Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 893

3900 & 5900 Series Base Station

Model Description

Issue 15
Date 2022-06-27

HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.


Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2022. All rights reserved.
No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior
written consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Trademarks and Permissions

and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective
holders.

Notice
The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and
the customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be
within the purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements,
information, and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees
or representations of any kind, either express or implied.

The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the
preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and
recommendations in this document do not constitute a warranty of any kind, express or implied.

Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.


Address: Huawei Industrial Base
Bantian, Longgang
Shenzhen 518129
People's Republic of China

Website: https://www.huawei.com
Email: support@huawei.com

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. i


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station
Model Description Contents

Contents

1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model Description...................................................... 1


1.1 Changes in 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model Description...........................................................................4
1.2 3900 Series Base Stations.................................................................................................................................................. 25
1.2.1 BTS3900................................................................................................................................................................................ 26
1.2.1.1 Cabinets and Subracks Used by a BTS3900.......................................................................................................... 26
1.2.1.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900....................................................................................................28
1.2.1.2.1 BTS3900 (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs......................................................................... 28
1.2.1.2.2 BTS3900 (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs.........................................................................32
1.2.1.2.3 BTS3900 (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs and RRUs..........................................................................................38
1.2.1.2.4 BTS3900 (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs and RRUs......................................................................................... 40
1.2.1.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900..........................................................................................................................46
1.2.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900 (Ver.C)....................................................................................................... 46
1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900 (Ver.D)....................................................................................................... 52
1.2.1.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900......................................................................................................... 61
1.2.1.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.C) Cabinets.........................................................................61
1.2.1.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.D) Cabinets........................................................................ 64
1.2.1.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900....................................................................................................... 72
1.2.2 BTS3900L.............................................................................................................................................................................. 72
1.2.2.1 Cabinets and Subracks Used by a BTS3900L........................................................................................................ 72
1.2.2.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900L................................................................................................. 75
1.2.2.2.1 BTS3900L (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs....................................................................... 75
1.2.2.2.2 BTS3900L (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs.......................................................................76
1.2.2.2.3 BTS3900L (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs and RRUs........................................................................................80
1.2.2.2.4 BTS3900L (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs and RRUs....................................................................................... 82
1.2.2.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L....................................................................................................................... 84
1.2.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L (Ver.C)..................................................................................................... 84
1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L (Ver.D)..................................................................................................... 91
1.2.2.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900L..................................................................................................... 101
1.2.2.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900L (Ver.C) Cabinets.................................................................... 101
1.2.2.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900L (Ver.D) Cabinets....................................................................103
1.2.2.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900L...................................................................................................110
1.2.3 BTS3900A........................................................................................................................................................................... 111
1.2.3.1 Cabinets Used by a BTS3900A................................................................................................................................ 111

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. ii


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station
Model Description Contents

1.2.3.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900A.............................................................................................. 119


1.2.3.2.1 BTS3900A (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs.................................................................... 120
1.2.3.2.2 BTS3900A (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs....................................................................128
1.2.3.2.3 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs.............. 141
1.2.3.2.4 BTS3900A (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs and RRUs.................................................................................... 148
1.2.3.2.5 BTS3900A (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs and RRUs.................................................................................... 156
1.2.3.2.6 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E) Configured with RFUs and RRUs............................... 165
1.2.3.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A.................................................................................................................... 173
1.2.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A (Ver.C).................................................................................................. 173
1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A (Ver.D).................................................................................................. 180
1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A (Ver.E).................................................................................................. 189
1.2.3.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900A.................................................................................................... 198
1.2.3.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.C) Cabinets................................................................... 199
1.2.3.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.D) Cabinets................................................................... 204
1.2.3.4.3 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.E) Cabinets....................................................................210
1.2.3.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900A.................................................................................................. 220
1.2.4 BTS3900AL......................................................................................................................................................................... 221
1.2.4.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS3900AL....................................................................................................................221
1.2.4.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900AL............................................................................................ 223
1.2.4.2.1 BTS3900AL (Ver.A) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs................................................................. 223
1.2.4.2.2 BTS3900AL (Ver.A) Configured with RFUs and RRUs.................................................................................. 234
1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900AL (Ver.A)................................................................................................... 243
1.2.4.4 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900AL (Ver.A) Cabinets.................................................................... 246
1.2.4.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900AL................................................................................................249
1.2.5 DBS3900............................................................................................................................................................................. 249
1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used by a DBS3900............................................................................................................. 250
1.2.5.2 Application Scenarios of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3900 or BBU3910................................274
1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios............................................................................................................................................ 274
1.2.5.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios............................................................................................................................................ 344
1.2.5.2.3 Indoor AC Scenarios................................................................................................................................................ 363
1.2.5.2.4 Indoor DC Scenarios................................................................................................................................................ 365
1.2.5.3 Application Scenarios of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3910A......................................................375
1.2.5.3.1 Outdoor AC Scenario.............................................................................................................................................. 375
1.2.5.3.2 Outdoor DC Scenario.............................................................................................................................................. 377
1.2.5.4 Application Scenario of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3910C........................................................378
1.2.5.5 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3900 or BBU3910................................. 379
1.2.5.5.1 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H....................................................................... 380
1.2.5.5.2 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H....................................................................... 381
1.2.5.5.3 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H-L................................................................... 388
1.2.5.5.4 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H-L................................................................... 390
1.2.5.5.5 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(AC)................................................................. 396
1.2.5.5.6 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(DC).................................................................398

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. iii


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station
Model Description Contents

1.2.5.5.7 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)............................................................. 406


1.2.5.5.8 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.D).............................................................407
1.2.5.5.9 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.C)............................................................. 408
1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.E)........................................................... 408
1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.D).......................................................... 417
1.2.5.5.12 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.C)........................................................... 425
1.2.5.5.13 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the MRE1000........................................................................ 432
1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C).................................................................. 433
1.2.5.5.15 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the IMB05, IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch Rack, or Wall for
Installation................................................................................................................................................................................... 439
1.2.5.5.16 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TP48600A....................................................................... 458
1.2.5.5.17 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the IBC10................................................................................459
1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)..................................................................461
1.2.5.6 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Configured with a BBU3910A........................................................... 468
1.2.5.7 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Configured with a BBU3910C........................................................... 474
1.2.5.8 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Configured with a BBU3900 or BBU3910.......................474
1.2.5.8.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H.........................................................475
1.2.5.8.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H.........................................................477
1.2.5.8.3 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H-L.....................................................480
1.2.5.8.4 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H-L.....................................................482
1.2.5.8.5 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(AC)...................................................489
1.2.5.8.6 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(DC).................................................. 491
1.2.5.8.7 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)............................................... 495
1.2.5.8.8 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.D).............................................. 504
1.2.5.8.9 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.C)...............................................509
1.2.5.8.10 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.D) or TMC11H (Ver.E)......512
1.2.5.8.11 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.C)............................................ 516
1.2.5.8.12 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the MRE1000..........................................................517
1.2.5.8.13 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)....................................................521
1.2.5.8.14 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the IMB05, IMB03, IFS06, 19-Inch Rack, or
Wall for Installation.................................................................................................................................................................. 526
1.2.5.8.15 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the TP48600A.........................................................532
1.2.5.8.16 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the IBC10................................................................. 535
1.2.5.8.17 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)................................................... 536
1.2.5.9 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Configured with a BBU3910A.............................................540
1.2.5.10 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Configured with a BBU3910C...........................................542
1.2.5.11 Cables and Cable Connections in a DBS3900..................................................................................................542
1.2.6 BTS3900C........................................................................................................................................................................... 545
1.2.6.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS3900C...................................................................................................................... 545
1.2.6.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900C.....................................................................................................................547
1.2.6.2.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900C WCDMA............................................................................................... 547
1.2.6.2.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900C (Ver.C).................................................................................................. 548
1.2.6.3 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900C.................................................................................................... 549

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. iv


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station
Model Description Contents

1.2.6.3.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900C WCDMA................................................................................ 549


1.2.6.3.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900C (Ver.C).................................................................................... 550
1.2.6.4 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900C.................................................................................................. 552
1.3 5900 Series Base Stations................................................................................................................................................ 553
1.3.1 BTS5900.............................................................................................................................................................................. 553
1.3.1.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS5900.........................................................................................................................553
1.3.1.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS5900................................................................................................. 555
1.3.1.2.1 BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) Cabinet Applications.................................................................................................... 555
1.3.1.2.2 BTS5900 (Ver.A) Cabinet Applications.............................................................................................................. 559
1.3.1.3 Power Requirements of a BTS5900....................................................................................................................... 566
1.3.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)........................................................................................... 566
1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS5900 (Ver.A)..................................................................................................... 575
1.3.1.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900....................................................................................................... 583
1.3.1.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS5900..................................................................................................... 589
1.3.2 BTS5900L............................................................................................................................................................................590
1.3.2.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS5900L...................................................................................................................... 590
1.3.2.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS5900L............................................................................................... 592
1.3.2.2.1 BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) Cabinet Applications.................................................................................................. 592
1.3.2.2.2 BTS5900L (Ver.A) Cabinet Applications............................................................................................................ 593
1.3.2.3 Power Requirements of a BTS5900L..................................................................................................................... 596
1.3.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)......................................................................................... 596
1.3.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS5900L (Ver.A)...................................................................................................604
1.3.2.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900L..................................................................................................... 613
1.3.2.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS5900L...................................................................................................619
1.3.3 BTS5900A........................................................................................................................................................................... 620
1.3.3.1 Cabinets Used by a BTS5900A................................................................................................................................ 620
1.3.3.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS5900A.............................................................................................. 625
1.3.3.2.1 BTS5900A Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs...................................................................................625
1.3.3.2.2 BTS5900A Configured with RFUs and RRUs................................................................................................... 631
1.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a BTS5900A.................................................................................................................... 639
1.3.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS5900A Using the APM30H (Ver.E)........................................................... 639
1.3.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS5900A Using the APM30H (Ver.F_B~E)/TMC11H (Ver.F_B~E)....... 648
1.3.3.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900A.................................................................................................... 657
1.3.3.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900A Using the APM30H (Ver.E)........................................... 657
1.3.3.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900A Using the APM30H (Ver.F_B~E)..................................670
1.3.3.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS5900A.................................................................................................. 672
1.3.4 DBS5900............................................................................................................................................................................. 673
1.3.4.1 Cabinets and Racks Used by a DBS5900............................................................................................................. 673
1.3.4.2 Application Scenarios of a DBS5900..................................................................................................................... 694
1.3.4.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios............................................................................................................................................ 694
1.3.4.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios............................................................................................................................................ 733
1.3.4.2.3 Indoor AC Scenario.................................................................................................................................................. 748

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. v


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station
Model Description Contents

1.3.4.2.4 Indoor DC Scenarios................................................................................................................................................ 749


1.3.4.3 Power Requirements of a DBS5900...................................................................................................................... 762
1.3.4.3.1 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H....................................................................... 763
1.3.4.3.2 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H....................................................................... 765
1.3.4.3.3 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H-L................................................................... 772
1.3.4.3.4 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H-L................................................................... 774
1.3.4.3.5 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(AC)................................................................. 780
1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC).................................................................782
1.3.4.3.7 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)............................................................. 790
1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.E)..............................................................791
1.3.4.3.9 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the IBC10 (Ver.B)................................................................... 799
1.3.4.3.10 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)..................................................................800
1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/IFS5906+IMS5906......................................... 808
1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch Rack or Wall for Installation................... 816
1.3.4.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a DBS5900...................................................................................................... 826
1.3.4.4.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H.........................................................826
1.3.4.4.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H.........................................................828
1.3.4.4.3 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H-L.....................................................831
1.3.4.4.4 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H-L.....................................................833
1.3.4.4.5 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(AC)...................................................836
1.3.4.4.6 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC).................................................. 844
1.3.4.4.7 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)............................................... 848
1.3.4.4.8 When the BBU Is Installed in the TMC11H (Ver.E)...................................................................................... 857
1.3.4.4.9 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the IBC10 (Ver.B)..................................................... 861
1.3.4.4.10 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)................................................... 863
1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch Rack,
or Wall for Installation.............................................................................................................................................................867
1.3.4.5 Cable Connections in a DBS5900........................................................................................................................... 874
1.3.5 DBS5900A.......................................................................................................................................................................... 877
1.3.5.1 Application Scenarios of a DBS5900A.................................................................................................................. 877
1.3.5.1.1 Outdoor AC Scenario.............................................................................................................................................. 877
1.3.5.1.2 Outdoor DC Scenario.............................................................................................................................................. 881
1.3.5.2 Power Requirements of a DBS5900A................................................................................................................... 882
1.3.5.3 Power Distribution Schemes for a DBS5900A................................................................................................... 884
1.3.5.4 Cable Connections in a DBS5900A........................................................................................................................ 886

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. vi


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model


Description

Overview
This document describes supported cabinets and racks, application scenarios,
power requirements, power distribution schemes, cable lists, and cable
connections of 3900 & 5900 series base stations. This document serves as a
reference for 3900 & 5900 series base station planning and deployment.

The RF modules for distributed base stations in this document include RRUs and
AAUs. The application scenarios, power distribution schemes, cable connections,
and cable installation of the RRUs and AAUs are the same. The following uses the
RRUs as an example.

The exteriors of components or cables in this document are for reference only. The
actual exteriors may be different.

NOTE

● Unless otherwise specified, in this document, LTE and eNodeB always include FDD, NB-IoT,
and TDD. In scenarios where they need to be distinguished, LTE FDD, LTE NB-IoT, and LTE
TDD are used. The same rules apply to eNodeB.
● Unless otherwise specified, in this document, NR and gNodeB always include FDD and TDD.
In scenarios where they need to be distinguished, NR FDD and NR TDD are used. The same
rules apply to gNodeB.
● In this document, "G" is short for GSM, "U" for UMTS, "L" for LTE FDD, "T" for LTE TDD, "M"
for LTE NB-IoT, and "N" for NR. In addition, "N (FDD)" is short for NR FDD and "N (TDD)" is
short for NR TDD.
● For details about the LampSite solution, see LampSite Base Station Hardware Description.

Product Versions
The following table lists the product versions related to this document.

Product Name Solution Version Product Version

3900 series base stations SRAN8.0 and later V100R008C00 and later

5900 series base stations

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Unless otherwise specified, cabinets, components, and RATs involved in this


document are supported in V100R008C00 and later versions. The following table
lists the special cases.
Item Solution Version Product Version

IBC10 SRAN8.1/GBSS15.1/ V100R008C01 and later


RAN15.1/eRAN6.1 and
later

● BBU3910 SRAN9.0/GBSS16.0/ V100R009C00 and later


● APM30H (Ver.E) RAN16.0/eRAN7.0/eRAN
TDD 7.0 and later
● TMC11H (Ver.E)
● RFC (Ver.E)
● IBBS200D (Ver.E)
● IBBS200T (Ver.E)

● BBU3910A SRAN10.0/GBSS17.0/ V100R010C00 and later


● OPM50M RAN17.0/eRAN8.0 and
later
● OPM15M
● IBBS20D
● IBBS300D (Ver.A)
● IBBS300T (Ver.A)
● USU3910

IBBS20L SRAN11.0/GBSS18.0/ V100R011C00 and later


RAN18.0/eRAN11.0/
eRAN TDD 11.0 and later

● IBBS20L-E SRAN11.1/GBSS18.1/ V100R011C10 and later


● OPM30M RAN18.1/eRAN11.1/
eRAN TDD 11.1 and later

RMU3900A SRAN12.0/GBSS19.0/ V100R012C00 and later


RAN19.0/eRAN12.0/
eRAN TDD 12.0 and later

● EPU02D SRAN12.1/GBSS19.1/ V100R012C10 and later


● EPU02D-02 RAN19.1/eRAN12.1/
eRAN TDD 12.1 and later
● MRE1000

● BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) SRAN12.1/GBSS19.1/ V100R012C10 and later


● BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) RAN19.1/eRAN12.1/
eRAN TDD 12.1 and later
● IMB05
● ILC29 (Ver.E)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Item Solution Version Product Version

● BTS5900 (Ver.A) SRAN12.1/GBSS19.1/ V100R012C10 and later


● BTS5900L (Ver.A) RAN19.1/eRAN12.1/
eRAN TDD 12.1 and later

● APM5930 SRAN12.1/GBSS19.1/ V100R012C10 and later


● BBC5200D/BBC5200T/ RAN19.1/eRAN12.1/
BBC5300D/BBC5300T eRAN TDD 12.1 and later
● IBC10 (Ver.B)

● BBC5200D-L SRAN15.1/GBSS21.1/ V100R015C10 and later


● DCDU16D RAN21.1/eRAN15.1/
eRAN TDD 15.1 and later
● FAN02H
● BBU5900A
● OPM200
● IBBS50L
● RFC5906

● INS05 SRAN16.0/GBSS22.0/ V100R016C00 and later


● IFS5906 RAN22.0/eRAN16.0/
eRAN TDD 16.0 and later
● IMS5906
● EPU02S

● EPU02B SRAN16.1/GBSS22.1/ V100R016C10 and later


● EPU02S-02 RAN22.1/eRAN16.1/
eRAN TDD 16.1 and later

DCDU16D-02 SRAN17.0/GBSS23.0/ V100R017C00 and later


RAN23.0/eRAN17.0/
eRAN TDD 17.0 and later

● APM5950H SRAN18.1/GBSS24.1/ V100R018C10 and later


● APM5900H RAN24.1/eRAN18.1/
eRAN TDD 18.1 and later
● BBC5600D
● BBC5600D-V
● APM5950H-L
● APM5900H-L
● BBC5600A
● BBC5600A-V

Intended Audience
This document is intended for:

● System engineers
● Base station installation engineers

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 3


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● Site maintenance engineers

Organization
1.1 Changes in 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model Description
This section describes the changes in 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Description.
1.2 3900 Series Base Stations
3900 series base stations include BTS3900C, BTS3900, BTS3900L, BTS3900A,
BTS3900AL, and DBS3900.
1.3 5900 Series Base Stations
5900 series base stations include the DBS5900, BTS5900, BTS5900L, BTS5900A,
and DBS5900A.

1.1 Changes in 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model


Description
This section describes the changes in 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Description.

15 (2022-06-27)
This is the fifteenth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 14 (2022-02-08), this issue includes the following new topics:
● 1.3.4.3.3 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H-L
● 1.3.4.3.4 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H-L
● 1.3.4.4.3 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H-
L
● 1.3.4.4.4 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H-
L
● 1.2.5.5.3 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H-L
● 1.2.5.5.4 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H-L
● 1.2.5.8.3 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H-
L
● 1.2.5.8.4 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H-
L
Compared with Issue 14 (2022-02-08), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 4


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Added descriptions of


Model Description APM5950H&APM5900H cabinets and
● 1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios BBC5600A&BBC5600A-V battery
cabinets.
● 1.2.5.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios
● 1.3.4.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios
● 1.3.4.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios
● 1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS3900
● 1.3.4.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS5900
● 1.3.4.5 Cable Connections in a
DBS5900

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 5


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a Added the AAU5726e, AAU5835f,


BTS3900 (Ver.C) AAU5825g, and AAU5825a to
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a descriptions of the RRU/AAU
BTS3900 (Ver.D) maximum power consumption.

● 1.2.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a


BTS3900L (Ver.C)
● 1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.C)
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.2 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM5900H
● 1.2.5.5.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.15 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the IMB05,
IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch Rack, or
Wall for Installation
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Configured with a
BBU3910A
● 1.3.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)
● 1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900 (Ver.A)
● 1.3.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 6


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.3.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a


BTS5900L (Ver.A)
● 1.3.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900A Using the APM30H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900A Using the APM30H
(Ver.F_B~E)/TMC11H (Ver.F_B~E)
● 1.3.4.3.2 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5900H
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906
● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation

Compared with Issue 14 (2022-02-08), this issue does not exclude any topics.

14 (2022-02-08)
This is the fourteenth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 13 (2021-12-30), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 13 (2021-12-30), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 7


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a Added the AAU5726e to descriptions


BTS3900 (Ver.C) of the RRU/AAU maximum power
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a consumption.
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.C)
● 1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.C)
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.2 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM5900H
● 1.2.5.5.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.15 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the IMB05,
IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch Rack, or
Wall for Installation
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Configured with a
BBU3910A
● 1.3.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)
● 1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900 (Ver.A)
● 1.3.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 8


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.3.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a


BTS5900L (Ver.A)
● 1.3.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900A Using the APM30H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900A Using the APM30H
(Ver.F_B~E)/TMC11H (Ver.F_B~E)
● 1.3.4.3.2 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5900H
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906
● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation

13 (2021-12-30)
This is the thirteenth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 12 (2021-11-27), this issue includes the following new topics:
● 1.2.5.5.1 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H
● 1.2.5.5.2 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H
● 1.2.5.8.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H
● 1.2.5.8.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H
● 1.3.4.3.1 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H
● 1.3.4.3.2 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H
● 1.3.4.4.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H
● 1.3.4.4.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H
Compared with Issue 12 (2021-11-27), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 9


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a Deleted descriptions of the DRFU,


BTS3900 (Ver.C) GRFU, RRU3004, and RRU3008.
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.C)
● 1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.C)
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900AL (Ver.A)
● 1.2.6.2.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900C (Ver.C)
● 1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900 (Ver.A)
● 1.3.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900L (Ver.A)
● 1.3.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900A Using the APM30H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 10


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of


a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation

● 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Added descriptions of the APM5950H
Model Description and APM5900H.
● 1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS3900
● 1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios
● 1.2.5.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios
● 1.3.4.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS5900
● 1.3.4.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios
● 1.3.4.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios

Entire document Deleted descriptions about the


RRU3201, RRU3801E, RRU3804,
RRU3805, RRU3806, RRU3808,
RRU3828, and RRU3829.

12 (2021-11-27)
This is the twelfth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 11 (2021-11-12), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 11 (2021-11-12), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 11


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of Added the RRU5910 to descriptions of


a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H the RRU/AAU maximum power
(Ver.E) consumption.
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906
● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900AL (Ver.A)

11 (2021-11-12)
This is the eleventh commercial release.
Compared with Issue 10 (2021-09-29), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 10 (2021-09-29), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 12


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of Added the AAU5835f to descriptions of


a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H the RRU/AAU maximum power
(Ver.E) consumption.
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906
● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900AL (Ver.A)

10 (2021-09-29)
This is the tenth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 09 (2021-08-12), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 09 (2021-08-12), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 13


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.3.1 Cabinets Used by a Deleted the information of the


BTS3900A BBC5200T-L and its upgrade package.
● 1.2.3.2.6 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or
BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E)
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS3900
● 1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios
● 1.3.3.1 Cabinets Used by a
BTS5900A
● 1.3.3.2 Cabinet Applications
Supported by a BTS5900A
● 1.3.4.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS5900
● 1.3.4.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios
● 1.2.3.2.5 BTS3900A (Ver.D)
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.3.1 Cabinets Used by a
BTS3900A
● 1.2.3.2.5 BTS3900A (Ver.D)
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.3.2.6 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or
BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E)
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS3900
● 1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios

09 (2021-08-12)
This is the ninth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 08 (2021-06-30), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 08 (2021-06-30), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 14


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.3.1 Cabinets Used by a Added the description that the


BTS3900A BBC5200T-L can be used with an
● 1.2.3.2.5 BTS3900A (Ver.D) APM30H (Ver.D).
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.3.2.6 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or
BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E)
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS3900
● 1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios

08 (2021-06-30)
This is the eighth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 07 (2021-06-26), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 07 (2021-06-26), this issue includes the following changes.

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.3.1 Cabinets Used by a Added the information of the


BTS3900A BBC5200T-L and its upgrade package.
● 1.2.3.2.6 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or
BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E)
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS3900
● 1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios
● 1.3.3.1 Cabinets Used by a
BTS5900A
● 1.3.3.2 Cabinet Applications
Supported by a BTS5900A
● 1.3.4.1 Cabinets and Racks Used
by a DBS5900
● 1.3.4.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios

07 (2021-06-26)
This is the seventh commercial release.
Compared with Issue 06 (2021-04-30), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 06 (2021-04-30), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 15


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of Added the RRU5513t to descriptions of


a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H the RRU/AAU maximum power
(Ver.E) consumption.
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906
● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900AL (Ver.A)

06 (2021-04-30)
This is the sixth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 05 (2021-03-05), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 05 (2021-03-05), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 16


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of Added the RRU5512, RRU5512t,


a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H RRU5862, AAU5833f, and AAU5636 to
(Ver.E) descriptions of the RRU/AAU
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of maximum power consumption.
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906
● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900AL (Ver.A)

05 (2021-03-05)
This is the fifth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 04 (2020-12-29), this issue does not include any new topics
or changes.
Compared with Issue 04 (2020-12-29), this issue excludes the following topics:
● DBS5900E
● Application Scenarios of a DBS5900E
● Power Requirements of a DBS5900E

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 17


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

04 (2020-12-29)
This is the fourth commercial release.
Compared with Issue 03 (2020-10-10), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 03 (2020-10-10), this issue includes the following changes.

Topic Change Description

Entire document Deleted descriptions of the BTS3900


(Ver.B), BTS3900L (Ver.B), BTS3900A
(Ver.B), APM30H (Ver.B), TMC11H
(Ver.B), RFC (Ver.B), OMB, IBBS200D
(Ver.B), IBBS200T (Ver.B), DCDU-03B,
DCDU-03C, and EPS30-4815AF.

03 (2020-10-10)
This is the third commercial release.
Compared with Issue 02 (2020-07-31), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 02 (2020-07-31), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 18


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a Deleted the DCDU16D-02S description.


BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.1.4.2 Power Distribution
Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.D)
Cabinets
● 1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
● 1.2.2.4.2 Power Distribution
Schemes for BTS3900L (Ver.D)
Cabinets
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.3.4.3 Power Distribution
Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.E)
Cabinets
● 1.2.5.5.7 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM30H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM30H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.15 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the IMB05,
IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch Rack, or
Wall for Installation
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.8.7 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the
APM30H (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.8.10 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the
TMC11H (Ver.D) or TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900 (Ver.A)
● 1.3.1.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 19


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a


DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.10 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch
Rack, or Wall for Installation
● 1.3.4.4.6 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.4.8 When the BBU Is
Installed in the TMC11H (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch
Rack, or Wall for Installation

● 1.3.5 DBS5900A Added the descriptions of the


● 1.3.5.1 Application Scenarios of a DBS5900A and DBS5900E.
DBS5900A
● 1.3.5.2 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900A
● 1.3.5.3 Power Distribution
Schemes for a DBS5900A
● DBS5900E
● Application Scenarios of a
DBS5900E
● Power Requirements of a DBS5900E

02 (2020-07-31)
This is the second commercial release.
Compared with Issue 01 (2020-01-20), this issue does not include any new topics
or exclude any topics.
Compared with Issue 01 (2020-01-20), this issue includes the following changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 20


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a Added the descriptions of


BTS3900 (Ver.D) DCDU16D-02, DCDU16D-02S, and
● 1.2.1.4.2 Power Distribution PDU03D-03.
Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.D)
Cabinets
● 1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
● 1.2.2.4.2 Power Distribution
Schemes for BTS3900L (Ver.D)
Cabinets
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.3.4.3 Power Distribution
Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.E)
Cabinets
● 1.2.5.5.7 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM30H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Using the APM30H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.15 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the IMB05,
IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch Rack, or
Wall for Installation
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.8.7 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the
APM30H (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.8.10 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the
TMC11H (Ver.D) or TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900 (Ver.A)
● 1.3.1.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 21


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a


DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.10 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch
Rack, or Wall for Installation
● 1.3.4.4.6 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.4.8 When the BBU Is
Installed in the TMC11H (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch
Rack, or Wall for Installation

1.3.4.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios Added the descriptions of the mixed


configuration of lead and lithium
battery cabinets.

● Power Requirements of a DBS5900E Added the BookBBU5901 descriptions.


● Application Scenarios of a
DBS5900E

01 (2020-01-20)
This is the first commercial release.
This document is separated from the 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Hardware
Description document and its content derives from the sections "3900 Series Base
Stations" and "5900 Series Base Stations."
Compared with the sections "3900 Series Base Stations" and "5900 Series Base
Stations" in 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Hardware Description of Issue 18
(2019-03-25), this issue includes the following new topics and changes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 22


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a Added the descriptions of EPU02B,


BTS5900 (Ver.A) EPU02S, EPU02S-02, and DCDU16D.
● 1.3.1.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900
● 1.3.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900L (Ver.A)
● 1.3.2.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900L
● 1.3.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900A Using the APM30H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.3.4.1 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900A Using
the APM30H (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.5 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
APM5930(AC)
● 1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.4.6 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
APM5930(DC)
● 1.3.4.4.7 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
APM30H (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900 Using the TMC11H
(Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.4.8 When the BBU Is
Installed in the TMC11H (Ver.E)
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.1.4.2 Power Distribution
Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.D)
Cabinets
● 1.2.3.2.6 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or
BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E)
Configured with RFUs and RRUs
● 1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.D)
● 1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● 1.2.3.4.2 Power Distribution
Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.D)
Cabinets

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 23


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Topic Change Description

● 1.2.3.4.3 Power Distribution


Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.E)
Cabinets
● 1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900AL (Ver.A)
● 1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.2.5.8.13 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the
OMB (Ver.C)
● 1.2.5.8.17 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the
ILC29 (Ver.E)
● 1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/
IFS5906+IMS5906
● 1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch
Rack, or Wall for Installation
● 1.2.5.5.15 Power Requirements of
a DBS3900 Using the IMB05,
IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch Rack, or
Wall for Installation
● 1.2.5.8.14 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the
IMB05, IMB03, IFS06, 19-Inch
Rack, or Wall for Installation

● 1.3.4.1 Cabinets and Racks Used Added the descriptions of IFS5906,


by a DBS5900 INS05, and IMS5906.
● 1.3.4.2.4 Indoor DC Scenarios
● 1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of
a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch
Rack or Wall for Installation
● 1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution
Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the
IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch
Rack, or Wall for Installation

Compared with the sections "3900 Series Base Stations" and "5900 Series Base
Stations" in 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Hardware Description of Issue 18
(2019-03-25), this issue does not exclude any topics.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 24


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Before the separation, compared with Issue 17 (2018-12-31), Issue 18


(2019-03-25) does not include any new topics or exclude any topics.

Compared with Issue 17 (2018-12-31), Issue 18 (2019-03-25) includes the


following changes.

Topic Change Description

● 1.3.1.3 Power Requirements of a Deleted the configurations of upper-


BTS5900 level circuit breakers, power cables,
● 1.3.2.3 Power Requirements of a and power distribution schemes for
BTS5900L the EPU02B and EPU02S.
● 1.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a
BTS5900A
● 1.3.4.3 Power Requirements of a
DBS5900
● 1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
● 1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
● 1.2.5.5 Power Requirements of a
DBS3900 Configured with the
BBU3900 or BBU3910
● 1.3.1.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900
● 1.3.2.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900L
● 1.3.3.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS5900A
● 1.3.4.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a DBS5900
● 1.2.1.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS3900
● 1.2.2.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS3900L
● 1.2.3.4 Power Distribution
Schemes for a BTS3900A
● 1.2.5.8 Power Distribution Scheme
for a DBS3900 Configured with a
BBU3900 or BBU3910

1.2 3900 Series Base Stations


3900 series base stations include BTS3900C, BTS3900, BTS3900L, BTS3900A,
BTS3900AL, and DBS3900.

3900 series base stations are divided into the following categories:

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 25


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● Indoor macro base stations: BTS3900 and BTS3900L


● Outdoor macro base stations: BTS3900A and BTS3900AL
● Outdoor compact mini base station: BTS3900C
● Distributed base station: DBS3900

1.2.1 BTS3900
This section describes cabinets, cabinet applications, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, cables, and cable connections of a BTS3900.

1.2.1.1 Cabinets and Subracks Used by a BTS3900


A BTS3900 is an indoor macro base station. Different types of base stations can be
formed by BTS3900 cabinets of different versions.
With the improvement in cabinet design, Huawei has many types of cabinets
applicable to a BTS3900 base station. Among these cabinets, the BTS3900 (Ver.D)
cabinet can work with the IMS06 cabinet to meet the requirements of power
distribution, module configuration, and space for customer equipment. The
following table describes the cabinets and subracks.

Table 1-1 Cabinet/Subrack description


Base Cabinet/ Cabinet/Subrack Cabinet/Subrack
Station Subrack Description Configuration
Name

BTS3900 BTS3900 The cabinet can be For details, see


(Ver.C) (Ver.C) supplied with AC or DC Components in BTS3900
power. One of the Cabinets.
following types of
cabinets needs to be
used to support a
corresponding type of
power supply:
● BTS3900 AC cabinet
● BTS3900 DC cabinet
(-48 V), shortened
to BTS3900 DC
cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 26


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Base Cabinet/ Cabinet/Subrack Cabinet/Subrack


Station Subrack Description Configuration
Name

BTS3900 BTS3900 The cabinet can be For details, see


(Ver.D) (Ver.D) supplied with AC or DC Components in BTS3900
power. One of the Cabinets.
following types of
cabinets needs to be
used to support a
corresponding type of
power supply:
● BTS3900 AC cabinet
● BTS3900 DC cabinet
(-48 V), shortened
to BTS3900 DC
cabinet

IMS06a An IMS06 can be For details, see


installed under a Components in BTS3900
BTS3900 cabinet to Cabinets.
provide space for
batteries or
transmission
equipment.

a. IMS06: indoor mini subrack

The following figure shows the exteriors of a BTS3900 (Ver.C) cabinet, a BTS3900
(Ver.D) cabinet, and an IMS06.

NOTE

A BTS3900 (Ver.C) AC cabinet has the same exteriors as a DC cabinet, whereas a BTS3900
(Ver.D) AC cabinet has a different exterior from a DC cabinet.

Figure 1-1 Cabinet/Subrack exteriors

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 27


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Besides the preceding cabinets, some cabinets of earlier versions can be


restructured to have the same capability as BTS3900 (Ver.D) cabinets. The
following table describes such cabinets.

Table 1-2 Restructured cabinets


Base Cabinet Cabinet Description Cabinet Configuration
Station Name

BTS3900 BTS3900 The cabinet is For details, see BTS3900


(Ver.E_A~ (Ver.E_A~D) restructured from a Installation Guide for
D) BTS3900 (Ver.A), Enhancing Existing
BTS3900 (Ver.B), Cabinets (Ver.E Series).
BTS3900 (Ver.C), or
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
cabinet.

BTS3900 BTS3900 The BTS3900 (Ver.D_A) For details, see BTS3900


(Ver.D_A) (Ver.D_A) cabinet is restructured Installation Guide for
from a BTS3900 Enhancing Existing
(Ver.A) cabinet. Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
BTS3900 BTS3900 The BTS3900 (Ver.D_B) For details, see BTS3900
(Ver.D_B) (Ver.D_B) cabinet is restructured Installation Guide for
from a BTS3900 (Ver.B) Enhancing Existing
cabinet. Cabinets (Ver.D Series).

1.2.1.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900


A BTS3900 supports different RF module configurations and spaces for customer
equipment. A BTS3900 can be configured with RFUs but without RRUs or
configured with RFUs and RRUs depending on different scenarios.

1.2.1.2.1 BTS3900 (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


A BTS3900 configured with RFUs but without RRUs is applicable to various
scenarios, including a single cabinet, cabinets installed side by side, and stacked
cabinets.
The following table lists the application scenarios of the BTS3900.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 28


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Sce Nu Application Maxim Illustration Applicable Cabinet


nar mb Mode um
io er Numbe
of r of RF
BB Modul
Us es

Sin 1 Single-, 6 RFUs The ● 1 BTS3900 DC


gle dual-, application cabinet
cab quadruple-, scenarios are ● 1 BTS3900 AC cabinet
inet and triple- shown by
mode base illustrations 1
stations and 2 in
Figure 1-2.

Cab 1 Single-, 12 The ● 2 BTS3900 DC


inet dual-, RFUs application cabinets
s quadruple-, scenarios are ● 2 BTS3900 AC
inst and triple- shown by cabinets
alle mode base illustrations 1
d stations and 2 in
sid Figure 1-3.
e
by 2 Triple- and 12 The
sid quadruple- RFUs application
e mode base scenarios are
stations shown by
illustrations 3
and 4 in
Figure 1-3.

Sta 1 Single-, 12 The ● 2 BTS3900 DC


cke dual-, RFUs application cabinets
d quadruple-, scenario is ● 2 BTS3900 AC
cab and triple- shown by cabinets
inet mode base illustration 1 in
s stations Figure 1-4.

2 Triple- and 12 The


quadruple- RFUs application
mode base scenario is
stations shown by
illustration 2 in
Figure 1-4.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 29


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

● A BTS3900 cabinet is configured with one BBU by default and can be configured with a
maximum of two BBUs whose power consumption cannot exceed 1000 W. This principle
applies to a new or expansion scenario.
● It is recommended that two BTS3900 DC cabinets be stacked. If two BTS3900 AC
cabinets are stacked, reduce the maximum working temperature of the cabinets to
+50°C (+122°F). One of the following figures shows stacked BTS3900 DC cabinets as
examples.

Figure 1-2 Single cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 30


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-3 Cabinets installed side by side

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 31


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-4 Stacked cabinets

1.2.1.2.2 BTS3900 (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


A BTS3900 configured with RFUs but without RRUs is applicable to various
scenarios, including a single cabinet, cabinets installed side by side, stacked
cabinets, and cabinets used with an IMS06.

BTS3900 Configured with Only BTS3900 Cabinets


The following table lists the application scenarios for a BTS3900 that uses only
BTS3900 cabinets and is configured with RFUs but without RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 32


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Sce Nu Application Maxim Illustration Applicable Cabinet


nar mb Mode um
io er Numbe
of r of RF
BB Module
Us s

Sin 1 Single-, 6 RFUs The application ● 1 BTS3900 DC


gle dual-, scenarios are cabinet
cab quadruple-, shown by ● 1 BTS3900 AC cabinet
inet and triple- illustrations 1
mode base and 2 in
stations Figure 1-5.

2 Triple- and 6 RFUs The application


quadruple- scenarios are
mode base shown by
stations illustrations 3
and 4 in
Figure 1-5.

Cab 1 Single-, 12 The application ● 2 BTS3900 DC


inet dual-, RFUs scenarios are cabinets
s quadruple-, shown by ● 1 BTS3900 AC cabinet
inst and triple- illustrations 1 +1 BTS3900 DC
alle mode base and 2 in cabinet
d stations Figure 1-6.
sid
e 2 Triple- and 12 The application
by quadruple- RFUs scenarios are
sid mode base shown by
e stations illustrations 3
and 4 in
Figure 1-6.

Sta 1 Single-, 12 The application 2 BTS3900 DC cabinets


cke dual-, RFUs scenario is
d quadruple-, shown by
cab and triple- illustration 1 in
inet mode base Figure 1-7.
s stations

2 Triple- and 12 The application


quadruple- RFUs scenario is
mode base shown by
stations illustration 2 in
Figure 1-7.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 33


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

● A BTS3900 cabinet is configured with one BBU by default and can be configured with a
maximum of two BBUs whose power consumption cannot exceed 1000 W. This principle
applies to new site deployment or capacity expansion.
● When cabinets are installed side by side or stacked, it is recommended that BBU 1 and
BBU 0 be installed in the same cabinet.
● One BTS3900 AC cabinet consists of one BTS3900 DC cabinet and one IMS06.

Figure 1-5 Single cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 34


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-6 Cabinets installed side by side

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 35


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-7 Stacked cabinets

BTS3900 Configured with BTS3900 Cabinets and an IMS06


The following table lists the application scenarios for a BTS3900 that uses
BTS3900 cabinets and an IMS06 and is configured with RFUs but without RRUs.
Scenario Num Applica Maximum Illustration Description
ber tion Number of
of Mode RF
BBUs Modules

1 BTS3900 2 Triple- 12 RFUs The The IMS06 is


AC cabinet mode application used to house
+1 BTS3900 base scenario is 100 Ah storage
DC cabinet station shown by batteries, which
+1 IMS06 illustration 1 provide low-
in Figure 1-8. capacity backup
power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 36


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Scenario Num Applica Maximum Illustration Description


ber tion Number of
of Mode RF
BBUs Modules

1 BTS3900 2 Triple- 6 RFUs The The IMS06 is


AC cabinet mode application used to house
+1 IMS06 base scenario is transmission
station shown by equipment.
illustration 2
in Figure 1-8.

NOTICE

An IMS06 cannot be stacked on a BTS3900 cabinet. Otherwise, the heat


dissipation holes on the top of the BTS3900 cabinet will be blocked.

NOTE

When an IMS06 is configured with storage batteries, the power consumption of a BTS3900
cannot exceed 10,000 W. If the power consumption exceeds 10,000 W, large-capacity
battery packs need to be added.

Figure 1-8 BTS3900 configured with BTS3900 cabinets and an IMS06

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 37


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.1.2.3 BTS3900 (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs and RRUs


A BTS3900 configured with RFUs and RRUs is applicable to various scenarios,
including a single cabinet, cabinets installed side by side, and stacked cabinets.
The following table lists the application scenarios for a BTS3900 configured with
RFUs and RRUs.
Sce Nu Application Maximum Illustration Applicable
nari mb Mode Number Cabinet
o er of RF
of Modules
BB
Us

Sing 1 Single-, dual-, 6 RFUs+6 The application 1 BTS3900 DC


le triple-, and RRUs scenario is shown cabinet
cabi quadruple- in Figure 1-9.
net mode base
stations

Cab 2 Triple- and 12 RFUs+6 The application 2 BTS3900 DC


inet quadruple- RRUs scenario is shown cabinets
s mode base in Figure 1-10.
inst stations
alle
d
side
by
side

Stac 2 Triple- and 12 RFUs+6 The application


ked quadruple- RRUs scenario is shown
cabi mode base in Figure 1-11.
nets stations

For a BTS3900 (Ver.C) configured with RFUs and RRUs, a DCDU-11B can be
configured to provide power for RRUs and the DCDU-11B must be installed on a
wall.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 38


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-9 Single cabinet (one BBU)

Figure 1-10 Cabinets installed side by side (two BBUs)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 39


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-11 Stacked cabinets (two BBUs)

1.2.1.2.4 BTS3900 (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs and RRUs


A BTS3900 configured with RFUs and RRUs is applicable to various scenarios,
including a single cabinet, cabinets installed side by side, stacked cabinets, and
cabinets used with an IMS06.

BTS3900 Configured with Only BTS3900 Cabinets


The following table lists the application scenarios for a BTS3900 that uses only
BTS3900 cabinets and is configured with RFUs and RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 40


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Scen Nu Application Maximu Illustration Applicable


ario mb Mode m Cabinet
er Number
of of RF
BBU Modules
s

Singl 1 Single-, 6 RFUs+6 The application scenario ● 1


e dual-, RRUs is shown in Figure 1-12. BTS3900
cabi triple-, and DC
net quadruple- cabinet
mode base ● 1
stations BTS3900
2 Triple- and 6 RFUs+9 The application AC
quadruple- RRUs scenarios are shown in cabinet
mode base Figure 1-13 and Figure
stations 1-14.

Cabi 1 Single-, 12 RFUs The application scenario 2 BTS3900


nets dual-, +6 RRUs is shown in Figure 1-15. DC cabinets
insta triple-, and
lled quadruple-
side mode base
by stations
side
2 Triple- and 12 RFUs The application scenario
quadruple- +9 RRUs is shown in Figure 1-16.
mode base
stations

Stac 1 Single-, 12 RFUs The application scenario


ked dual-, +6 RRUs is shown in Figure 1-17.
cabi triple-, and
nets quadruple-
mode base
stations

2 Triple- and 12 RFUs The application scenario


quadruple- +9 RRUs is shown in Figure 1-18.
mode base
stations

For a BTS3900 (Ver.D) configured with RFUs and RRUs, a DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02 can be configured to provide power for RRUs,
and the DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02 must be
installed in a BTS3900 cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 41


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

An EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 is configured
based on site requirements. For configuration principles, see "EPU02B", "EPU02S",
"EPU02S-02", "DCDU16D", "DCDU16D-02", and "EPU02D/EPU02D-02". The installation
position of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 in
a cabinet is the same as that of a DCDU-12B. This section uses a DCDU-12B as an example.

Figure 1-12 One BTS3900 DC cabinet (one BBU)

Figure 1-13 One BTS3900 DC cabinet (two BBUs)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 42


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-14 One BTS3900 AC cabinet (two BBUs)

Figure 1-15 Two BTS3900 DC cabinets installed side by side (one BBU)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 43


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-16 Two BTS3900 DC cabinets installed side by side (two BBUs)

Figure 1-17 Two BTS3900 DC cabinets stacked together (one BBU)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 44


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-18 Two BTS3900 DC cabinets stacked together (two BBUs)

BTS3900 Configured with a BTS3900 Cabinet and an IMS06


The following table lists the application scenario for a BTS3900 that uses a
BTS3900 cabinet and an IMS06 and is configured with RFUs and RRUs.
Scenario Num Applica Maximum Illustration Description
ber tion Number
of Mode of RF
BBUs Modules

1 BTS3900 2 Triple- 6 RFUs+9 The application The IMS06 is


AC cabinet and RRUs scenario is used to house
+1 IMS06 quadrup shown in 100 Ah
le-mode Figure 1-19. batteries, which
base provide low-
stations capacity backup
power.

NOTICE

An IMS06 cannot be stacked on a BTS3900 cabinet. Otherwise, the heat


dissipation holes on the top of the BTS3900 cabinet will be blocked.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 45


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

When an IMS06 is configured with storage batteries, the power consumption of a BTS3900
cannot exceed 10,000 W. If the power consumption exceeds 10,000 W, large-capacity
battery packs need to be added.

Figure 1-19 BTS3900 configured with one BTS3900 AC cabinet and one IMS06

1.2.1.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a BTS3900 (Ver.C) and a
BTS3900 (Ver.D). Power requirements of a BTS3900 (Ver.D_A), BTS3900 (Ver.D_B),
or BTS3012 (Ver.D_Z) are the same as those of a BTS3900 (Ver.D).

1.2.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900 (Ver.C)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 46


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

AC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when a BTS3900 is supplied with
AC power.

Table 1-3 Power requirements in AC scenarios

Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

220 V AC three- 1x20 A/3 P (by 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 in.2) ≤ 15 m


phase default) (49.21 ft)

220 V AC single- 1x50 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


phase default)

110 V AC dual- 1x50 A/2 P (by


live-wire default)

NOTE

An insulation cable with two insulation layers and four wires is used for AC three-phase
power. An insulation cable with two insulation layers and three wires is used for AC single-
phase and 110 V dual-live-wire power.

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


The following table lists the power requirements when -48 V DC power is supplied
to a BTS3900 configured with RFUs but without RRUs.

Table 1-4 Power requirements of a base station configured with RFUs but without
RRUs

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 4 to 6 high- 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2) ≤ 15 m


power RFUs default) (49.21 ft)
● 1 BBU 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) (low
smoke zero halogen)

● 4 to 6 low- 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


power RFUs
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 47


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 high- 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) (low


power RFUs smoke zero halogen)
● 1 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)

1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)

● 1 to 3 low- 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


power RFUs
● 1 BBU

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a BTS3900 is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the external power
equipment provides -48 V DC power for a DCDU-11A and a DCDU-11B. For
details, see 1.2.1.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.C) Cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 48


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● The DCDU-11A provides power for the RFUs, BBU, and fan assembly in the
cabinet. When the DCDU-11A is powered by the external power equipment,
the power requirements in this scenario are the same as those in the scenario
where a base station is configured with RFUs but without RRUs. For details,
see Table 1-4.
● The DCDU-11B provides power for RRUs. The following table lists the power
requirements when the DCDU-11B is powered by the external power
equipment.

Table 1-5 Power requirements of a base station configured with RFUs and RRUs
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 300 W)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 300 W)

4 to 6 RRUs (400 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables (low smoke zero
RRU ≤ 560 W) halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

1 to 3 RRUs (400 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 560 W)

4 to 6 RRUs (300 1x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power default) group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 400 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (300 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 400 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 49


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables
W)
● 3 RRUs (300 W
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
default) groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 400 halogen)
W)
2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (400 W
default) groups of DC input power
< power
cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 50


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 51


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.

1.2.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900 (Ver.D)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs Only


The power requirements of a BTS3900 supplied with AC power are the same as
those of the IMS06. The following table lists the power requirements when a
BTS3900 is configured with RFUs only.

Table 1-6 Power requirements in AC input scenarios configured with RFUs only
Power Number of Minimum Requirements for Cable Length
Supply PSUs Requireme the Input Power Requirement
nt for Cable
Circuit
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x40 A/3 P Cable with a black ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


three- jacket and four
phase 2 or 3 1x25 A/3 P core wires, two
insulation layers,
and a cross-
sectional area of
6 mm2 (0.0093 in.
2)

220 V AC 5 1x100 A/1 Two wires (L and


single- P N), each with a
phase (recommen single core wire,
ded) two insulation
layers, and a
4 1x80 A/1 P cross-sectional
3 1x63 A/1 P area of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 52


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

AC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


The power requirements of a BTS3900 supplied with AC power are the same as
those of the IMS06. The following table lists the power requirements when a
BTS3900 is configured with RFUs and RRUs.

Table 1-7 Power requirements in AC input scenarios configured with RFUs and
RRUs

Power Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Supply Configurati Requireme Area of the Input Requirement
on nt for Power Cable
Circuit
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC ● 6 RRUs 1x100 A/1 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


single- (400 W < P 2)
phase power
consumpt
220 V AC ion per 1x40 A/3 P 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.
three- RRU ≤ 2)
phase 560 W)
● 3 RRUs
(power
consumpt
ion per
RRU ≤
400 W)

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs Only


The following table lists the power requirements when -48 V DC power is supplied
to a BTS3900 configured with RFUs only.

Table 1-8 Power requirements of a base station configured with RFUs only

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 4 to 6 high- 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


power RFUs default) 2)

● 2 BBUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 53


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2) (low smoke

zero halogen)

● 4 to 6 low- 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2)

● 1 BBU

● 4 to 6 low- 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


power RFUs 2)

● 2 BBUs
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2)

● 1 to 3 high- 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


power RFUs 2)

● 2 BBUs
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2)

● 1 to 3 high- 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2)

● 1 BBU

● 1 to 3 low- 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2)

● 2 BBUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 54


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a BTS3900 is configured with RFUs and RRUs, a DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 can be
configured.
● The DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, BBUs, and fan assembly in the
cabinet. The power requirements in this scenario are the same as those in the
scenario where a base station is configured with RFUs only. For details, see
Table 1-8.
● The DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 provides power for RRUs and is configured as required.
Table 1-9 lists the power requirements of a DCDU-12B. Table 1-12 lists the
power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Table 1-10 lists the power
requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S. Table 1-11 lists the
power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 55


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-9 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 300 W)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 300 W)

4 to 6 RRUs (400 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables (low smoke zero
RRU ≤ 560 W) halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

1 to 3 RRUs (400 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 560 W)

4 to 6 RRUs (300 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 400 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (300 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 400 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables
W)
● 3 RRUs (300 W
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 56


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 400 halogen)
W)
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (400 W
groups of DC input power
< power
cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)

● 6 RRUs (400 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 560 halogen)
W)
2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (power
default) groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 400
W)

● 6 RRUs (300 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 560 halogen)
W)
2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (power
default) groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)

9 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 57


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

9 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per default) group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

Table 1-10 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-11 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 58


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-12 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(5) Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 59


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 60


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.1.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900 (Ver.C) and a
BTS3900 (Ver.D) supplied with different power. The power distribution scheme in a
BTS3900 (Ver.D_A), BTS3900 (Ver.D_B), or BTS3012 (Ver.D_Z) is the same as that
in a BTS3900 (Ver.D).

1.2.1.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.C) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for BTS3900 cabinets.

Power Distribution Scheme in AC Input Scenarios


The external power equipment supplies 220 V AC single-phase, 220 V AC three-
phase, or 110 V AC dual-live-wire power to a BTS3900 AC cabinet. The ETP48150-
A3 converts the AC power into -48 V DC power and then supplies the DC power to
a DCDU-11A. The DCDU-11A distributes the DC power to other components in the
cabinet. The following figure shows the power distribution scheme in this scenario.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a 220
V AC single-phase scenario, except that "L1", "L2", and "L3" input terminals do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 61


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-20 Power distribution scheme in AC input scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 62


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in DC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs but


Without RRUs
The external power equipment supplies -48 V DC power to the DCDU-11A in a
BTS3900 DC (-48 V) cabinet, and the DCDU-11A distributes the DC power to other
components in the cabinet. The following figure shows the power distribution
scheme in this scenario.

Figure 1-21 Power distribution scheme in DC input scenarios configured with


RFUs but without RRUs

Power Distribution Scheme in DC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs and


RRUs
● When a BTS3900 is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the external power
equipment supplies -48 V DC power to a DCDU-11A, and the DCDU-11A
distributes the DC power to the RFUs, BBU, and fan assembly in the cabinet.
The power distribution scheme in this scenario is the same as that for a
BTS3900 DC (-48 V) cabinet configured with RFUs but without RRUs. For
details, see Figure 1-21.
● The external power equipment provides -48 V DC power for a DCDU-11B, and
the DCDU-11B distributes the -48 V DC power to RRUs. The following figure
shows the power distribution scheme in this scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 63


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-22 Power distribution scheme in DC input scenarios configured with


RFUs and RRUs

1.2.1.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900 (Ver.D) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for BTS3900 cabinets.

Power Distribution Scheme in AC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs


Only
When a BTS3900 is configured with RFUs only, the external power equipment
provides 220 V AC single-phase or 220 V AC three-phase power for an EPU05A-02.
The EPU05A-02 converts the AC power into -48 V DC power and then supplies the
-48 V DC power to a DCDU-12A. Figure 1-23 shows the power distribution
scheme in this scenario.
The DCDU-12A distributes the DC power to the RFUs, BBU, and fan assembly in
the cabinet. Figure 1-25 shows the distribution schemes for the DCDU-12A.

NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a 220
V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be connected by
short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 64


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-23 Power distribution scheme in AC input scenarios configured with RFUs
only

Power Distribution Scheme in AC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs and


RRUs
When the BTS3900 is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the external power
equipment provides 220 V AC single-phase or 220 V AC three-phase power input
for the EPU05A-02. The EPU05A-02 converts the AC power into -48 V DC power
and then supplies the -48 V DC power to the DCDU-12A and DCDU-12B/EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02. Figure 1-24
shows the power distribution scheme in this scenario.
The DCDU-12A distributes the power to the RFUs, BBU, and fan assembly in the
cabinet. The DCDU-12B/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 distributes the DC power to RRUs. Figure 1-25, Figure 1-26,
Figure 1-27, and Figure 1-28 show the power distribution schemes for the
DCDU-12A, DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D/EPU02D-02,
respectively. Figure 1-29 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02B.
Figure 1-30 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S. Figure 1-31
shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a 220
V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be connected by
short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 65


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-24 Power distribution scheme in AC input scenarios configured with RFUs
and RRUs

Power Distribution Scheme in DC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs


Only
When the BTS3900 is configured with RFUs only, the external power equipment
provides -48 V DC power for the DCDU-12A in the BTS3900 DC (-48 V) cabinet
and the DCDU-12A distributes the -48 V DC power to the BBU, fan assembly, and
RFUs in the cabinet. The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for
the BTS3900 cabinet.

Figure 1-25 Power distribution scheme in DC input scenarios configured with


RFUs only

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 66


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in DC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs and


RRUs
● When a BTS3900 is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the external power
equipment supplies -48 V DC power to a DCDU-12A, and the DCDU-12A
distributes the DC power to the RFUs, BBU, and fan assembly in the cabinet.
The power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12A in this scenario is the same
as that for a DCDU-12A used by a BTS3900 DC (-48 V) cabinet configured
with RFUs only. For details, see Figure 1-25.
● A DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S
is configured as required. The external power equipment provides -48 V DC
power for a DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/
EPU02B/EPU02S, and the DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S distributes power to RRUs. Figure 1-26, Figure
1-27, and Figure 1-28 show the power distribution schemes for a DCDU-12B,
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D/EPU02D-02, respectively. Figure 1-29
shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02B. Figure 1-30 shows the
power distribution scheme for an EPU02S. Figure 1-31 shows the power
distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Figure 1-26 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU-12B in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

NOTE

Ports "LOAD0" to "LOAD5" on a DCDU-12B feed power to each RRU with power
consumption of less than or equal to 560 W, and ports "LOAD6" to "LOAD8" feed power to
each RRU with power consumption of less than or equal to 400 W.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 67


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-27 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 in a


scenario configured with RFUs and RRUs

Figure 1-28 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02D or EPU02D-02 in a scenario


configured with RFUs and RRUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 68


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-29 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02B in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

Figure 1-30 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02S in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 69


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-31 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02 in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


providing boosted-voltage and DC power outputs.

Table 1-13 Fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


Power Fuse Terminal Specifications
Equipmen
t

EPU02D Slot 1 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) -57 V boosted-voltage power


Slot 2 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) output: 6x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)

EPU02D-0 Slot 1 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) -57 V boosted-voltage power


2 Slot 2 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) output: 3x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(RRU)

The following table lists the circuit breaker or fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02 providing DC power outputs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 70


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-14 Circuit breaker/fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02


Power Equipment Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse

DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 -48 V DC power output: 3x50 A (RRU) (MCB)

-48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU/FAN/TM) (FUSE)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02B.

Table 1-15 Fuse specifications of an EPU02B


Power External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Equipmen Output Fuse
t

EPU02B -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)
-57 V DC power output: 6x30 A
(RRU)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02S.

Table 1-16 Fuse specifications of an EPU02S


Power External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Equipmen Output Fuse
t

EPU02S -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)
-57 V DC power output: 3x28 A
(RRU)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-17 Fuse specifications of an EPU02S-02


Power External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Equipmen Output Fuse
t

EPU02S-02 -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)
-57 V DC power output: 3x28 A
(RRU)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 71


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.1.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900


This section lists the reference sections in 3900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS3900.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS3900, see the following sections:
● BTS3900 (Ver.C): BTS3900 (Ver.C) Cable List
● BTS3900 (Ver.D): BTS3900 (Ver.D) Cable List

Cable Connections
For cable connections for a BTS3900, see topics related to Cable Connections in
3900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Table 1-18 Cable connections


Bas Power Monitorin Transmiss BBU CPRI RF Cable
e Cable g Signal ion Cable Interconn Cable Connecti
Sta Connecti Cable Connecti ection Connecti ons
tio ons Connecti ons Signal ons
n ons Cable
Connecti
ons

BTS BTS3900 BTS3900 Transmissi BBU CPRI RF Cable


390 (Ver.C) (Ver.C) on Cable Interconn Cable Connectio
0 Power Monitorin Connectio ection Connectio ns
(Ve Cable g Signal ns for Signal ns for
r.C) Connectio Cable 3900 Cable 3900
ns Connectio Series Connectio Series
ns Base ns Base
Stations Stations
BTS BTS3900 BTS3900
390 (Ver.D) (Ver.D)
0 Power Monitorin
(Ve Cable g Signal
r.D) Connectio Cable
ns Connectio
ns

1.2.2 BTS3900L
This section describes cabinets, cabinet applications, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, cables, and cable connections of a BTS3900L.

1.2.2.1 Cabinets and Subracks Used by a BTS3900L


The cabinets used by a BTS3900L, an indoor macro base station, can be classified
into the BTS3900L (Ver.C) and BTS3900L (Ver.D) in terms of cabinet versions.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 72


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

With the improvement in cabinet design, the BTS3900L cabinets can meet
different site requirements for power distribution, module configuration, and
space for customer equipment. The AC power can be used when the BTS3900L
(Ver.D) DC cabinet is stacked on an IMS06.

The following table lists the cabinets and subracks that are used by the BTS3900L
base stations.

Table 1-19 Cabinet/Subrack description

Base Station Cabinet/ Cabinet/Subrack Cabinet/Subrack


Subrack Description Configuration
Name

BTS3900L BTS3900L This cabinet For details, see


(Ver.C) (Ver.C) provides space for Components in BTS3900L
the RFUs, BBU, Cabinets.
fan assembly,
power equipment,
and customer
equipment. Only
-48 V DC power
input is
supported.

BTS3900L BTS3900L This cabinet For details, see


(Ver.D) (Ver.D) provides space for Components in BTS3900L
the RFUs, BBU, Cabinets.
fan assembly,
power equipment,
and customer
equipment. This
cabinet can be
divided into the
following types
based on the
configured power
equipment:
● BTS3900L DC
cabinet
● BTS3900L AC
cabinet

IMS06 The IMS06 houses For details, see


power equipment. Components in IMS06s.
The BTS3900L
base station uses
AC power when a
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
DC cabinet is
stacked upon the
IMS06.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 73


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following figure shows the exteriors of a BTS3900L (Ver.C) cabinet, a


BTS3900L (Ver.D) cabinet, and an IMS06.

Figure 1-32 Cabinet/Subrack exteriors

The BTS3900L (Ver.B) cabinet can be restructured to have the same capability as
the BTS3900L (Ver.D) DC cabinet, as listed in the following table.

Table 1-20 Restructured cabinets


Base Station Cabinet Cabinet Cabinet Configuration
Name Description

BTS3900L BTS3900L Restructured from For details, see BTS3900L


(Ver.E_B~D) (Ver.E_B~D) a BTS3900L Installation Guide for
(Ver.B), BTS3900L Enhancing Existing Cabinets
(Ver.C), or (Ver.E Series).
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
cabinet

BTS3900L BTS3900L Restructured from For details, see BTS3900L


(Ver.D_B) (Ver.D_B) a BTS3900L Installation Guide for
(Ver.B) cabinet Enhancing Existing Cabinets
(Ver.D Series).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 74


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.2.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900L


A BTS3900L cabinet can meet different requirements for RF module configurations
and spaces for customer equipment. A BTS3900L can be configured with RFUs but
without RRUs or configured with RFUs and RRUs depending on different scenarios.

1.2.2.2.1 BTS3900L (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


This section describes scenarios where the BTS3900L (Ver.C) is configured with
RFUs but without RRUs. In these scenarios, the BTS3900L (Ver.C) can be
configured with one or multiple BBUs.
A BTS3900L can be configured with only one cabinet.
The following table describes the scenarios where the BTS3900L is configured with
RFUs but without RRUs.
Numbe Application Mode Maximum Illustration
r of Number of
BBUs RF Modules

1 Single-, dual-, triple-, 12 RFUs The cabinet application is


and quadruple-mode shown by illustration 1 in
base stations the following figure.

2 Triple- and quadruple- 12 RFUs The cabinet application is


mode base stations shown by illustration 2 in
the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 75


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-33 BTS3900L

1.2.2.2.2 BTS3900L (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


This section describes scenarios where the BTS3900L (Ver.D) is configured with
RFUs but without RRUs. In these scenarios, the base station can be configured
with one or multiple BBUs.

Scenarios Where the BTS3900L Uses BTS3900L Cabinets Only


The following table lists the application scenarios where the BTS3900L uses one
BTS3900L cabinet and is configured with RFUs but without RRUs.

Cabinet Num Application Mode Maximum Illustration


Type ber of Number of
BBUs RF
Modules

BTS3900L 1 Single-, dual-, 12 RFUs The cabinet


DC cabinet quadruple-, and application is shown
triple-mode base by illustration 1 in
stations Figure 1-34.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 76


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Num Application Mode Maximum Illustration


Type ber of Number of
BBUs RF
Modules

2 Triple- and 12 RFUs The cabinet


quadruple-mode application is shown
base stations by illustration 2 in
Figure 1-34.

BTS3900L 1 Single-, dual-, 12 RFUs The cabinet


AC cabinet quadruple-, and application is shown
triple-mode base by illustration 1 in
stations Figure 1-35.

2 Triple- and 12 RFUs The cabinet


quadruple-mode application is shown
base stations by illustration 2 in
Figure 1-35.

NOTICE

An IMS06 cannot be stacked on a BTS3900L cabinet. Otherwise, the heat


dissipation holes on the top of the BTS3900L cabinet will be blocked.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 77


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-34 One BTS3900L DC cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 78


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-35 One BTS3900L AC cabinet (one BTS3900L DC cabinet+one IMS06)

Scenarios Where the BTS3900L Uses a BTS3900L Cabinet and an IMS06


The following table lists the application scenarios where the BTS3900L uses a
BTS3900L DC cabinet and an IMS06 and is configured with RFUs but without
RRUs.
Cabinet Num Application Maximum Illustration
Type ber of Mode Number of
BBUs RF Modules

1 BTS3900L 1 Single-, dual-, 12 RFUs The cabinet


DC cabinet and triple-mode application is shown
+1 IMS06 base stations by illustration 1 in
Figure 1-35.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 79


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Num Application Maximum Illustration


Type ber of Mode Number of
BBUs RF Modules

2 Triple-mode 12 RFUs The cabinet


base station application is shown
by illustration 2 in
Figure 1-35.

NOTE

● A BTS3900L DC cabinet stacked on an IMS06 comprises an AC base station.


● The IMS06 houses an EPU05A-02 that provides DC power for components in the
BTS3900L cabinet stacked on the IMS06.

1.2.2.2.3 BTS3900L (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs and RRUs


This section describes scenarios where the BTS3900L (Ver.C) is configured with
RFUs and RRUs. In these scenarios, the BTS3900L (Ver.C) can be configured with
one or multiple BBUs.
A BTS3900L can be configured with only one cabinet.
The following table describes the scenarios where the BTS3900L is configured with
RFUs and RRUs.
Numb Application Mode Maximum Illustration
er of Number of RF
BBUs Modules

1 Single-, dual-, 12 RFUs+6 RRUs The cabinet application is


triple-, and shown in Figure 1-36.
quadruple-mode
base stations

2 Triple- and 12 RFUs+6 RRUs The cabinet application is


quadruple-mode shown in Figure 1-37.
base stations

When a BTS3900L (Ver.C) is configured with RFUs and RRUs, a DCDU-11B is


installed on a wall to distribute power to the RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 80


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-36 BTS3900L configured with one BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 81


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-37 BTS3900L configured with two BBUs

1.2.2.2.4 BTS3900L (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs and RRUs


This section describes scenarios where the BTS3900L (Ver.D) is configured with
RFUs and RRUs. In these scenarios, the base station can be configured with one or
multiple BBUs.
A BTS3900L can be configured with only one cabinet.
The following table describes the scenarios where the BTS3900L is configured with
RFUs and RRUs.
Numb Application Mode Maximum Illustration
er of Number of
BBUs RF Modules

1 Single-, dual-, triple-, and 12 RFUs+6 The cabinet application is


quadruple-mode base RRUs shown in Figure 1-38.
stations

2 Triple- and quadruple- 12 RFUs+9 The cabinet application is


mode base stations RRUs shown in Figure 1-39.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 82


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When a BTS3900L (Ver.D) is configured with RFUs and RRUs, a DCDU-12B/


DCDU16D/EPU02D/EPU02D-02 is installed at the third 1 U space for customer
equipment at the bottom of a cabinet to distribute power to RRUs.

NOTE

An EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 is configured
based on site requirements. For configuration principles, see "EPU02B", "EPU02S",
"EPU02S-02", "DCDU16D", "DCDU16D-02", and "EPU02D/EPU02D-02". The installation
position of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 in
a cabinet is the same as that of a DCDU-12B. This section uses a DCDU-12B as an example.

Figure 1-38 BTS3900L (Ver.D) configured with one BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 83


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-39 BTS3900L (Ver.D) configured with two BBUs

1.2.2.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a BTS3900L (Ver.C) and a
BTS3900L (Ver.D). The power requirements of a BTS3900L (Ver.D_B) are the same
as those of a BTS3900L (Ver.D).

1.2.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L (Ver.C)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

BTS3900L Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


The BTS3900L uses -48 V DC power input. The power requirements of the
BTS3900L configured with RFUs but without RRUs are listed in the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 84


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-21 Power requirements of a base station configured with RFUs but
without RRUs
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)(4)

● 7 to 12 high- 4x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


power RFUs default) 2), four groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As

2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 7 to 12 low- 4x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), four groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As

2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As

2x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As

● 1 to 6 high- 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs (3 2), two groups of
or less RFUs in DC input power
an RF subrack) cables
● 2 BBUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 85


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)(4)

● 1 to 6 high- 3x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), three groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As. One
DCDU-11A is
connected to two
circuit breakers
and the other
DCDU-11A is
connected to one
circuit breaker.

● 1 to 6 low- 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs (3 2), two groups of
or less RFUs in DC input power
an RF subrack) cables which are
● 2 BBUs connected to two
DCDU-11As

● 1 to 6 low- 3x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), three groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As. One
DCDU-11A is
connected to two
circuit breakers
and the other
DCDU-11A is
connected to one
circuit breaker.

2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-11As

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 86


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged
based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A,
100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

BTS3900L Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a BTS3900L is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the external power
equipment provides one -48 V DC power input for a DCDU-11A and one -48 V DC
power input for a DCDU-11B. For details about the power distribution scheme, see
1.2.2.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900L (Ver.C) Cabinets.

● The DCDU-11A provides power for the RFUs, BBU, and fan assembly in the
cabinet. When the DCDU-11A is powered by the external power equipment,
the power requirements in this scenario are the same as those in the scenario
where a base station is configured with RFUs but without RRUs, as listed in
Table 1-21.
● The DCDU-11B provides power for RRUs. The following table lists the power
requirements when the DCDU-11B is powered by the external power
equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 87


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-22 Power requirements of a base station configured with RFUs and RRUs
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 300 W)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 300 W)

4 to 6 RRUs (400 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables (low smoke zero
RRU ≤ 560 W) halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

1 to 3 RRUs (400 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 560 W)

4 to 6 RRUs (300 1x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power default) group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 400 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (300 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


W < power group of DC input power
consumption per cables
RRU ≤ 400 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables
W)
● 3 RRUs (300 W
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 88


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
default) groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 400 halogen)
W)
2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (400 W
default) groups of DC input power
< power
cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 89


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the maximum configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 90


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).

1.2.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L (Ver.D)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The power requirements of a BTS3900L supplied with AC power are the same as
those of the IMS06. The following table lists the power requirements when a
BTS3900L is configured with RFUs only.

Table 1-23 Power requirements in AC input scenarios configured with RFUs only

Power Number of Minimum Requirements for Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requireme the Input Power Requirement
nt for Cable
Circuit
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x40 A/3 P Cable with a black ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


three- jacket and four
phase 2 or 3 1x25 A/3 P core wires, two
insulation layers,
and a cross-
sectional area of
6 mm2 (0.0093 in.
2)

220 V AC 5 1x100 A/1 Two wires (L and


single- P N), each with a
phase (recommen single core wire,
ded) two insulation
layers, and a
4 1x80 A/1 P cross-sectional
3 1x63 A/1 P area of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 91


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs Only


The BTS3900L uses -48 V DC power input. The power requirements of the
BTS3900L configured with RFUs only are listed in the following table.

Table 1-24 Power requirements of a base station configured with RFUs only
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)(4)

● 7 to 12 high- 4x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


power RFUs default) 2), four groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As

2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 7 to 12 low- 4x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), four groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As

2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As

2x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 92


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)(4)

● 1 to 6 high- 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs (3 2), two groups of
or less RFUs in DC input power
an RF subrack) cables which are
● 2 BBUs connected to two
DCDU-12As

● 1 to 6 high- 3x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), three groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables, which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As. One
DCDU-12A is
connected to two
circuit breakers,
and the other
DCDU-12A is
connected to one
circuit breaker.

● 1 to 6 low- 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs (3 2), two groups of
or less RFUs in DC input power
an RF subrack) cables which are
● 2 BBUs connected to two
DCDU-12As

● 1 to 6 low- 3x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), three groups of

● 2 BBUs DC input power


cables, which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As. One
DCDU-12A is
connected to two
circuit breakers,
and the other
DCDU-12A is
connected to one
circuit breaker.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 93


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)(4)

2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables which are
connected to two
DCDU-12As

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged
based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A,
100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 94


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a BTS3900L is configured with RFUs and RRUs, a DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 can be
configured.
● The DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, BBU, and fan assembly in the
cabinet. When the DCDU-12A is powered by the external equipment, the
power requirements are the same as those in the scenario where a base
station is configured with RFUs only, as listed in Table 1-24.
● The DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 provides power for RRUs and is configured as required.
Table 1-25 lists the power requirements of a DCDU-12B. Power
requirements of a DCDU16D lists the power requirements of a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02. Table 1-26 lists the power requirements of an EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S. Table 1-27 lists the power requirements of an
EPU02S-02.

Table 1-25 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


(power 2),one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

4 to 6 RRUs (400 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

1 to 3 RRUs (400 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 95


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

4 to 6 RRUs (300 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

1 to 3 RRUs (300 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption 2), one group of
per RRU ≤ 300 DC input power
W) cables
● 3 RRUs (300 W
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


consumption 2), one group of
per RRU ≤ 300 DC input power
W) cables (low smoke
● 3 RRUs (400 W zero halogen)
< power
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption
2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 560
W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


< power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 400 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
< power
2), two groups of
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560 DC input power
W) cables

● 6 RRUs (400 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


< power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 560 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 96


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)
● 3 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption default) 2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 400 DC input power
W) cables

● 6 RRUs (300 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


< power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 560 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 3 RRUs (power
2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption
default) 2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 300
W) DC input power
cables

9 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

9 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per default) 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 300 W) DC input power
cables

Table 1-26 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S

Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 97


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-27 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-28 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(5) Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 98


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(5) Circuit Breakers (4) Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 99


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the maximum configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 100


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.2.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900L


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900L (Ver.C) and a
BTS3900L (Ver.D). The power distribution scheme in a BTS3900L (Ver.D_B) is the
same as that in a BTS3900L (Ver.D).

1.2.2.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900L (Ver.C) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for BTS3900L cabinets.

Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900L Cabinet Configured with RFUs


but Without RRUs
The external power equipment provides -48 V DC power for the DCDU-11A in a
BTS3900L cabinet, and the DCDU-11A distributes the -48 V DC power to the BBU,
fan assembly, and RFUs in the cabinet. The following figure shows the power
distribution scheme in this scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 101


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-40 Power distribution scheme for a BTS3900L cabinet configured with
RFUs but without RRUs

Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900L Cabinet Configured with RFUs


and RRUs
● When a BTS3900L is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the external power
equipment supplies -48 V DC power to a DCDU-11A. The DCDU-11A
distributes the -48 V DC power to the BBU, fan assembly, and RFUs in the
cabinet. The power distribution scheme for the DCDU-11A in this scenario is
the same as that in the scenario where a BTS3900L is configured with RFUs
but without RRUs, as shown in Figure 1-40.
● The external power equipment provides -48 V DC power for a DCDU-11B, and
the DCDU-11B distributes the -48 V DC power to RRUs. The following figure
shows the power distribution scheme in this scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 102


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-41 Power distribution scheme for a BTS3900L cabinet configured with
RFUs and RRUs

1.2.2.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900L (Ver.D) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for BTS3900L cabinets.

Power Distribution Scheme in AC Input Scenarios


When a BTS3900L is configured with RFUs only, the external power equipment
provides 220 V AC single-phase or 220 V AC three-phase power for the EPU05A-02
in the IMS06. The EPU05A-02 converts the AC power into -48 V DC power and
then supplies the -48 V DC power to a DCDU-12A. Figure 1-42 shows the power
distribution scheme in this scenario.
The DCDU-12A supplies power to the BBU, fan assembly, and RFUs in the cabinet.
Figure 1-43 shows the power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12A.

NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 103


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-42 Power distribution scheme when 220 V AC single-phase power is


supplied

Power Distribution Scheme in DC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs


Only
The external power equipment provides -48 V DC power for the DCDU-12A in a
BTS3900L cabinet, and the DCDU-12A distributes the -48 V DC power to the BBU,
fan assembly, and RFUs in the cabinet. The following figure shows the power
distribution scheme for a BTS3900L cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 104


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-43 Power distribution scheme for a BTS3900L cabinet configured with
RFUs only

Power Distribution Scheme in DC Input Scenarios Configured with RFUs and


RRUs
● When a BTS3900L is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the external power
equipment provides -48 V DC power input for the DCDU-12A. The DCDU-12A
distributes the -48 V DC power to the BBU, fan assembly, and RFUs in the
cabinet. The power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12A in this scenario is
the same as that in the scenario where a BTS3900L is configured with RFUs
only, as shown in Figure 1-43.
● A DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/
EPU02S-02 is configured as required. The external power equipment provides
-48 V DC power for a DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02, and the DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 distributes

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 105


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

power to RRUs. Figure 1-26, Figure 1-45, and Figure 1-46 show the power
distribution schemes for a DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D/
EPU02D-02, respectively. Figure 1-47 shows the power distribution scheme
for an EPU02B. Figure 1-48 shows the power distribution scheme for an
EPU02S. Figure 1-49 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Figure 1-44 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU-12B in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

NOTE

Ports "LOAD0" to "LOAD5" on a DCDU-12B feed power to each RRU with power
consumption of less than or equal to 560 W, and ports "LOAD6" to "LOAD8" feed power to
each RRU with power consumption of less than or equal to 400 W.

Figure 1-45 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 in a


scenario configured with RFUs and RRUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 106


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-46 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02D or EPU02D-02 in a scenario


configured with RFUs and RRUs

Figure 1-47 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02B in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 107


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-48 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02S in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

Figure 1-49 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02 in a scenario configured


with RFUs and RRUs

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


providing boosted-voltage and DC power outputs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 108


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-29 Fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


Power Fuse Terminal Specifications
Equipmen
t

EPU02D Slot 1 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) -57 V boosted-voltage power


Slot 2 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) output: 6x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)

EPU02D-0 Slot 1 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) -57 V boosted-voltage power


2 Slot 2 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) output: 3x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(RRU)

The following table lists the circuit breaker or fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02 providing DC power outputs.

Table 1-30 Circuit breaker/fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02


Power Equipment Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse

DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 -48 V DC power output: 3x50 A (RRU) (MCB)

-48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU/FAN/TM) (FUSE)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02B.

Table 1-31 Fuse specifications of an EPU02B


Power External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Equipmen Output Fuse
t

EPU02B -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)
-57 V DC power output: 6x30 A
(RRU)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02S.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 109


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-32 Fuse specifications of an EPU02S


Power External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Equipmen Output Fuse
t

EPU02S -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)
-57 V DC power output: 3x28 A
(RRU)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-33 Fuse specifications of an EPU02S-02


Power External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Equipmen Output Fuse
t

EPU02S-02 -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)
-57 V DC power output: 3x28 A
(RRU)

1.2.2.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900L


This section lists the reference sections in 3900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS3900L.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS3900L, see the following sections:
● BTS3900L (Ver.C): BTS3900L (Ver.C) Cable List
● BTS3900L (Ver.D): BTS3900L (Ver.D) Cable List

Cable Connections
For cable connections in a BTS3900L, see topics related to cable connections in
3900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the links to these topics.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 110


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-34 Cable connections


Base Power Monitori Transmi BBU CPRI RF
Station Cable ng Signal ssion Intercon Cable Cable
Connection Cable Cable nection Connect Connect
s Connecti Connect Signal ions ions
ons ions Cable
Connect
ions

BTS3900 BTS3900L BTS3900L Transmis BBU CPRI RF Cable


L (Ver.C) (Ver.C) (Ver.C) sion Intercon Cable Connecti
Power Cable Monitorin Cable nection Connecti ons
Connections g Signal Connecti Signal ons for
Cable ons for Cable 3900
Connectio 3900 Connecti Series
ns Series ons Base
Base Stations
BTS3900 BTS3900L BTS3900L Stations
L (Ver.D) (Ver.D) (Ver.D)
Power Cable Monitorin
Connections g Signal
Cable
Connectio
ns

1.2.3 BTS3900A
This section describes cabinets, cabinet applications, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, cables, and cable connections of a BTS3900A.

1.2.3.1 Cabinets Used by a BTS3900A


The BTS3900A is an outdoor separated macro base station, and it can be
constituted of cabinets with different functions.
With the improvement in cabinet design, Huawei has many types of cabinets
applicable to a BTS3900A. These cabinets meet the requirements of power
distribution, module configuration, and space for customer equipment, as
described in the following table.
NOTE

In this section, BTS3900A (Ver.C), BTS3900A (Ver.D), or BTS3900A (Ver.E) refers to the BTS3900A
whose cabinets are all of Ver.B, Ver.C, Ver.D, or Ver.E.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 111


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-35 Cabinets constituting a BTS3900A


Base Cabinet Name Cabinet Description
Statio
n

BTS39 APM30H (Ver.C), TMC11H ● The APM30Ha provides power


00A (Ver.C), RFC (Ver.C), IBBS200D for components in it and to
(Ver.C) (Ver.C), and IBBS200T (Ver.C) other cabinets in AC scenarios.
BTS39 APM30H (Ver.D), TMC11H ● The TMC11Hb can serve as a
00A (Ver.D), RFC (Ver.D), IBBS200D power cabinet in DC scenarios
(Ver.D) (Ver.D), IBBS200T (Ver.D), or as a transmission cabinet
IBBS700D, IBBS700T, IBBS300D based on the transmission
(Ver.A), and IBBS300T (Ver.A) space requirements.
● The IBBS/BBCc is a battery
BTS39 APM30H (Ver.E), TMC11H (Ver.E), cabinet that provides backup
00A RFC (Ver.E), IBBS200D (Ver.E), power for a site.
(Ver.E) IBBS200T (Ver.E), IBBS300D
(Ver.A), BBC5200D-L, and ● The RFCd houses RFUs.
IBBS300T (Ver.A)

a. APM30H: advanced power module with heat exchanger


b. TMC11H: transmission cabinet with heat exchanger
c. IBBS200T/IBBS300T/IBBS700T: integrated backup battery system with TEC;
IBBS200D/IBBS300D/IBBS700D: integrated backup battery system with direct
ventilation
d. RFC: radio frequency cabinet

Cabinet Exteriors
Figure 1-50 and Figure 1-51 show the common combinations of cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 112


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-50 Exteriors of cabinets used by the BTS3900A (Ver.C)

A: BTS3900A (Ver.C) in AC scenarios without B: BTS3900A (Ver.C) in AC scenarios with


backup power or in DC scenarios backup power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 113


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-51 Exteriors of cabinets used by BTS3900As (Ver.D)

A: BTS3900A (Ver.D) in AC scenarios without B: BTS3900A (Ver.D) in AC scenarios with


backup power or in DC scenarios backup power provided by the IBBS200Ds

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 114


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

C: BTS3900A (Ver.D) in AC scenarios with D: BTS3900A (Ver.D) in AC scenarios with


backup power provided by the IBBS300Ds backup power provided by the IBBS700D

Figure 1-52 Exteriors of cabinets used by BTS3900As (Ver.E)

A: BTS3900A (Ver.E) in AC scenarios without B: BTS3900A (Ver.E) in AC scenarios with


backup power or in DC scenarios backup power provided by the IBBS200Ds

C: BTS3900A (Ver.E) in AC scenarios with -


backup power provided by the IBBS300Ds

Cabinet Introduction
The following table lists cabinets applicable to the BTS3900A and the cabinet
configuration for reference.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 115


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-36 APM30H, TMC11H, IBBS, and RFC series cabinets


Cabinet Type Cabinet Name Cabinet Configuration

APM30H ● APM30H (Ver.C) ● For details, see Components in


series cabinets ● APM30H (Ver.D) APM30Hs.
● APM30H (Ver.E)

TMC11H series ● TMC11H (Ver.C) ● For details, see Components in


cabinets ● TMC11H (Ver.D) TMC11Hs.
● TMC11H (Ver.E)

IBBS series ● IBBS700D and ● For details, see Components in an


cabinets IBBS700T IBBS700D and Components in an
● IBBS200D (Ver.C) IBBS700T.
and IBBS200T ● For details, see Components in
(Ver.C) IBBS200Ds and Components in
● IBBS200D (Ver.D) IBBS200Ts.
and IBBS200T ● For details, see Components in
(Ver.D) IBBS200Ds and Components in
● IBBS200D (Ver.E) IBBS200Ts.
and IBBS200T ● For details, see Components in
(Ver.E) IBBS200Ds and Components in
● IBBS300D (Ver.A) IBBS200Ts.
and IBBS300T ● For details, see Components in
(Ver.A) IBBS200Ds and Components in
IBBS200Ts.
● For details, see Components in
IBBS300Ds and Components in
IBBS300Ts.

BBC series ● BBC5200D-L ● For details, see Components in a


cabinets BBC5200D-L.

RFC series ● RFC (Ver.C) ● For details, see Components in RFCs.


cabinets ● RFC (Ver.D)
● RFC (Ver.E)

Besides the preceding cabinets, some cabinets of earlier versions can be


restructured to have the same capability as Ver.D or Ver.E cabinets. The following
table describes such cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 116


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-37 Reused cabinets


Base Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Cabinet Configuration
Statio
n

BTS39 APM30H Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A


00A (Ver.D_C) APM30H (Ver.C) Installation Guide for
(Ver.D_ Enhancing Existing
C) TMC11H Restructured from the Cabinets (Ver.D Series)
(Ver.D_C) TMC11H (Ver.C) and IBBS Installation
IBBS200D Restructured from the Guide for Reconstructing
(Ver.D_C) and IBBS200D (Ver.C) and Existing Cabinets to Use
IBBS200T IBBS200T (Ver.C) Lithium Batteries.
(Ver.D_C)

IBBS200D Restructured from the


(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.B),
and IBBS200T IBBS200D (Ver.C),
(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.D), and
IBBS200D (Ver.E)

RFC (Ver.D_C) Restructured from the


RFC (Ver.C)

BTS39 APM30H Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A


00A (Ver.D_B) APM30H (Ver.B) Installation Guide for
(Ver.D_ Enhancing Existing
B) TMC11H Restructured from the Cabinets (Ver.D Series)
(Ver.D_B) TMC11H (Ver.B) and IBBS Installation
IBBS200D Restructured from the Guide for Reconstructing
(Ver.D_B) and IBBS200D (Ver.B) and Existing Cabinets to Use
IBBS200T IBBS200T (Ver.B) Lithium Batteries.
(Ver.D_B)

IBBS200D Restructured from the


(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.B),
and IBBS200T IBBS200D (Ver.C),
(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.D), and
IBBS200D (Ver.E)

RFC (Ver.D_B) Restructured from the


RFC (Ver.B)

BTS39 APM30H Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A


00A (Ver.D_A2) APM30H (Ver.A) Installation Guide for
(Ver.D_ Enhancing Existing
A2) Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
TMC11H Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A
(Ver.D_A2) TMC11H (Ver.A) Installation Guide for
Enhancing Existing
Cabinets (Ver.D Series).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 117


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Base Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Cabinet Configuration


Statio
n

IBBS200T Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A


(Ver.D_A2) IBBS200T (Ver.A) Installation Guide for
Enhancing Existing
Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
IBBS200D Restructured from the For details, see IBBS
(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.B), Installation Guide for
and IBBS200T IBBS200D (Ver.C), Reconstructing Existing
(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.D), and Cabinets to Use Lithium
IBBS200D (Ver.E) Batteries.
RFC (Ver.D_A) Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A
RFC (Ver.A) Installation Guide for
Enhancing Existing
Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
BTS39 APM30 Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A
00A (Ver.D_A1) APM30 (with Installation Guide for
(Ver.D_ breathable film) Enhancing Existing
A1) Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
TMC Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A
(Ver.D_A1) TMC (with breathable Installation Guide for
film) Enhancing Existing
Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
BBC (Ver.D_A1) Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A
BBC Installation Guide for
Enhancing Existing
Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
RFC (Ver.D_A) Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A
RFC Installation Guide for
Enhancing Existing
Cabinets (Ver.D Series).
IBBS200D Restructured from the For details, see IBBS
(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.B), Installation Guide for
and IBBS200T IBBS200D (Ver.C), Reconstructing Existing
(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.D), and Cabinets to Use Lithium
IBBS200D (Ver.E) Batteries.
BTS39 APM30H Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A
00A (Ver.E_B~D) APM30H (Ver.B), Installation Guide for
(Ver.E_ APM30H (Ver.C), and Enhancing Existing
B~D) APM30H (Ver.D) Cabinets (Ver.E Series) and
IBBS Installation Guide for
TMC11H Restructured from the Reconstructing Existing
(Ver.E_B~D) TMC11H (Ver.B), Cabinets to Use Lithium
TMC11H (Ver.C), and Batteries.
TMC11H (Ver.D)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 118


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Base Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Cabinet Configuration


Statio
n

IBBS200D Restructured from the


(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.B),
and IBBS200T IBBS200D (Ver.C),
(Ver.F_B~E) IBBS200D (Ver.D), and
IBBS200D (Ver.E)

RFC Restructured from the


(Ver.E_B~D) RFC (Ver.B), RFC (Ver.C),
and RFC (Ver.D)

BTS39 APM30H Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A


00A (Ver.E_A2) APM30H (Ver.A) Installation Guide for
(Ver.E_ Enhancing Existing
A2) TMC11H Restructured from the Cabinets (Ver.E Series).
(Ver.E_A2) TMC11H (Ver.A)

IBBS200T Restructured from the


(Ver.E_A2) IBBS200T (Ver.A)

RFC (Ver.E_A2) Restructured from the


RFC (Ver.A)

BTS39 APM30 Restructured from the For details, see BTS3900A


00A (Ver.E_A1) APM30 (with Installation Guide for
(Ver.E_ breathable film) Enhancing Existing
A1) Cabinets (Ver.E Series).
TMC Restructured from the
(Ver.E_A1) TMC (with breathable
film)

BBC (Ver.E_A1) Restructured from the


BBC

RFC (Ver.E_A1) Restructured from the


RFC

BTS30 BTS3012AE Restructured from the For details, see BTS3012AE


12AE (Ver.D_Z) BTS3012AE (Ver.D_Z) Installation
(Ver.D_ Guide.
Z)

1.2.3.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900A


Various cabinets can be configured for a BTS3900A to meet different requirements
for RF module configurations, backup power capacity, and spaces for customer
equipment. A BTS3900A can be configured with RFUs but without RRUs or
configured with RFUs and RRUs depending on different scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 119


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.3.2.1 BTS3900A (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


When a BTS3900A is configured with RFUs but without RRUs, different cabinet
configurations can be used for the BTS3900A supplied with 110 V AC, 220 V AC, or
-48 V DC power in single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode scenarios.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


Maximum configuration principles for a single site
● A BTS3900A site can be configured with a maximum of 12 RFUs. If there are
more than 12 RFUs, one or more sites must be added.
● A BTS3900A site can be configured with a maximum of two cabinet
combinations (one cabinet combination consists of one APM30H/TMC11H
and one RFC). The two cabinet combinations must be installed side by side
with a clearance of 40 mm between them.
● An APM30H can be configured with an RFC and a maximum of two
IBBS200Ds or IBBS200Ts.
Principles for stacking and combining cabinets
● An IBBS200D or IBBS200T can be stacked only with an IBBS200D, IBBS200T, or
TMC11H. When being stacked with a TMC11H, an IBBS200D or IBBS200T
must be placed under the TMC11H.
● The RFC can be stacked only below the APM30H or TMC11H.
● If auxiliary cabinets, such as the IBBS200D, IBBS200T, or TMC11H, are required
during initial site deployment, the auxiliary cabinets are positioned on the left,
and the basic cabinets are positioned on the right. If both a battery cabinet
and a transmission cabinet are required, the battery cabinet is positioned on
the left side of the basic cabinet, and the transmission cabinet is stacked on
the battery cabinet or positioned on the left side of the battery cabinet.
● During initial site deployment, space must be reserved for capacity expansion
in the future. Unless otherwise stated, new cabinets are added to the right
side of original cabinets for capacity expansion and the original cabinets are
not relocated. In a special scenario, new cabinets can be added to the left side
of original cabinets.

Cabinet Configurations of a Single- or Dual-Mode Base Station


A single- or dual-mode base station can be configured with only one BBU, which
is installed in the APM30H. When 7 to 12 RFUs are configured, two APM30Hs are
required. The BBU is installed in the basic APM30H, which is on the left.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station in
the case of different spaces for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 120


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-53 Cabinet configurations of a base station without backup power

When backup power is provided by one battery cabinet in the initial configuration
of a site, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station in the
case of different spaces for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 121


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-54 Cabinet configurations of a base station where the number of battery
cabinets is the same as that of APM30Hs

When backup power is provided by two battery cabinets in the initial


configuration of a site, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 122


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-55 Cabinet configurations of a base station where the number of battery
cabinets is twice that of APM30Hs

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


single- or dual-mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer
equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 123


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-56 Cabinet configurations of a base station in -48 V DC scenarios

NOTE

The preceding figure shows two configurations of 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs: (A) and (B). (A)
refers to the initial configuration of 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC expanded to 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs. (B)
refers to the initial configuration of 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station with different backup power requirements, requirements on space for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-38 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Power Backup Space for RF Module Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power
AC ≤ 12 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs

≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 124


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for RF Module Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

≤ 23 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+1


TMC11H

The ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


number of IBBS200D/IBBS200T
battery
cabinets is ≤ 12 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+2
the same IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
as that of ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
APM30Hs IBBS200D/IBBS200T+1
in the TMC11H
initial
configurati ≤ 23 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+2
on IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
TMC11H

The ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


number of IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
battery
cabinets is ≤ 12 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+4
two times IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
that of ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
APM30Hs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
in the TMC11H
initial
configurati ≤ 23 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+4
on IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
TMC11H

-48 V DC - ≤9U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 TMC11H+1 RFC

≤ 12 RFUs 1 TMC11H+2 RFCs

≤ 20 U ≤ 6 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC

≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs

Cabinet Configurations of a Triple-Mode Base Station


The principles for configuring a triple-mode base station cabinet are as follows:
● A single cabinet combination of APM30H+RFC supports only one BBU. A
triple-mode base station can be configured with one or two BBUs. When two
BBUs are required, the second BBU must be configured in the second
combination of APM30H+RFC. This principle applies to a new or expansion
scenario.
● Two BBUs (BBU 0 and BBU 1) are configured for a triple-mode base station.
BBU 0 is installed in the basic APM30H or TMC11H, which is on the left side.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 125


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU 1 is installed in the extension APM30H or TMC11H, which is on the right


side.
● A triple-mode base station can be configured with only one BBU, which is
installed in the position of BBU 0 in the following figure.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a triple-mode base station in the case
of different spaces for customer equipment are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-57 Cabinet configurations of a triple-mode base station when backup


power is not required

When backup power is provided by two battery cabinets, the cabinet


configurations of a triple-mode base station in the case of different spaces for
customer equipment are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-58 Cabinet configurations of a triple-mode base station when backup


power is provided by two battery cabinets

When backup power is provided by four battery cabinets, the cabinet


configurations of a triple-mode base station in the case of different spaces for
customer equipment are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 126


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-59 Cabinet configurations of a triple-mode base station when backup


power is provided by four battery cabinets

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


triple-mode base station are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-60 Cabinet configurations of a triple-mode base station in -48 V DC


scenarios

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple-mode base station
with different backup power requirements, requirements on space for customer
equipment, and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 127


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-39 Cabinet configurations of a triple-mode base station


Power Backup Space for RF Module Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤ 10 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs


or 220 V power
AC ≤ 21 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+1
TMC11H

Backup ≤ 10 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+2


power IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided
by two ≤ 21 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+2
battery IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
cabinets TMC11H

Backup ≤ 10 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+4


power IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided
by four ≤ 21 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 APM30Hs+2 RFCs+4
battery IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
cabinets TMC11H

-48 V DC - ≤ 18 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs

1.2.3.2.2 BTS3900A (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


When a BTS3900A is configured with RFUs but without RRUs, different cabinet
configurations can be used for the BTS3900A supplied with 110 V AC, 220 V AC, or
-48 V DC power in single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode scenarios.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


Maximum configuration principles for a single site
● A BTS3900A can be configured with a maximum of 12 RFUs.
● A BTS3900A can be configured with a maximum of two cabinet combinations
(one cabinet combination consists of one APM30H and one RFC). The two
cabinet combinations must be installed side by side with a clearance of 40
mm (1.57 in.) between them.
● When a site is configured with more than six RFUs and only one IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T, the IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T
must be configured with at least two battery packs consisting of 100 Ah
batteries to avoid overcurrent of a single battery pack during discharging.
Principles for stacking and combining cabinets
● An IBBS200D/IBBS200T can be stacked only with an IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
TMC11H. When being stacked with a TMC11H, an IBBS200D/IBBS200T must
be placed under the TMC11H. When two IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts are stacked,
an IBBS200D/IBBS200T can only be stacked on another cabinet of the same
type. An IBBS200D cannot be stacked with an IBBS200T.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 128


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● An IBBS300D/IBBS300T can be stacked only with an IBBS300D/IBBS300T/


TMC11H. When being stacked with a TMC11H, an IBBS300D/IBBS300T must
be placed under the TMC11H. When two IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts are stacked,
an IBBS300D/IBBS300T can only be stacked on another cabinet of the same
type. An IBBS300D cannot be stacked with an IBBS300T.
● An IBBS200D or IBBS200T cannot be used together with an IBBS300D or
IBBS300T.
● An RFC can be stacked only under an APM30H or TMC11H.
● If auxiliary cabinets, such as the battery cabinet IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T or transmission cabinet TMC11H, are required during
initial site deployment, the auxiliary cabinets are positioned on the left side of
basic cabinets. If both a battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are
required, the battery cabinet is positioned on the left side of the basic cabinet,
and the transmission cabinet is stacked on the battery cabinet or positioned
on the left side of the battery cabinet.
● During initial site deployment, space must be reserved for capacity expansion
in the future. Unless otherwise stated, new cabinets are added to the right
side of original cabinets for capacity expansion and the original cabinets are
not relocated. In a special scenario, new cabinets can be added to the left side
of original cabinets.
● A cabinet combination of one APM30H and one RFC is configured with one
BBU by default. This cabinet combination can be configured with a maximum
of two BBUs, and the power consumption of all BBU boards cannot exceed
1000 W. This principle applies to new site deployment or capacity expansion.

Cabinet Configurations of a Single- or Dual-Mode Base Station


A single- or dual-mode base station is configured with only one BBU, which is
installed in the APM30H or TMC11H. When 7 to 12 RFUs need to be configured,
two RFCs are required.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station
with different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 129


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-61 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is not required

NOTE

The preceding figure shows two configurations: (A) and (B). (A) refers to the initial
configuration of 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1 TMC11H. (B) refers to the initial configuration of 1
APM30H+1 RFC+1 TMC11H expanded to 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1 TMC11H.

When backup power is provided by one battery cabinet, the cabinet configurations
of a single- or dual-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in Figure 1-62 and
Figure 1-63.
NOTE

IBBS in the following figure represents the IBBS200D/IBBS200T, and the IBBS300D/IBBS300T is
used when the base station needs to be configured with two battery cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 130


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-62 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is provided by one battery cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 131


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-63 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is provided by one IBBS700D/IBBS700T

When backup power is provided by two battery cabinets, the cabinet


configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station with different requirements
on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the
following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 132


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-64 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is provided by two battery cabinets

NOTE

The preceding figure shows two configurations: (A) and (B). (A) refers to the initial
configuration of 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts+1 TMC11H.
(B) refers to the initial configuration of 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts+1 TMC11H expanded to 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts+1 TMC11H.

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


single- or dual-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 133


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-65 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

NOTE

The preceding figure shows two configurations: (A) and (B). (A) refers to the initial
configuration of 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs. (B) refers to the initial configuration of 2 TMC11Hs+1
RFC expanded to 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station with different backup power requirements, requirements on space for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-40 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurati
Requirem Equipmen on
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power
AC ≤5U ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs

≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


TMC11H

≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 134


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurati
Requirem Equipmen on
ent t

Backup ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


power IBBS200D/IBBS200T
provided ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
by one IBBS700D/IBBS700T
battery
cabinet ≤5U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS200D/IBBS200T
● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T

≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


IBBS200D/IBBS200T+1
TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T+1
TMC11H

≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


IBBS200D/IBBS200T+1
TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T+1
TMC11H

Backup ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


power IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
by two IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
battery
cabinets ≤5U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
+1 TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
+1 TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 135


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurati
Requirem Equipmen on
ent t

-48 V DC - ≤9U ≤ 6 RFUs 1 TMC11H+1 RFC

≤ 12 RFUs 1 TMC11H+2 RFCs

≤ 20 U ≤ 6 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC

≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs

Cabinet Configurations of a Triple- or Quadruple-Mode Base Station


The principles for configuring a triple- or quadruple-mode base station are as
follows:
● When one BBU is configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
position of the BBU is indicated by BBU0 in the following figure.
● If two BBUs are configured during initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H, and transmission equipment is installed in a
TMC11H.
● During the capacity expansion, if there is space for a second BBU in the
APM30H, the BBU is installed in the APM30H. Otherwise, the BBU is installed
in a TMC11H.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base
station with different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in
the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 136


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-66 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is not required

When a site is configured with one battery cabinet, the cabinet configurations of a
triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment are shown in the following figure.
NOTE

IBBS in the following figure represents the IBBS200D/IBBS200T, and the IBBS300D/IBBS300T is
used when the base station needs to be configured with two battery cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 137


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-67 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is provided by one battery cabinet

When a site is configured with two battery cabinets, the cabinet configurations of
a triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 138


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-68 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is provided by two battery cabinets

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


triple- or quadruple-mode base station are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 139


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-69 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station in the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-41 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤3U ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs


or 220 V power
AC ≤ 14 U ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
TMC11H

Backup ≤3U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


power IBBS200D/IBBS200T
provided ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
by one IBBS700D/IBBS700T
battery
cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 140


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

≤ 14 U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


IBBS200D/IBBS200T+1
TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T+1
TMC11H

Backup ≤3U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


power IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
by two IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
battery
cabinets ≤ 14 U ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
+1 TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

-48 V DC - ≤7U ≤ 12 RFUs 1 TMC11H+2 RFCs

≤ 18 U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs

1.2.3.2.3 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E) Configured with RFUs but


Without RRUs
When a BTS3900A is configured with RFUs but without RRUs, different cabinet
configurations can be used for the BTS3900A supplied with 110 V AC, 220 V AC, or
-48 V DC power in single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode scenarios.

Cabinet Configuration Principles for a BTS3900A (Ver.E)


Maximum configuration principles for a single site
● A site can be configured with a maximum of 12 RFUs.
● Cabinets in a site must be installed side by side with a clearance of 40 mm
(1.57 in.) between them.
● When a site is configured with more than six RFUs and only one IBBS200D,
IBBS200T, IBBS300D, or IBBS300T, the IBBS200D, IBBS200T, IBBS300D, or
IBBS300T must be configured with at least two battery packs consisting of
100 Ah storage batteries to avoid overcurrent of a single battery pack during
discharging.
Principles for stacking and combining cabinets
● When an IBBS200D/IBBS200T/BBC5200D-L is stacked with a TMC11H, the
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/BBC5200D-L must be placed under the TMC11H. When
two IBBS200D/IBBS200T/BBC5200D-L cabinets are stacked, only cabinets of

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 141


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

the same type can be stacked. That is, an IBBS200D can only be stacked with
another IBBS200D. An IBBS200T can only be stacked with another IBBS200T. A
BBC5200D-L can only be stacked with another BBC5200D-L.
● When an IBBS300D/IBBS300T is stacked with a TMC11H, the IBBS300D/
IBBS300T must be placed under the TMC11H. When two IBBS300D/IBBS300T
cabinets are stacked, only cabinets of the same type can be stacked. That is,
an IBBS300D can only be stacked with another IBBS300D. An IBBS300T can
only be stacked with another IBBS300T.
● An IBBS200D or IBBS200T cannot be used together with an IBBS300D or
IBBS300T.
● An RFC can be stacked only with an APM30H or TMC11H, and the RFC must
be placed under the APM30H or TMC11H.
● If auxiliary cabinets, such as the battery cabinet IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T/BBC5200D-L or transmission cabinet TMC11H, are
required during initial site deployment, the auxiliary cabinets are positioned
on the left, and the basic cabinets are positioned on the right. If both a
battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are required, the battery cabinet is
positioned on the left side of the basic cabinet, and the transmission cabinet
is stacked on the battery cabinet or positioned on the left side of the battery
cabinet.
● During initial site deployment, space must be reserved for capacity expansion.
Unless otherwise stated, new cabinets are added to the right side of original
cabinets for capacity expansion and the original cabinets are not relocated. In
a special scenario, new cabinets can be added to the left side of original
cabinets.
Configuration principles in single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode base
stations
● In a single- or dual-mode base station, only one BBU is configured. In a triple-
or quadruple-mode base station, two BBUs can be configured, and the second
BBU is installed in the 2 U space under the first BBU.
● A cabinet combination of one APM30H and one RFC is configured with one
BBU by default. This cabinet combination can be configured with a maximum
of two BBUs, and the power consumption of the two BBUs cannot exceed
1200 W.
● If two BBUs are configured during the initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H and transmission equipment is installed in a TMC11H.
● During capacity expansion, if there is space for a second BBU in an APM30H,
the second BBU is installed in the APM30H. If there is no space, the second
BBU is installed in a TMC11H.
NOTE

The cabinet configurations in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base station


configured with one BBU are the same as those in a triple- or quadruple-mode base station
configured with two BBUs. This section describes the cabinet configurations in a base
station configured with two BBUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 142


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Configuration Principles for a BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E)


NOTE

Cabinet configuration principles for a base station (Ver.D+Ver.E) are the same as those for a
base station (Ver.E+Ver.E). For details, see Cabinet Configuration Principles for a
BTS3900A (Ver.E).

Restrictions on the cabinet configurations in a base station (Ver.D+Ver.E)


● If a Ver.E cabinet is installed on a Ver.D base, the cabling capability at the
bottom of the Ver.E cabinet is the same as that of a Ver.D cabinet.
● If an APM30H (Ver.E) supplies power to a Ver.D series battery cabinet, the
power distribution capability of the APM30H (Ver.E) is the same as that of an
APM30H (Ver.D).
● If an APM30H (Ver.E) is stacked on an RFC (Ver.D), the cabling capability at
the bottom of the APM30H (Ver.E) is the same as that of an APM30H (Ver.D).
● If an APM30H (Ver.D) supplies power to a Ver.E battery cabinet, the power
backup and monitoring capabilities of the Ver.E battery cabinet are the same
as those of a Ver.D battery cabinet.
● If an APM30H (Ver.D) is stacked on an RFC (Ver.E), the cabling capability at
the bottom of the RFC (Ver.E) is the same as that of an RFC (Ver.D).

Cabinet Configurations
● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
different space for customer equipment and carrier configurations but
without backup power in a 110 V or 220 V AC power supply scenario.

Figure 1-70 Cabinet configurations of a base station without backup power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 143


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

The preceding figure shows two configurations: (A) and (B). (A) refers to the initial
configuration of 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1 TMC11H. (B) refers to the initial configuration of 1
APM30H+1 RFC+1 TMC11H expanded to 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1 TMC11H.
● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by one battery cabinet as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Figure 1-71 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by one battery cabinet

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by two battery cabinets as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 144


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-72 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by two battery cabinets

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station


supplied with -48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 145


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-73 Cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with -48 V DC


power

The following table lists the cabinet configurations in the case of different power
inputs, backup power requirements, spaces for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-42 Cabinet configurations


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power BBU: ≤ 5 U
AC Two BBUs:
≤3U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 5 U
Two BBUs:
≤3U

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 146


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


power BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
by one ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
battery IBBS300D/IBBS300T
cabinet
Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


power BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
by two ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
battery IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
cabinets

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 147


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

-48 V DC - Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 TMC11H+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 9 U
≤ 12 RFUs 1 TMC11H+2 RFCs
Two BBUs:
≤7U

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 20
U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs
Two BBUs:
≤ 18 U

1.2.3.2.4 BTS3900A (Ver.C) Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a BTS3900A is configured with RFUs and RRUs, different configurations of
cabinets can be used for the BTS3900A with 110 V AC/220 V AC power supply or
-48 V DC power supply in single-, dual-, quadruple-, and triple-mode scenarios.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


A BTS3900A can be configured with a maximum of six RFUs and six RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 148


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Configurations of a Single- or Dual-Mode Base Station


A single- or dual-mode base station can be configured with only one BBU, which
is installed in the APM30H.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station
with different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-74 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is not required

When backup power is provided by one battery cabinet in the initial configuration
of a site, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station with
different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 149


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-75 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is provided by one battery cabinet

When backup power is provided by two battery cabinets in the initial


configuration of a site, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station with different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 150


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-76 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is provided by two battery cabinets

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


single- or dual-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-77 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 151


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station with different backup power requirements, requirements on space for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.
NOTE

APM30Hs listed in the Cabinet Configuration column of the following table include the
APM30H used in the BTS3900A (AC) and the extension APM30H used in the distributed
base station.

Table 1-43 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤ 12 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC


or 220 V power RRUs
AC
≤ 23 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+1
RRUs TMC11H

Backup ≤ 12 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+2


power RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided
by one ≤ 23 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+2
battery RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
cabinet in TMC11H
the initial
configurati
on

Backup ≤ 12 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+4


power RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided
by two ≤ 23 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+4
battery RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
cabinets in TMC11H
the initial
configurati
on

-48 V DC - ≤9U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 1 TMC11H+1 RFC


RRUs

≤ 20 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


RRUs

Cabinet Configurations of a Triple- or Quadruple-Mode Base Station


The principles for configuring a triple-mode base station cabinet are as follows:
● Two BBUs (BBU 0 and BBU 1) are configured for a triple-mode base station.
BBU 0 is installed in the basic APM30H or TMC11H, which is on the left side.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 152


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU 1 is installed in the extension APM30H or TMC11H, which is on the right


side.
● A triple-mode base station can be configured with only one BBU, which is
installed in the position of BBU 0 in the following figure.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base
station with different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-78 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is not required

When a site is configured with two battery cabinets, the cabinet configurations of
a triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 153


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-79 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is provided by two battery cabinets

When a site is configured with four battery cabinets, the cabinet configurations of
a triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 154


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-80 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is provided by four battery cabinets

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-81 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 155


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station in the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-44 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤ 10 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC


or 220 V power RRUs
AC
≤ 21 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+1
RRUs TMC11H

Backup ≤ 10 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+2


power RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided
by two ≤ 21 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+2
battery RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
cabinets TMC11H

Backup ≤ 10 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+4


power RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided
by four ≤ 21 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 APM30Hs+1 RFC+4
battery RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts+1
cabinets TMC11H

-48 V DC - ≤ 18 U ≤ 6 RFUs+6 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


RRUs

1.2.3.2.5 BTS3900A (Ver.D) Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a BTS3900A is configured with RFUs and RRUs, different configurations of
cabinets can be used for the BTS3900A with 110 V AC/220 V AC power supply or
-48 V DC power supply in single-, dual-, quadruple-, and triple-mode scenarios.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


● A BTS3900A can be configured with a maximum of six RFUs and nine RRUs.
● When a BTS3900A is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the maximum
configuration of RRUs is six RRUs of 2x60 W and three RRUs of 2x40 W.

Cabinet Configurations of a Single- or Dual-Mode Base Station


A single- or dual-mode base station is configured with only one BBU, which is
installed in the APM30H or TMC11H.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 156


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

with different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier


configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-82 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is not required

When backup power is provided by one battery cabinet in the initial configuration
of a site, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station with
different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in Figure 1-83.
NOTE

IBBS in the following figure represents the IBBS200D/IBBS200T, and the IBBS300D/IBBS300T is
used when the base station needs to be configured with two battery cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 157


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-83 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is provided by one battery cabinet

When backup power is provided by two battery cabinets in the initial


configuration of a site, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station with different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-84 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is provided by two battery cabinets

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


single- or dual-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 158


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-85 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station with different backup power requirements, requirements on space for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-45 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power RRUs
AC
≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
RRUs TMC11H

Backup ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


power RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T
provided ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
by one IBBS700D/IBBS700T
battery
cabinet in ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
the initial RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T+1
configurati TMC11H
on ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T+1
TMC11H

Backup ≤5U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


power RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
by two IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
battery
cabinets in

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 159


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

the initial ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


configurati RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
on +1 TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

-48 V DC - ≤9U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 1 TMC11H+1 RFC


RRUs

≤ 20 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


RRUs

Cabinet Configurations of a Triple- or Quadruple-Mode Base Station


The principles for configuring a triple- or quadruple-mode base station are as
follows:
● When one BBU is configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
position of the BBU is indicated by BBU0 in the following figure.
● If two BBUs are configured during initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H, and transmission equipment is installed in a
TMC11H.
● During the capacity expansion, if there is space for a second BBU in the
APM30H, the BBU is installed in the APM30H. Otherwise, the BBU is installed
in a TMC11H.
When a site is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power and does not require
backup power, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base
station with different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 160


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-86 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is not required

When a site is configured with one battery cabinet, the cabinet configurations of a
triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in Figure 1-87 and
Figure 1-88.
NOTE

IBBS in the following figure represents the IBBS200D/IBBS200T, and the IBBS300D/IBBS300T is
used when the base station needs to be configured with two battery cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 161


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-87 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is provided by one battery cabinet

Figure 1-88 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is provided by one IBBS700D/IBBS700T

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 162


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When a site is configured with two battery cabinets, the cabinet configurations of
a triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-89 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is provided by two battery cabinets

When a site is supplied with -48 V DC power, the cabinet configurations of a


triple- or quadruple-mode base station with different requirements on space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 163


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-90 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station in the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-46 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup ≤3U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power RRUs
AC
≤ 14 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
RRUs TMC11H

Backup ≤3U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


power RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T
provided ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
by one IBBS700D/IBBS700T
battery
cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 164


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

≤ 14 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T+1
TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T+1
TMC11H

Backup ≤3U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


power RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
provided ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
by two IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
battery
cabinets ≤ 14 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
+1 TMC11H
● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

-48 V DC - ≤7U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 1 TMC11H+1 RFC


RRUs

≤ 18 U ≤ 6 RFUs+9 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


RRUs

1.2.3.2.6 BTS3900A (Ver.E) or BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E) Configured with RFUs and


RRUs
When RFUs and RRUs are configured, different cabinet configurations can be used
for single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode BTS3900A base stations supplied
with 110 V AC/220 V AC power and -48 V DC power.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


Maximum configuration principles for a BTS3900A (Ver.E)
● A single BTS3900A supports a maximum of 6 RFUs and 15 RRUs or 12 RFUs
and 9 RRUs.
● If a BTS3900A is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the RRU specifications
supported by the BTS3900A are listed in the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 165


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-47 RRU specifications supported by a BTS3900A configured with RFUs and
RRUs
RF Module Configuration RRU Specifications

6 RFUs+15 RRUs 6 RRUs (2x80 W power per RRU)+9


RRUs (2x40 W power per RRU)

12 RFUs+9 RRUs 9 RRUs (2x40 W power per RRU)

Maximum configuration principles for a BTS3900A (Ver.D+Ver.E)


● If a Ver.D cabinet and a Ver.E cabinet are installed side by side or stacked in a
base station, the base station supports a maximum of six RFUs and nine
RRUs.
● A maximum of six 2x60 W RRUs and three 2x40 W RRUs can be configured.
Configuration principles in single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode base
stations
● In a single- or dual-mode base station, only one BBU is configured. In a triple-
or quadruple-mode base station, two BBUs can be configured, and the second
BBU is installed in the 2 U space under the first BBU.
● A cabinet combination of one APM30H and one RFC is configured with one
BBU by default. This cabinet combination can be configured with a maximum
of two BBUs, and the power consumption of the two BBUs cannot exceed
1200 W.
● If two BBUs are configured during the initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H and transmission equipment is installed in a TMC11H.
● During capacity expansion, if there is space for a second BBU in an APM30H,
the second BBU is installed in the APM30H. If there is no space, the second
BBU is installed in a TMC11H.
NOTE

The cabinet configurations in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base station


configured with one BBU are the same as those in a triple- or quadruple-mode base station
configured with two BBUs. This section describes the cabinet configurations in a base
station configured with two BBUs.

Cabinet Configuration
● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
different space for customer equipment and carrier configurations but
without backup power in a 110 V or 220 V AC power supply scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 166


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-91 Cabinet configurations of a base station without backup power

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by one battery cabinet as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 167


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-92 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by one battery cabinet

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by two battery cabinets as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 168


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-93 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by two battery cabinets

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station


supplied with -48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 169


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-94 Cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with -48 V DC


power

The following table lists the cabinet configurations in the case of different power
inputs, backup power requirements, spaces for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 170


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-48 Cabinet configurations


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power BBU: ≤ 5 U +15 RRUs
AC Two BBUs:
≤3U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 5 U +9 RRUs
Two BBUs:
≤3U

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +15 RRUs TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +9 RRUs TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


power BBU: ≤ 5 U +15 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
by one ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
battery IBBS300D/IBBS300T
cabinet
Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
BBU: ≤ 5 U +9 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +15 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 171


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +9 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


power BBU: ≤ 5 U +15 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
by two ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
battery IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
cabinets
Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
BBU: ≤ 5 U +9 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


BBU: ≤ 16 +15 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


BBU: ≤ 16 +9 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

-48 V DC - Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 TMC11H+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 8 U +15 RRUs
Two BBUs:
≤6U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 TMC11H+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 9 U +9 RRUs
Two BBUs:
≤7U

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 172


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 19 +15 RRUs
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 17 U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 20 +9 RRUs
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 18 U

1.2.3.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a BTS3900A (Ver.C), a
BTS3900A (Ver.D), and a BTS3900A (Ver.E). The power requirements of a reused
base station with the same capability as a BTS3900A (Ver.D) are the same as
those of the BTS3900A (Ver.D). The power requirements of a reused base station
with the same capability as a BTS3900A (Ver.E) are the same as those of the
BTS3900A (Ver.E).

1.2.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A (Ver.C)


This section describes the power requirements of base stations with different
power supplies and configurations.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following tables, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when AC power is supplied to a
BTS3900A.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 173


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-49 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC three- 1x25 A/3 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


phase 2)

220 V AC single- 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


phase 2)

110 V AC dual- 1x63 A/2 P


live-wire

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


The following table lists the power requirements when -48 V DC power is supplied
to a BTS3900A configured with RFUs but without RRUs.

Table 1-50 Power requirements in DC input scenarios configured with RFUs but
without RRUs
Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement Input Power Cable(3) Length
for Circuit Requirement
Breakers on
Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 high- 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 15 m


power RFUs group of DC input power (49.21 ft)
● 0 or 1 BBU cables (low smoke zero
halogen)
● Power
consumption 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
of transmission default) groups of DC input
equipment ≤ power cables
350 W

● 4 to 6 low- 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


power RFUs group of DC input power
● 0 or 1 BBU cables (low smoke zero
halogen)
● Power
consumption 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
of transmission groups of DC input
equipment ≤ power cables
350 W

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 174


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement Input Power Cable(3) Length
for Circuit Requirement
Breakers on
Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 low- 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


power RFUs group of DC input power
● 0 or 1 BBU cables
● Power
consumption
of the BBU
and
transmission
equipment ≤
650 W

● 1 to 3 high- 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


power RFUs group of DC input power
● 0 or 1 BBU cables (low smoke zero
halogen)
● Power
consumption 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
of transmission groups of DC input
equipment ≤ power cables
350 W

● 1 to 3 high- 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


power RFUs group of DC input power
● 0 or 1 BBU cables
● Power
consumption
of the BBU
and
transmission
equipment ≤
650 W

● 1 to 3 low- 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


power RFUs group of DC input power
● 0 or 1 BBU cables
● Power
consumption
of transmission
equipment ≤
350 W

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 175


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When -48 V DC power is supplied to a BTS3900A configured with RFUs and RRUs,
a DCDU-11A/DCDU-11B/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S is used to provide
power for the equipment in the BTS3900A.
● The DCDU-11A provides power for the RFUs and FAN 01B in the RFC. Table
1-50 lists the power requirements of the DCDU-11A.
● The DCDU-11B/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S provides power for
RRUs only. A DCDU-11B/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S is configured
as required. Table 1-51 lists the power requirements of the DCDU-11B. Table
1-52 lists the power requirements of the EPU02D/EPU02B/EPU02S.

Table 1-51 Power requirements in DC input scenarios configured with RFUs and
RRUs

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


consumption per group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 176


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W)+3 cables
RRUs (power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)

3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W) 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 177


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

Table 1-52 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 178


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w, RRU5903,
RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w, RRU5513t,
RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256, RRU3259,
RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m, RRU3959, RRU3959a,
RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953, RRU3953w,
RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962, RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972, AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the specifications
of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the full
configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do not meet
the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the circuit breakers
during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 179


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the circuit
breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption need to be
added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.

If an AC heater is installed when -48 V DC power is used, one more AC power


input must be added. In this scenario, the power requirements are listed in the
following table.

Table 1-53 Power requirements of an AC heater


Power Input Minimum Requirement for Cable Length
Type Requirement for an Input Power Requirement
Circuit Breakers Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x10 A/1 P 1.5 mm2 (0.002 ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


phase/three- in.2)
phase

110 V AC dual-
live-wire

1.2.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A (Ver.D)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following tables, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when AC power is supplied to a
BTS3900A.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 180


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-54 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Power Number of Minimum Requirements for the Input Cable
Suppl PSUs Requirem Power Cable Lengt
y ent for h
Circuit Requir
Breakers ement
on
Customer
Equipmen
t

220 V 4 or 5 1x40 A/3 P Cable with a black jacket and four ≤ 15


AC (by core wires, two insulation layers, m
three- default) and a cross-sectional area of 6 (49.21
phase mm2 (0.0093 in.2) ft)
2 or 3 1x25 A/3 P
(by
default)

220 V 5 1x100 A/1 Two wires (L and N), each with a


AC P (by single core wire, two insulation
single- default) layers, and a cross-sectional area
phase of 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)
4 1x80 A/1 P

3 1x63 A/1 P

110 V 5 1x100 A/2 Three wires (L1, L2, and N), each
AC or P (by with a single core wire, two
120 V default) insulation layers, and a cross-
AC sectional area of 25 mm2 (0.039
dual- 4 1x80 A/2 P
in.2)
live- 3 1x63 A/2 P
wire

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs Only


The following table lists the power requirements when -48 V DC power is supplied
to a BTS3900A configured with RFUs only.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 181


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-55 Power requirements in DC input scenarios configured with RFUs only

Product Configuration(1) Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Requirem Input Power Cable(3) Length
ent for Requireme
Circuit nt
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipmen
t(2)

● 4 to 6 high-power RFUs 1x160 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 15 m


● 0 to 2 BBUs P one group of DC input (49.21 ft)
power cables (low
● Power consumption of
smoke zero halogen)
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W 2x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
P (by two groups of DC input
default) power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 2x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 2 BBUs P two groups of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment 1x100 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),
≤ 350 W P one group of DC input
power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 or 1 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W

● 0 to 3 high-power RFUs 1x100 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


● 0 to 2 BBUs P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment 2x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
≤ 350 W P two groups of DC input
power cables

● 0 to 3 low-power RFUs 1x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 or 1 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W

● 4 to 6 high-power RFUs 1x160 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables (low
smoke zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 182


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Configuration(1) Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Requirem Input Power Cable(3) Length
ent for Requireme
Circuit nt
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipmen
t(2)

2x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


P (by two groups of DC input
default) power cables

● 0 to 3 high-power RFUs 1x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

● 0 to 3 low-power RFUs 1x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 183


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When -48 V DC power is supplied to a BTS3900A configured with RFUs and RRUs,
a DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 is used to provide power for the equipment in the BTS3900A.
● The DCDU-12A provides power for the RFUs and FAN 01C in the RFC. Table
1-55 lists the power requirements of a DCDU-12A.
● The DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 provides power for RRUs and is configured as required.
Table 1-56 lists the power requirements of a DCDU-12B. Table 1-57 lists the
power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Table 1-58 lists the power
requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S. Table 1-59 lists the
power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-56 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


consumption per group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 184


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W)+3 cables
RRUs (power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)

3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W) 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
cables

9 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

9 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W) 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
default) groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 185


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
default) groups of DC input power
cables

Table 1-57 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
(5) Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU (power
groups of DC input power
consumption ≤
cables (low smoke zero
1000 W)
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 186


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
(5) Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 BBU (power 2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two


consumption ≤ groups of DC input power
1000 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-58 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-59 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 187


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w, RRU5903,
RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w, RRU5513t,
RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256, RRU3259,
RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m, RRU3959, RRU3959a,
RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953, RRU3953w,
RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962, RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972, AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the specifications
of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the full
configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do not meet
the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the circuit breakers
during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 188


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the circuit
breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption need to be
added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

If an AC heater is installed when -48 V DC power is used, one more AC power


input must be added. In this scenario, the power requirements are listed in the
following table.

Table 1-60 Power requirements of an AC heater

Power Input Minimum Requirement for Cable Length


Type Requirement for an Input Power Requirement
Circuit Breakers Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x10 A/1 P 1.5 mm2 (0.002 ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


phase/three- in.2)
phase

110 V AC dual-
live-wire

1.2.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900A (Ver.E)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

AC Input Scenario
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table lists the power requirements when AC power is supplied to the
base station.

Table 1-61 Power requirements in AC scenarios

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x40 A/3 P Cable with a ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) black jacket ft)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 189


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P and four core


(by default) wires, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 6 mm2
(0.0093 in.2)

220 V AC 5 1x100 A/1 P Two wires (L


single-phase (by default) and N), each
with a single
4 1x80 A/1 P core wire, two
3 1x63 A/1 P insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x100 A/2 P Three wires


120 V AC (by default) (L1, L2, and
dual-live-wire N), each with
4 1x80 A/2 P a single core
3 1x63 A/2 P wire, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs Only


The following table lists the power requirements when -48 V DC power is supplied
to a base station configured with RFUs only.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 190


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-62 Power requirements in DC input scenarios configured with RFUs only

Product Configuration(1) Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Requirem Input Power Cable(3) Length
ent for Requireme
Circuit nt
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipmen
t(2)

● 4 to 6 high-power RFUs 1x160 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 15 m


● 0 to 2 BBUs P one group of DC input (49.21 ft)
power cables (low
● Power consumption of
smoke zero halogen)
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W 2x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
P (by two groups of DC input
default) power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 2x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 2 BBUs P two groups of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment 1x100 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),
≤ 350 W P one group of DC input
power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 or 1 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W

● 0 to 3 high-power RFUs 1x100 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


● 0 to 2 BBUs P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment 2x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
≤ 350 W P two groups of DC input
power cables

● 0 to 3 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 or 1 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W

● 4 to 6 high-power RFUs 1x160 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables (low
smoke zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 191


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Configuration(1) Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Requirem Input Power Cable(3) Length
ent for Requireme
Circuit nt
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipmen
t(2)

2x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


P (by two groups of DC input
default) power cables

● 0 to 3 high-power RFUs 1x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

● 0 to 3 low-power RFUs 1x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 192


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a base station uses -48 V DC power and is configured with RFUs and RRUs,
external power equipment supplies power to the DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02, as
shown below.
● The DCDU-12A provides power for the RFUs and FAN 01D in the RFC. Table
1-62 describes the power requirements of a DCDU-12A.
● The DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 provides power for RRUs and is configured as required.
Table 1-63 lists the power requirements of a DCDU-12B. Table 1-64 lists the
power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Table 1-65 lists the power
requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S. Table 1-66 lists the
power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-63 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


consumption per group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 640 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
default) groups of DC input power
cables

9 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 193


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W)+3 cables
RRUs (power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 640 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 640 W) cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 194


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-64 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 10 m (32.81


(power one group of DC ft)
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 195


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),


two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-65 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-66 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 196


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w, RRU5903,
RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w, RRU5513t,
RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256, RRU3259,
RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m, RRU3959, RRU3959a,
RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953, RRU3953w,
RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962, RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972, AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the specifications
of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the full
configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do not meet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 197


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the circuit breakers
during base station capacity expansion.
● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the circuit
breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption need to be
added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

If an AC heater is installed when -48 V DC power is used, one more AC power


input must be added. In this scenario, the power requirements are listed in the
following table.

Table 1-67 Power requirements of an AC heater

Power Input Minimum Requirement for Cable Length


Type Requirement for an Input Power Requirement
Circuit Breakers Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x10 A/1 P 1.5 mm2 (0.002 ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


phase/three- in.2)
phase

110 V AC dual-
live-wire

Table 1-68 Power requirements of an AC heater

Power Supply Minimum Requirements for Cable Length


Requirement for the Input Power Requirement
Circuit Breakers Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x10 A/1 P 1.5 mm2 (0.0023 ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


phase/three- in.2)
phase

110 V AC dual-
live-wire

1.2.3.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900A


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900A (Ver.C), a
BTS3900A (Ver.D), and a BTS3900A (Ver.E) supplied with different power. The
power distribution scheme for a reused base station with the same capability as a
BTS3900A (Ver.D) is the same as that of the BTS3900A (Ver.D). The power
distribution scheme for a reused base station with the same capability as a
BTS3900A (Ver.E) is the same as that of the BTS3900A (Ver.E).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 198


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.3.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.C) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900A supplied with
110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


If 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, the AC power is
converted to DC power and distributed by the embedded power subrack unit
(EPU) in an APM30H.

The EPU converts one AC power input into two AC power outputs:
● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.

The AC power input is converted by PSUs into DC power, which is supplied to the
battery cabinet, RFC, TMC11H, and other equipment.

Figure 1-95 and Figure 1-96 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-69 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a 220
V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be connected by
short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-95 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in a BTS3900A supplied
with 220 V AC single-phase power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 199


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-96 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in a BTS3900A supplied
with 110 V AC dual-live-wire power

Table 1-69 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H in an
AC-powered BTS3900A
Power Specifications Specifications Specifications of the
Supply of the Upper- of the AC Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Level Circuit Output Circuit the DC Output
Breaker for the Breaker
PSU

220 V AC 3x20 A (MCBa) Heater and SOU: ● BATb: 1x160 A (MCB)


single-phase/ 1x15 A (MCB) ● RFC 1: 1x125 A (MCB)
three-phase
● RFC 2: 1x125 A (MCB)
110 V AC 1x63 A (MCB) ● Heater: 1x15 ● TMC: 1x30 A (MCB)
dual-live-wire A (MCB)
● BBU_0: 1x25 A (MCB)
● SOU: 1x15 A
(MCB) ● BBU_1: 1x25 A (MCB)
● TMc: 2x5 A (FUSEd)
● TM or TMC: 1x15 A
(FUSE)
● FAN or TECe: 1x15 A
(FUSE)
● TM or EMUA: 1x15 A
(FUSE)
● FAN: 1x15 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 200


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Specifications Specifications Specifications of the


Supply of the Upper- of the AC Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Level Circuit Output Circuit the DC Output
Breaker for the Breaker
PSU

a. MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b. BAT: storage battery
c. TM: transmission equipment
d. FUSE: fuse
e. TEC: air conditioner

When AC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, the APM30H distributes three DC


outputs to RFC 1, RFC 2, and the TMC11H, as shown in Figure 1-95 and Figure
1-96. The DCDU-11A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other
modules in an RFC. The DCDU-11C distributes power to the transmission
equipment, fan assembly, and other modules in the TMC11H.

NOTE

When the RFC is configured with DRFUs, 12 DRFUs are required, that is, two RFCs are
configured.

Figure 1-97 shows the power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H. Table
1-70 lists the specifications of the circuit breakers in the RFC and TMC11H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 201


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-97 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-
powered BTS3900A

Table 1-70 Specifications of the circuit breakers in the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-
powered BTS3900A
Cabinet Type Specifications of the Circuit Breaker for
the DC Output

RFC ● RFU 0 to RFU 5: 6x25 A (MCB)


● FAN: 1x25 A (MCB)
● Reserved: 3x25 A (MCB)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 202


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Type Specifications of the Circuit Breaker for


the DC Output

TMC11H ● TM: 2x25 A (MCB)+2x12 A (MCB)+2x6 A


(MCB)
● TM or BBU: 2x25 A (MCB)
● TM or EMUA: 1x25 A (MCB)
● FAN: 1x25 A (MCB)

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


If -48 V DC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, external power is directly supplied to
an RFC. -48 V DC power is directly supplied to the DC junction box in an RFC,
which then distributes the power to the DCDU-11A in the RFC and the DCDU-11C
in a TMC. The DCDU-11A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other
modules in the RFC. The DCDU-11C distributes power to the BBU, fan assembly,
and other modules in the TMC11H.
Figure 1-98 shows the power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H. The
specifications of the circuit breakers in this scenario are the same as those in AC
scenarios, as listed in Table 1-70.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 203


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-98 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H in a BTS3900A
supplied with -48 V DC power

1.2.3.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.D) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900A supplied with
110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


If 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, the AC power is
converted to DC power and distributed by the embedded power subrack unit
(EPU) in an APM30H.

The EPU converts one AC power input into two AC power outputs:
● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 204


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.
The AC power input is converted by PSUs into DC power, which is supplied to the
battery cabinet, RFC, TMC11H, and other equipment.
Figure 1-99 and Figure 1-100 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-71 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a 220
V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be connected by
short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-99 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in a BTS3900A supplied
with 220 V AC single-phase power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 205


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-100 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in a BTS3900A supplied
with 110 V AC dual-live-wire power

Table 1-71 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H in an
AC-powered BTS3900A
Power Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
Supply the Upper-Level the Circuit Breaker the Circuit
Circuit Breaker for for the AC Output Breaker/Fuse for
the PSU the DC Output

220 V AC 2x40 A+1x25 A Heater and SOU: ● BATb: 1x125 A/2


single-phase/ (MCBa) 1x16 A/2 P (MCB) P (MCB)
three-phase ● RFC 1: 1x125 A
110 V AC 1x100 A/2 P (MCB) ● Heater: 1x16 A (MCB)
dual-live-wire (MCB) ● RFC 2: 1x125 A
● SOU: 1x16 A (MCB)
(MCB) ● FAN: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● BBU_0: 1x30 A
(FUSEc)
● BBU_1: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMd: 4x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMCe: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBSf: 1x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 206


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


Supply the Upper-Level the Circuit Breaker the Circuit
Circuit Breaker for for the AC Output Breaker/Fuse for
the PSU the DC Output

a. MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b. BAT: storage battery
c. FUSE: fuse
d. TM: transmission equipment
e. TMC: TMC11H
f. IBBS: fan in an IBBS200D/IBBS700D or TEC in an IBBS200T/IBBS700T

If AC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, an APM30H distributes three DC outputs


to RFC 1, RFC 2, and a TMC11H, as shown in Figure 1-99 and Figure 1-100. The
DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other components in
an RFC. The DCDU-12C distributes power to the transmission equipment, fan
assembly, and other components in the TMC11H.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for an RFC and a
TMC11H. The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in an RFC and a
TMC11H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 207


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-101 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-
powered BTS3900A

Table 1-72 Specifications of the fuses in the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-powered
BTS3900A
Cabinet Type Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

RFC ● RFU 0 to RFU 5: 6x30 A (FUSE)


● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● Reserved: 3x30 A (FUSE)

TMC11H ● TM: 7x30 A (FUSE)


● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 208


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


If -48 V DC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, external power is directly supplied to
an RFC. -48 V DC power is directly supplied to the DC junction box in an RFC,
which then distributes the power to the DCDU-12A in the RFC and the DCDU-12C
in a TMC. The DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other
components in the RFC. The DCDU-12C distributes power to the BBU, transmission
equipment, fan assembly, and other components in the TMC11H.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for an RFC and a
TMC11H. The specifications of the fuses in this scenario are the same as those in
AC scenarios, as listed in Table 1-72.

Figure 1-102 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H in a BTS3900A
supplied with -48 V DC power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 209


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.3.4.3 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900A (Ver.E) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900A supplied with
110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


If 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied, the AC power is converted to DC power
and distributed by the embedded power subrack unit (EPU05A) in an APM30H.
The EPU05A converts one AC power input into two AC power outputs:
● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.
The AC power input is converted by PSUs into DC power, which is supplied to the
battery cabinet, RFC, TMC11H, and other equipment.
Figure 1-103 and Figure 1-104 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-73 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-103 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H supplied with 220 V AC
single-phase power and configured with a PDU03D-02

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 210


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-104 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H supplied with 110 V AC
dual-live-wire power and configured with a PDU03D-02

Table 1-73 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H in an
AC-powered scenario
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 5x32 A/1 P Heater and SOU: ● RFC 1: 1x100 A


phase/three- (MCBa) 1x16 A (MCB) (MCB)
phase ● RFC 2: 1x100 A
(MCB)
● FAN: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● BBU_0: 1x30 A
(FUSEb)
● BBU_1: 1x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 211


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 5x32 A/1 P (MCB) Heater and SOU: ● TMc: 4x30 A
live-wire 1x16 A (MCB) (FUSE)
● TMCd: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBSe: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RRU: 9x30 A
(FUSE)

a. MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b. FUSE: fuse
c. TM: transmission equipment
d. TMC: TMC11H
e. IBBS: fan in an IBBS200D/IBBS300D or TEC in an IBBS200T/IBBS300T

When the cabinet requires an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, the


EPU05A must be configured with two PDU01D-01 modules, which get the DC
power from the EPU05A and distribute it to the EPU02D/EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02. The power distribution schemes are shown in Figure 1-105 and
Figure 1-106. The following table lists specifications of circuit breakers and fuses.
NOTE

The DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 and EPU02D/EPU02D-02 are connected in a similar way. The


following figure uses the EPU02D as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 212


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-105 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in 220 V AC single-phase
scenarios (configured with an EPU02D or EPU02D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 213


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-106 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in 110 V AC dual-live-
wire scenarios (configured with an EPU02D or EPU02D-02)

Table 1-74 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H in an
AC-powered scenario
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 5x32 A/1 P Heater and SOU: ● RFC 1: 1x100 A


phase/three- (MCBa) 1x16 A (MCB) (MCB)
phase ● RFC 2: 1x100 A
(MCB)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 214


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 5x32 A/1 P (MCB) Heater and SOU: ● FAN: 1x30 A
live-wire 1x16 A (MCB) (FUSE)
● BBU_0: 1x30 A
(FUSEb)
● BBU_1: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMc: 4x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMCd: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBSe: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RRU (slot 7):
3x30 A (FUSE)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
8): 1x100 A
(MCB)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
9): 1x100 A
(MCB)

a. MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b. FUSE: fuse
c. TM: transmission equipment
d. TMC: TMC11H
e. IBBS: fan in an IBBS200D/IBBS300D or TEC in an IBBS200T/IBBS300T

The following figure shows power distribution scheme for an EPU02D/EPU02D-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 215


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-107 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02D/EPU02D-02

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


providing boosted-voltage and DC power outputs.

Table 1-75 Fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


Power Fuse Terminal Specifications
Equipmen
t

EPU02D Slot 1 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) -57 V boosted-voltage power


Slot 2 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) output: 6x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)

EPU02D-0 Slot 1 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) -57 V boosted-voltage power


2 Slot 2 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) output: 3x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(RRU)

The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 216


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-108 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02

The following table lists the circuit breaker or fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02 providing DC power outputs.

Table 1-76 Circuit breaker/fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02


Power Equipment Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse

DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 -48 V DC power output: 3x50 A (RRU) (MCB)

-48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU/FAN/TM) (FUSE)

If AC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, an APM30H distributes three DC outputs


to RFC 1, RFC 2, and a TMC11H, as shown in Figure 1-103 and Figure 1-104. The
DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other components in
an RFC. The DCDU-12B distributes power to the transmission equipment, fan
assembly, and other components in a TMC11H.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for an RFC and a
TMC11H. The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in an RFC and a
TMC11H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 217


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-109 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-
powered scenario

Table 1-77 Specifications of the fuses in the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-powered
scenario
Cabinet Type Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

RFC ● RFU 0 to RFU 5: 6x30 A (FUSE)


● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● Reserved: 3x30 A (FUSE)

TMC11H ● TM: 7x30 A (FUSE)


● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 218


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


If -48 V DC power is supplied, external power is directly supplied to an RFC. -48 V
DC power is directly supplied to the DC junction box in an RFC, which then
distributes the power to the DCDU-12A in an RFC and the DCDU-12C in a
TMC11H. A DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other
components in an RFC. A DCDU-12C distributes power to the BBU, transmission
equipment, fan assembly, and other components in a TMC11H.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for an RFC and a
TMC11H. The specifications of the fuses in this scenario are the same as those in
AC scenarios, as listed in Table 1-77.

Figure 1-110 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H supplied with
-48 V DC power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 219


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.3.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900A


This section lists the reference sections in 3900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS3900A.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS3900A, see the following sections:
● BTS3900A (Ver.C): BTS3900A (Ver.C) Cable List
● BTS3900A (Ver.D): BTS3900A (Ver.D) Cable List
● BTS3900A (Ver.E): BTS3900A (Ver.E) Cable List

Cable Connections
For cable connections for a BTS3900A, see topics related to Cable Connections in
3900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Table 1-78 Cable connections

Bas Power Monitorin Transmiss BBU CPRI RF Cable


e Cable g Signal ion Cable Interconn Cable Connecti
Sta Connecti Cable Connecti ection Connecti ons
tio ons Connecti ons Signal ons
n ons Cable
Connecti
ons

BTS BTS3900A BTS3900A Transmissi BBU CPRI RF Cable


390 (Ver.C) (Ver.C) on Cable Interconn Cable Connectio
0A Power Monitorin Connectio ection Connectio ns
(Ve Cable g Signal ns for Signal ns for
r.C) Connectio Cable 3900 Cable 3900
ns Connectio Series Connectio Series
ns Base ns Base
Stations Stations
BTS BTS3900A BTS3900A
390 (Ver.D) (Ver.D)
0A Power Monitorin
(Ve Cable g Signal
r.D) Connectio Cable
ns Connectio
ns

BTS BTS3900A BTS3900A


390 (Ver.E) (Ver.E)
0A Power Monitorin
(Ve Cable g Signal
r.E) Connectio Cable
ns Connectio
ns

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 220


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.4 BTS3900AL
This section describes cabinets, cabinet applications, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, cables, and cable connections of a BTS3900AL.

1.2.4.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS3900AL


A BTS3900AL, outdoor macro base station, supports the following cabinets:
BTS3900AL (Ver.A) cabinet, IBBS700D, IBBS700T, IBBS300D, IBBS300T, and
TMC11H (Ver.D).
The following table lists the cabinets supported by a BTS3900AL.

Table 1-79 Cabinets supported by a BTS3900AL


Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Components in the
Cabinet

BTS3900AL The BTS3900AL cabinet, basic For details, see


(Ver.A) cabinet in a BTS3900AL, houses Components in
the BBU, power equipment, RFUs, BTS3900AL Cabinets.
transmission equipment, and
storage batteries. Different power
equipment can be installed in
BTS3900AL cabinets to support
the AC or DC power supply.
● The BTS3900AL (Ver.A) cabinet
supplied with AC power is
referred to as a BTS3900AL AC
cabinet.
● The BTS3900AL (Ver.A) cabinet
supplied with DC power is
referred to as a BTS3900AL DC
cabinet.

● IBBS700D or The storage battery cabinets ● For details, see


IBBS700T provide backup power for a base Components in an
● IBBS300D or station. IBBS700D.
IBBS300T ● For details, see
Components in an
IBBS700T.
● For details, see
Components in
IBBS300Ds.
● For details, see
Components in
IBBS300Ts.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 221


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Components in the


Cabinet

TMC11H As the transmission cabinet in a For details, see


(Ver.D) BTS3900AL, it is installed when Components in
more transmission space is TMC11Hs.
required to provide power supplies
and installation space for
transmission equipment.

The following figure shows the exteriors of BTS3900AL, IBBS700D, IBBS700T, and
TMC11H (Ver.D) cabinets.

Figure 1-111 Exteriors of BTS3900AL, IBBS700D, IBBS700T, and TMC11H (Ver.D)


cabinets

The following figure shows the exteriors of an IBBS300D (Ver.A) and an IBBS300T
(Ver.A). IBBS300D (Ver.A) is shortened to IBBS300D and IBBS300T (Ver.A) is
shortened to IBBS300T in this section.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 222


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-112 Exteriors of an IBBS300D and an IBBS300T

1.2.4.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS3900AL


Various cabinets can be configured for a BTS3900AL to meet different
requirements for RF module configurations, backup power capacity, and spaces for
customer equipment. A BTS3900AL can be configured with RFUs but without RRUs
or configured with RFUs and RRUs depending on different scenarios.

1.2.4.2.1 BTS3900AL (Ver.A) Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


In a BTS3900AL configured with RFUs but without RRUs, the BTS3900AL can be
configured as a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base station and
supports different combinations of cabinets.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of 18 RFUs. If there are
more than 18 RFUs, one or more sites need to be added.
● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of one BTS3900AL AC
cabinet and one BTS3900AL DC cabinet, and the two cabinets must be
installed side by side with the BTS3900AL DC cabinet on the right.
● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of one IBBS700D or
IBBS700T.
● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of two IBBS300Ds or
IBBS300Ts.
● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of one TMC11H (Ver.D).
● If auxiliary cabinets, such as the battery cabinet IBBS700D/IBBS700T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T or transmission cabinet TMC11H (Ver.D), are required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 223


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

during an initial site construction, the auxiliary cabinets should be positioned


on the left, and the basic cabinet on the right.

Cabinet Configurations of a Single- or Dual-Mode Base Station


One BBU is configured in a single- or dual-mode base station. If six to nine RFUs
are configured, one BTS3900AL AC cabinet or BTS3900AL DC cabinet is configured
with the BBU installed in the cabinet. If more than nine RFUs are configured, one
BTS3900AL AC cabinet and one BTS3900AL DC cabinet are configured with the
BBU installed in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet.
The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode
base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when -48 V DC power is supplied.

Figure 1-113 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


-48 V DC power is supplied

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode


base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and backup power is
not required.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 224


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-114 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is not required

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode


base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and short-term
backup power is required.

Figure 1-115 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


short-term backup power is required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 225


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-116 and Figure 1-117 show the cabinet configurations of a single- or
dual-mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment
and RF configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and medium-
to long-term backup power is required.

Figure 1-116 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS700D or IBBS700T

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 226


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-117 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS300D or IBBS300T

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station in the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for customer
equipment, and RF configurations.

Table 1-80 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


Power Backup Space for RF Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configur
Requireme Equipme ation
nt nt

-48 V DC N/A ≤ 11 U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL DC cabinet

110 V AC No backup ≤ 11 U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


or 220 V power
AC ≤ 22 U ≤ 18 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
RFUs BTS3900AL DC cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 227


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for RF Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configur
Requireme Equipme ation
nt nt

Short-term ≤4U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


backup
power ≤ 15 U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
TMC11H (Ver.D)

Medium- ≤ 11 U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1


to long- IBBS700D/IBBS700T
term 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
backup IBBS300D/IBBS300T
power
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

≤ 22 U ≤ 18 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
RFUs IBBS700D/IBBS700T+1
BTS3900AL DC cabinet
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
BTS3900AL DC cabinet
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts+1
BTS3900AL DC cabinet

NOTICE

(1) When short-term backup power is required, a pack of four storage batteries
needs to be installed in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet. The prerequisites for
configuring the built-in storage batteries are as follows:
● The ambient temperature in the cabinet is below 40°C (104°F).
● The storage batteries must be used in the first class power grid. In the first
class power grid, the average power-off time of AC power supply every month
is less than ten hours.
● It is recommended that a pack of Northstar 100 Ah storage batteries be used
to meet the high-current discharge requirements.
● The maximum power consumption of a base station is 10,000 W.
(2) When medium- to long-duration backup power is used, an external battery
cabinet needs to be configured. It is recommended that the battery cabinet be
configured with a minimum of 300 Ah, that is, a minimum of two 150 Ah battery
packs.
(3) A base station cannot be configured with both the built-in storage batteries
and the external battery cabinet.
(4) When an IBBS700D or IBBS300D is configured, reduce the ambient
temperature to 40°C (104°F). When an IBBS700T or IBBS300T is configured, the
ambient temperature can remain unchanged.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 228


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Configurations of a Triple- or Quadruple-Mode Base Station


A triple- or quadruple-mode base station can be configured with one or two BBUs.
When a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with one BBU,
cabinet configurations in the triple- or quadruple-mode base station are the same
as those in a single- or dual-mode base station.
When a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with two BBUs and
six to nine RFUs, one BTS3900AL AC cabinet or BTS3900AL DC cabinet is
configured with the two BBUs installed in the cabinet. When more than nine RFUs
are configured, one BTS3900AL AC cabinet and one BTS3900AL DC cabinet are
configured with the two BBUs installed in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet.
In the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for customer
equipment, and RF configurations, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or
quadruple-mode base station are the same as those of a single- or dual-mode
base station, as described in Table 1-81.
The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-
mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when -48 V DC power is supplied.

Figure 1-118 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when -48 V DC power is supplied

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-


mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and backup power is
not required.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 229


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-119 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is not required

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-


mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and short-term
backup power is required.

Figure 1-120 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when short-term backup power is required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 230


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-121 and Figure 1-122 show the cabinet configurations of a triple- or
quadruple-mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer
equipment and RF configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied
and medium- to long-term backup power is required.

Figure 1-121 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS700D or
IBBS700T

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 231


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-122 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS300D or
IBBS300T

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station in the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for
customer equipment, and RF configurations.

Table 1-81 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station

Power Backup Space for RF Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configur
Requireme Equipme ation
nt nt

-48 V DC N/A ≤9U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL DC cabinet

110 V AC No backup ≤9U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


or 220 V power
AC ≤ 20 U ≤ 18 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
RFUs BTS3900AL DC cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 232


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for RF Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configur
Requireme Equipme ation
nt nt

Short-term ≤2U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


backup
power ≤ 13 U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
TMC11H (Ver.D)

Medium- ≤9U ≤ 9 RFUs 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1


to long- IBBS700D/IBBS700T
term 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
backup IBBS300D/IBBS300T
power
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

≤ 20 U ≤ 18 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
RFUs IBBS700D/IBBS700T+1
BTS3900AL DC cabinet
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
BTS3900AL DC cabinet
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts+1
BTS3900AL DC cabinet

NOTICE

(1) When short-term backup power is required, a pack of four storage batteries
needs to be installed in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet. The prerequisites for
configuring the built-in storage batteries are as follows:
● The ambient temperature in the cabinet is below 40°C (104°F).
● The storage batteries must be used in the first class power grid. In the first
class power grid, the average power-off time of AC power supply every month
is less than ten hours.
● It is recommended that a pack of Northstar 100 Ah storage batteries be used
to meet the high-current discharge requirements.
● The maximum power consumption of a base station is 10,000 W.
(2) When medium- to long-duration backup power is used, an external battery
cabinet needs to be configured. It is recommended that the battery cabinet be
configured with a minimum of 300 Ah, that is, a minimum of two 150 Ah battery
packs.
(3) A base station cannot be configured with both the built-in storage batteries
and the external battery cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 233


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.4.2.2 BTS3900AL (Ver.A) Configured with RFUs and RRUs


In a BTS3900AL configured with RFUs and RRUs, the BTS3900AL can be
configured as a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base station and
supports different combinations of cabinets.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of 9 RFUs and 12 RRUs and
with a maximum of one BTS3900AL AC cabinet or one BTS3900AL DC cabinet.
● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of one IBBS700D or
IBBS700T.
● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of two IBBS300Ds or
IBBS300Ts.
● A BTS3900AL can be configured with a maximum of one TMC11H (Ver.D).
● If auxiliary cabinets, such as the battery cabinet IBBS700D/IBBS700T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T or transmission cabinet TMC11H (Ver.D), are required
during an initial site construction, the auxiliary cabinets should be positioned
on the left, and the basic cabinet on the right.

Cabinet Configurations of a Single- or Dual-Mode Base Station


A single- or dual-mode base station can be configured with only one BBU, which
is installed in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet or BTS3900AL DC cabinet.

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode


base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when -48 V DC power is supplied.

Figure 1-123 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


-48 V DC power is supplied

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode


base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 234


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and backup power is


not required.

Figure 1-124 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is not required

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode


base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and short-term
backup power is required.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 235


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-125 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


short-term backup power is required

Figure 1-126 and Figure 1-127 show the cabinet configurations of a single- or
dual-mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment
and RF configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and medium-
to long-term backup power is required.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 236


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-126 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS700D or IBBS700T

Figure 1-127 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS300D or IBBS300T

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station in the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for customer
equipment, and RF configurations.

Table 1-82 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Power Supply Backup Space for Cabinet Configuration


Power Customer
Requirement Equipment

-48 V DC N/A ≤ 11 U 1 BTS3900AL DC cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 237


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Backup Space for Cabinet Configuration


Power Customer
Requirement Equipment

110 V AC or No backup ≤ 11 U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


220 V AC power

Short-term ≤4U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


backup power
≤ 15 U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
TMC11H (Ver.D)

Medium- to ≤ 11 U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1


long-term IBBS700D/IBBS700T
backup power 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

NOTICE

(1) When short-term backup power is required, a pack of four storage batteries
needs to be installed in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet. The prerequisites for
configuring the built-in storage batteries are as follows:
● The ambient temperature in the cabinet is below 40°C (104°F).
● The storage batteries must be used in the first class power grid. In the first
class power grid, the average power-off time of AC power supply every month
is less than ten hours.
● It is recommended that a pack of Northstar 100 Ah storage batteries be used
to meet the high-current discharge requirements.
● The maximum power consumption of a base station is 10,000 W.
(2) When medium- to long-duration backup power is used, an external battery
cabinet needs to be configured. It is recommended that the battery cabinet be
configured with a minimum of 300 Ah, that is, a minimum of two 150 Ah battery
packs.
(3) A base station cannot be configured with both the built-in storage batteries
and the external battery cabinet.
(4) When an IBBS700D or IBBS300D is configured, reduce the ambient
temperature to 40°C (104°F). When an IBBS700T or IBBS300T is configured, the
ambient temperature can remain unchanged.

Cabinet Configurations of a Triple- or Quadruple-Mode Base Station


If a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with two BBUs, both of
them are installed in a BTS3900AL AC cabinet or BTS3900AL DC cabinet.
If a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with one BBU, a filler
panel should be installed in the position illustrated by BBU1 in the following
figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 238


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

In the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for customer


equipment, and RF configurations, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or
quadruple-mode base station are the same as those of a single- or dual-mode
base station, as described in Table 1-83.
The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-
mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when -48 V DC power is supplied.

Figure 1-128 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when -48 V DC power is supplied

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-


mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and backup power is
not required.

Figure 1-129 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is not required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 239


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-


mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer equipment and RF
configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied and short-term
backup power is required.

Figure 1-130 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when short-term backup power is required

Figure 1-131 and Figure 1-132 show the cabinet configurations of a triple- or
quadruple-mode base station in the case of different spaces for customer

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 240


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

equipment and RF configurations when 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied


and medium- to long-term backup power is required.

Figure 1-131 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS700D or
IBBS700T

Figure 1-132 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when medium- to long-term backup power is provided by an IBBS300D or
IBBS300T

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station in the case of different backup power requirements, spaces for
customer equipment, and RF configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 241


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-83 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


Power Supply Backup Space for Cabinet Configuration
Power Customer
Requirement Equipment

-48 V DC N/A ≤9U 1 BTS3900AL DC cabinet

110 V AC or No backup ≤9U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


220 V AC power

Short-term ≤2U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet


backup power
≤ 13 U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
TMC11H (Ver.D)

Medium- to ≤9U 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1


long-term IBBS700D/IBBS700T
backup power 1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T
1 BTS3900AL AC cabinet+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

NOTICE

(1) When short-term backup power is required, a pack of four storage batteries
needs to be installed in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet. The prerequisites for
configuring the built-in storage batteries are as follows:
● The ambient temperature in the cabinet is below 40°C (104°F).
● The storage batteries must be used in the first class power grid. In the first
class power grid, the average power-off time of AC power supply every month
is less than ten hours.
● It is recommended that a pack of Northstar 100 Ah storage batteries be used
to meet the high-current discharge requirements.
● The maximum power consumption of a base station is 10,000 W.
(2) When medium- to long-duration backup power is used, an external battery
cabinet needs to be configured. It is recommended that the battery cabinet be
configured with a minimum of 300 Ah, that is, a minimum of two 150 Ah battery
packs.
(3) A base station cannot be configured with both the built-in storage batteries
and the external battery cabinet.
(4) When an IBBS700D or IBBS300D is configured, reduce the ambient
temperature to 40°C (104°F). When an IBBS700T or IBBS300T is configured, the
ambient temperature can remain unchanged.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 242


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.4.3 Power Requirements of a BTS3900AL (Ver.A)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when AC power is supplied to a
BTS3900AL.

Table 1-84 Power requirements in AC scenarios

Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable Length


Supply Configuration Requirement Sectional Requirement
for Circuit Area of the
Breakers on Input Power
Customer Cable
Equipment(2)

220 V AC 7 PSUs+1 SOU 1x63 A/3 P 10 mm2 ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (recommended) (0.016 in.2) ft)

4 to 6 PSUs+1 1x40 A/3 P


SOU

4 to 7 PSUs+1 1x63 A/3 P


HAU+1 SOU

220 V AC 7 PSUs+1 SOU 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2


single- (recommended) (0.054 in.2)
phase
6 PSUs+1 SOU 1x125 A/1 P

5 PSUs+1 SOU 1x100 A/1 P

4 PSUs+1 SOU 1x80 A/1 P

6 PSUs+1 HAU 1x125 A/1 P


+1 SOU

5 PSUs+1 HAU 1x125 A/1 P


+1 SOU

4 PSUs+1 HAU 1x100 A/1 P


+1 SOU

110 V AC 7 PSUs+1 SOU 1x125 A/2 P 35 mm2


dual-live- (recommended) (0.054 in.2)
wire
6 PSUs+1 SOU 1x125 A/2 P

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 243


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable Length


Supply Configuration Requirement Sectional Requirement
for Circuit Area of the
Breakers on Input Power
Customer Cable
Equipment(2)

5 PSUs+1 SOU 1x100 A/2 P

4 PSUs+1 SOU 1x80 A/2 P

DC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when DC power is supplied to a
BTS3900AL.

Table 1-85 Power requirements in DC scenarios


Power Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable
Supply Equipme Configurati Requiremen Sectional Length
nt on(1) t for Circuit Area of Requireme
Breakers on the Input nt
Customer Power
Equipment(2 Cable
)

-48 V DC PDU03D- 9 high- 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 ≤ 15 m


01_INPUT power RFUs (recommend (0.039 in.2) (49.21 ft)
0 ed) (low smoke
zero
6 high- 2x100 A/1 P
halogen)
power RFUs
+3 low-
power RFUs

3 high- 2x100 A/1 P


power RFUs
+6 low-
power RFUs

9 low- 1x125 A/1 P


power RFUs 2x63 A/1 P

PDU03D- 12 RRUs 2x125 A/1 P


01_INPUT (power
1 consumptio
n per RRU ≤
560 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 244


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable


Supply Equipme Configurati Requiremen Sectional Length
nt on(1) t for Circuit Area of Requireme
Breakers on the Input nt
Customer Power
Equipment(2 Cable
)

9 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P


(power
consumptio
n per RRU ≤
560 W)

6 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P


(power (recommend
consumptio ed)
n per RRU ≤ 2x63 A/1 P
560 W)

3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P


(power
consumptio
n per RRU ≤
560 W)

PDU03D- 2 BBUs 1x63 A/1 P


01_INPUT +transmissi (recommend
2 on ed)
equipment

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RF modules and low-power RF modules are configured in one base
station, the specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of
high-power RF modules.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RF modules. If the originally configured circuit
breakers do not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RF
modules, replace the circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 245


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.4.4 Power Distribution Schemes for BTS3900AL (Ver.A) Cabinets


This section describes power distribution schemes for BTS3900AL cabinets.

Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900AL AC Cabinet


When a BTS3900AL AC cabinet is supplied with 220 V AC or 110 V AC power, the
input AC power is distributed by the PDU05A-01 and converted into DC power by
the ETP48400 in the BTS3900AL AC cabinet. The DC power is distributed by the
DCDU-12C to components in the cabinet.
After going through the PDU05A-01, the AC power input is divided into five AC
power outputs:
● One AC output is connected to the junction box on the right side of the
cabinet door, and divided into four AC outputs, which are then provided for
the HAU01A-01.
● Three AC power outputs are connected to the PSUs (R4850G2) and converted
by the PSUs (R4850G2) into DC power outputs, which are then provided for
the DCDU-12C and storage batteries.
● One AC output is provided for the SOU.
Figure 1-133 shows the power distribution scheme for a BTS3900AL AC cabinet
supplied with 220 V AC three-phase power. The power distribution scheme in 220
V AC single-phase or 110 V AC dual-live-wire scenarios is the same as that in 220
V AC three-phase scenarios. To support different types of power supply, the power
input terminals need to be connected to different short-circuiting bars, as shown
in Figure 1-134.

NOTE

If RFUs and RRUs are configured, LOAD3 and LOAD5 ports on the ETP48400 provide DC
power for the DCDU-11B/DCDU-12C/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02B/EPU02S/
EPU02S-02. The following uses the DCDU-12C as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 246


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-133 Power distribution scheme for a cabinet supplied with 220 V AC
three-phase power

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses.

Table 1-86 Specifications of the circuit breakers


Power Distribution Specifications of the Specifications of the
Device Circuit Breaker for the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
AC Output the DC Output

PDU05A-01 ● PSU1/5: 1x40 A -


● PSU2/6: 1x40 A
● PSU3/4/7: 1x63 A
● HEATER: 1x25 A
● SOU: 1x10 A

ETP48400 - ● DCDU-12C 0#: 1x100 A


● DCDU-12C 1#: 1x200 A
● Storage battery: 1x400
A

DCDU-12C 0# - 10x30 A

DCDU-12C 1# - 10x30 A

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 247


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-134 Configuration of short-circuiting bars

Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900AL DC Cabinet


A BTS3900AL DC cabinet is supplied with external DC power, which is distributed
by the PDU03D-01 to the DCDU-12C. The following figure shows the power
distribution scheme for a BTS3900AL DC cabinet.
NOTE

If RFUs and RRUs are configured, the INPUT1 port on the PDU03D-01 provides DC power
for the DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02S-02.
The following uses the DCDU-12C as an example.

Figure 1-135 Power distribution scheme for a BTS3900AL DC cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 248


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the specifications of fuses.

Table 1-87 Fuse specifications

Power Distribution Device Fuse Specifications

DCDU-12C 0# 10x30 A

DCDU-12C 1# 10x30 A

1.2.4.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900AL


This section lists the reference sections in 3900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS3900AL.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS3900AL, see BTS3900AL (Ver.A) Cable List.

Cable Connections
For cable connections for a BTS3900AL, see topics related to Cable Connections in
3900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Table 1-88 Cable connections

Power Monitorin Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable RF Cable


Cable g Signal on Cable Interconne Connectio Connectio
Connectio Cable Connectio ction ns ns
ns Connectio ns Signal
ns Cable
Connectio
ns

BTS3900AL BTS3900AL Transmissio BBU CPRI Cable RF Cable


(Ver.A) (Ver.A) n Cable Interconne Connection Connection
Power Monitoring Connection ction s for 3900 s
Cable Signal s for 3900 Signal Series Base
Connection Cable Series Base Cable Stations
s Connection Stations Connection
s s

1.2.5 DBS3900
This section describes cabinets and racks, applications of cabinets and racks, power
requirements, power distribution schemes, and cable connections of a DBS3900.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 249


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.1 Cabinets and Racks Used by a DBS3900


A DBS3900 is a distributed base station, which is composed of cabinets (such as
APM5950H series cabinets, APM5950H-L series cabinets, IBC10, APM30H series
cabinets, TMC11H series cabinets, battery cabinets, OMB series cabinets,
MRE1000, and IMB03) and racks (such as IFS06 and INS12).

Cabinets and Racks


With the improvement in designing cabinets, Huawei has many types of cabinets
and racks applicable to a DBS3900. These cabinets meet the requirements of
power distribution, module configuration, and space for customer equipment. The
following table describes the cabinets and racks used by a DBS3900 configured
with a BBU3900 or BBU3910.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 250


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-89 Cabinets and racks used by a DBS3900 configured with a BBU3900 or
BBU3910
Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack
/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

APM59 ● APM595 ● In AC For details, see For details, see


50H 0H scenarios, an Configurations of APM5950H/
series (Ver.A), APM5950H the APM5950H APM5900H.
cabinets which is (Ver.A) and APM5900H.
shortene supplies
d to power to the
APM595 BBUs, RRUs,
0H and other
● APM590 components,
0H as well as
(Ver.A), other
which is cabinets.
shortene ● In DC
d to scenarios, an
APM590 APM5900H
0H (Ver.A) can
be used as a
power
cabinet to
supply
power to the
BBUs or
RRUs.
Alternatively,
this cabinet
can be used
as a
transmission
cabinet to
provide
space for
transmission
equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 251


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

APM59 ● APM595 ● In AC For details, see For details, see


50H-L 0H-L scenarios, an Configurations of Figure 1-343.
series (Ver.A), APM5950H- the APM5950H-L
cabinets which is L (Ver.A) and APM5900H-L.
shortene supplies
d to power to the
APM595 BBUs, RRUs,
0H-L and other
● APM590 components,
0H-L as well as
(Ver.A), other
which is cabinets.
shortene ● In DC
d to scenarios, an
APM590 APM5900H-
0H-L L (Ver.A) can
be used as a
power
cabinet to
supply
power to the
BBUs or
RRUs.
Alternatively,
this cabinet
can be used
as a
transmission
cabinet to
provide
space for
transmission
equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 252


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

APM59 ● APM593 ● In AC For details, see For details, see


30 0(AC) scenarios, an Components in APM5930.
cabinets (Ver.A), APM5930(A APM5930s.
which is C) (Ver.A)
shortene supplies
d to power to the
APM593 BBUs, RRUs,
0(AC) and other
● APM593 components,
0(DC) as well as
(Ver.A), other
which is cabinets.
shortene ● In DC
d to scenarios, an
APM593 APM5930(D
0(DC) C) (Ver.A)
can be used
as a power
cabinet to
supply
power to the
BBUs or
RRUs.
Alternatively,
this cabinet
can be used
as a
transmission
cabinet to
provide
space for
transmission
equipment.

APM30 ● APM30H The APM30H ● For details, see For details, see
Ha (Ver.C) provides power Components in Figure 1-136.
series ● APM30H for components APM30Hs.
cabinets (Ver.D) in it and to
other cabinets
● APM30H in AC scenarios.
(Ver.E)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 253


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

TMC11 ● TMC11H The TMC11H ● For details, see For details, see
Hb (Ver.C) can serve as a Components in Figure 1-136.
series ● TMC11H power cabinet TMC11Hs.
cabinets (Ver.D) in DC scenarios
or as a
● TMC11H transmission
(Ver.E) cabinet based
on the
transmission
space
requirement.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 254


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

IBBSc ● IBBS700 The IBBS is a ● For details, see ● For details,


series D and battery cabinet Components in see Figure
cabinets IBBS700T that provides an IBBS700D 1-146.
● IBBS200 backup power and ● For details,
D (Ver.C) for a site. Components in see Figure
and an IBBS700T. 1-147.
IBBS200T ● For details, see ● For details,
(Ver.C) Components in see Figure
● IBBS200 IBBS200Ds and 1-148.
D (Ver.D) Components in
IBBS200Ts. ● For details,
and see Figure
IBBS200T ● For details, see 1-149.
(Ver.D) Components in
IBBS200Ds and ● For details,
● IBBS200 see Figure
D (Ver.E) Components in
IBBS200Ts. 1-150.
and
IBBS200T ● For details, see
(Ver.E) Components in
● IBBS300 IBBS200Ds and
D (Ver.A) Components in
and IBBS200Ts.
IBBS300T ● For details, see
(Ver.A) Components in
● IBBS20L( IBBS200Ds and
10) Components in
IBBS200Ts.
● For details, see
Components in
IBBS300Ds and
Components in
IBBS300Ts.
● For details, see
Components in
an IBBS20D.
● For details, see
IBBS20L
Hardware
Description.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 255


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

OMBd ● OMB The OMB series For details, see For details, see
series (Ver.C) cabinets are Components in Figure 1-152.
cabinets mini power OMBs (Ver.C).
cabinets used in
outdoor
distributed base
stations to
provide AC or
DC power.

IMBe ● IMB03 The IMB series For details, see For details, see
series ● IMB05 subracks are Components in Figure 1-153.
cabinets mini subracks IMB03s and
used in an Components in an
indoor IMB05.
distributed base
station to
provide AC or
DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 256


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

IFS06f IFS06 ● An IFS06 is ● For components For details, see


an indoor of an IFS06, see Figure 1-153.
floor- Components of
mounted an IFS06.
rack for ● For details
installing about
RRUs components
indoors in a and
centralized configurations
manner. of an ICR, see
● The the following
combination path: 3900 &
of an IMB03 5900 Series
and an Base Station
IFS06, which Product
is called Documentatio
indoor n (Hardware
centralized Installation) >
rack (ICR), Installation
can support and
the Commissioning
centralized > Base Station
installation Installation
of a Guide >
distributed DBS3900 &
base station. DBS5900
Installation
Guide > IFS06
Installation
Guide.

19-inch ● INS12g The INS12 is an For details, see For details, see
rack ● 19-inch indoor Components of an Figure 1-153.
rack medium- INS12.
provided capacity rack
by an that provides
operator 12 U space for
19-inch
equipment.

IBC10h IBC10 An IBC10 For details, see For details, see


provides power Components in an Figure 1-154.
for components IBC10.
in it and to
other cabinets
in DC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 257


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

MRE100 MRE1000 An MRE1000 For details, see For details, see


0i supplies power Components in an Figure 1-154.
to Book RRUs MRE1000 Cabinet.
and AAU5940s
when being
used in AC
power supply
scenarios such
as streets and
residential
areas.

ILC29j ILC29 An ILC29 is an For details, see For details, see


(Ver.E) indoor cabinet Components in an Figure 1-156.
used in an ILC29.
indoor
distributed base
station. The
cabinet of this
type can be
supplied with
DC power and
provides DC
power for the
BBU, fan
assembly, RRU,
and other
modules.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 258


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

BBC ● BBC5200 The BBC series For details, see: ● For details,
series D cabinets are ● Components in see Exterior
cabinets ● BBC5200 battery cabinets a BBC5200D of a
T and are used BBC5200D.
together with ● Components in
● BBC5300 a BBC5200T ● For details,
APM5950H-L/ see Exterior
D APM5950H/ ● Components in of a
● BBC5300 APM5930/ a BBC5300D BBC5200T.
T APM30H series ● Components in
cabinets to ● For details,
● BBC5200 a BBC5300T see Exterior
D-L supply backup
power for sites. ● Components in of a
● BBC5600 a BBC5200D-L BBC5300D.
D ● Components in ● For details,
● BBC5600 a BBC5600D see Exterior
D-V ● Components in of a
● BBC5600 a BBC5600D-V BBC5300T.
A ● Configurations ● For details,
● BBC5600 of a BBC5600A see
A-V BBC5200D/
● Configurations BBC5200T/
of a BBC5600A- BBC5200D-
V L.
● For details,
see
BBC5200D/
BBC5200T/
BBC5200D-
L.
● For details,
see
BBC5600D/
BBC5600D-
V.
● For details,
see
BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-
V.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 259


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack


/Rack Rack Name Description Configuration Exterior
Type

a. APM30H: advanced power module with heat exchanger


b. TMC11H: transmission cabinet with heat exchanger
c. IBBS200T/IBBS300T/IBBS700T: integrated backup battery system with TEC;
IBBS200D/IBBS300D/IBBS700D: integrated backup battery system with direct
ventilation
d. OMB: outdoor mini box
e. IMB: indoor mini box
f. IFS06: indoor floor installation support 06
g. INS12: indoor normal support 12
h. IBC10: indoor BBU cabinet 10
i. MRE1000: multifunctional radio enclosure
j. ILC29: indoor large cabinet

The following table describes the devices used by a DBS3900 configured with a
BBU3910A.

Table 1-90 Devices used by a DBS3900 configured with a BBU3910A

Device Device Name Device Device Description


Type Introduction

Battery IBBS20Da (Ver.A) It is a direct- For details, see IBBS20D


cabinet (shortened to ventilation battery Hardware Description.
IBBS20D in this cabinet, which
section) provides backup
power.

Power ● IBBS20Lb They are ● For details on an


backup ● IBBS20L-E integrated power IBBS20L, see IBBS20L
module backup modules Hardware Description.
using lithium ● For details on an
batteries, which IBBS20L-E, see IBBS20L-E
provide backup Hardware Description.
power.

Power ● OPM15M They are outdoor ● For details on an


module ● OPM50M power modules, OPM15M, see OPM15M
which convert User Guide.
● OPM30M external input ● For details on an
power into -48 V OPM50M, see OPM50M
DC power and User Guide.
distribute the
power to BBUs ● For details on an
and RRUs. OPM30M, see OPM30M
User Guide.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 260


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Device Device Name Device Device Description


Type Introduction

a. IBBS20D: integrated backup battery system with direct ventilation


b. IBBS20L: integrated backup battery system with Li

APM30H/TMC11H
The following figure shows the exteriors of APM30H and TMC11H series cabinets.

Figure 1-136 Exteriors of APM30Hs and TMC11Hs

APM5950H/APM5900H
The following figure shows the exterior of an APM5950H or an APM5900H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 261


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-137 Exterior of an APM5950H/APM5900H

APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L
The following figure shows the exterior of an APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 262


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-138 Exterior of an APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L

APM5930
The following figure shows the exterior of an APM5930(AC) or an APM5930(DC).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 263


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-139 Exterior of an APM5930

BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V
The following figure shows the exterior of a BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V.

Figure 1-140 Exterior of a BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 264


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V

Figure 1-141 Exterior of a BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V

BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5200D-L
The following figures show the exteriors of a BBC5200D/BBC5200D-L/BBC5200T.

Figure 1-142 Exterior of a BBC5200D/BBC5200D-L

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 265


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-143 Exterior of a BBC5200T

BBC5300D/BBC5300T
The following figures show the exteriors of a BBC5300D and a BBC5300T.

Figure 1-144 Exterior of a BBC5300D

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 266


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-145 Exterior of a BBC5300T

IBBS700D/IBBS700T
The following figure shows the exteriors of an IBBS700D and an IBBS700T.

Figure 1-146 Exteriors of an IBBS700D and an IBBS700T

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 267


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

IBBS200D/IBBS200T
The following figure shows the exteriors of IBBS200Ds and IBBS200Ts.

Figure 1-147 Exteriors of IBBS200Ds and IBBS200Ts

IBBS300D/IBBS300T
The following figure shows the exteriors of an IBBS300D (Ver.A) and an IBBS300T
(Ver.A). IBBS300D (Ver.A) is shortened to IBBS300D and IBBS300T (Ver.A) is
shortened to IBBS300T in this section.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 268


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-148 Exteriors of an IBBS300D and an IBBS300T

IBBS20D
The following figure shows the exterior of an IBBS20D.

Figure 1-149 Exterior of an IBBS20D

IBBS20L/IBBS20L-E
The following figures show the exteriors of an IBBS20L and an IBBS20L-E.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 269


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-150 Exterior of an IBBS20L

Figure 1-151 Exterior of an IBBS20L-E

OMB (Ver.C)
The following figure shows the exterior of an OMB (Ver.C).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 270


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-152 Exterior of an OMB (Ver.C)

IMB05/IMB03/IFS06/INS12
The following figure shows the exteriors of an IMB03, an IMB05, an IFS06, and an
INS12.

Figure 1-153 Exteriors of an IMB03, an IMB05, an IFS06, and an INS12

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 271


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

IBC10
The following figure shows the exterior of an IBC10.

Figure 1-154 Exterior of an IBC10

MRE1000
The following figure shows the exterior of an MRE1000.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 272


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-155 Exterior of an MRE1000

ILC29 (Ver.E)
The following figure shows the exterior of an ILC29 (Ver.E).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 273


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-156 Exterior of an ILC29 (Ver.E)

1.2.5.2 Application Scenarios of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3900 or


BBU3910
This section describes the application scenarios of a DBS3900 configured with
different cabinets and a BBU3900 or BBU3910, including the outdoor AC scenario,
outdoor DC scenario, indoor AC scenario, and indoor DC scenario.

1.2.5.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS3900 is installed outdoors and
supplied with AC power.
The following table describes the scenarios where BBUs are installed outdoors and
the DBS3900 is supplied with AC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 274


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-91 BBU installation scenarios


BBU Installation Scenario Description Remarks
Scenario

APM5950H/APM5900H BBU 0 is installed in an BBU Installed in an


APM5950H, BBU 1 is APM5950H/APM5900H
installed in an
APM5950H or
APM5900H, and RRUs
are installed remotely.
The APM5950H supplies
power to the BBUs and
RRUs.

APM5950H-L/ BBU 0 is installed in an BBU Installed in an


APM5900H-L APM5950H-L, BBU 1 is APM5950H-L/
installed in an APM5900H-L
APM5950H-L or
APM5900H-L, and RRUs
are installed remotely.
The APM5950H-L
supplies power to the
BBUs and RRUs.

APM5930(AC)/ BBU 0 is installed in an BBU Installed in an


APM5930(DC) APM5930(AC), BBU 1 is APM5930(AC)/
installed in an APM5930(DC)
APM5930(AC) or
APM5930(DC), and RRUs
are installed remotely.
The APM5930(AC)
supplies power to the
BBUs and RRUs.

APM30H (Ver.E)/ BBU 0 is installed in an BBU Installed in an


TMC11H (Ver.E) APM30H (Ver.E), BBU 1 APM30H (Ver.E)/
is installed in an TMC11H (Ver.E)
APM30H (Ver.E) or
TMC11H (Ver.E), and
RRUs are installed
remotely. The APM30H
(Ver.E) or TMC11H
(Ver.E) supplies power to
the BBUs, and the
APM30H (Ver.E) supplies
power to the RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 275


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installation Scenario Description Remarks


Scenario

APM30H (Ver.D)/ BBU 0 is installed in an BBU Installed in an


TMC11H (Ver.D) APM30H (Ver.D), BBU 1 APM30H (Ver.D)/
is installed in an TMC11H (Ver.D)
APM30H (Ver.D) or
TMC11H (Ver.D), and
RRUs are installed
remotely. The APM30H
(Ver.D) or TMC11H
(Ver.D) supplies power to
the BBUs, and the
APM30H (Ver.D) supplies
power to the RRUs.

APM30H (Ver.C) The BBU is installed in BBU Installed in an


an APM30H (Ver.C), and APM30H (Ver.C)
RRUs are installed
remotely. The APM30H
(Ver.C) supplies power to
the BBU and RRUs.

TP48600A The BBU is installed in a BBU Installed in a


TP48600A, and RRUs are TP48600A
installed remotely. The
TP48600A supplies
power to the BBU and
RRUs.

OMB (Ver.C) The BBU is installed in BBU Installed in an


an OMB (Ver.C) and OMB (Ver.C)
RRUs are installed
remotely. The OMB
(Ver.C) supplies power to
the BBU and RRUs.

MRE1000 When a BBU is installed BBU Installed in an


in an MRE1000 or MRE1000
multiple BBUs are
installed indoors in a
centralized manner, the
AAU5940s or Book RRUs
are installed remotely
and the MRE1000
provides power for the
BBU and Book RRUs or
AAU5940s.

Cabinet Configuration Principles for a DBS3900


The general configuration principles for a DBS3900 are as follows:

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 276


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● A DBS3900 configured with an APM30H (Ver.E) supports a maximum of 21


RRUs. A DBS3900 configured with an APM30H (Ver.D) supports a maximum
of 15 RRUs. A DBS3900 configured with Ver.D and Ver.E cabinets supports a
maximum of 15 RRUs. A DBS3900 configured with an OMB (Ver.C) supports a
maximum of 6 RRUs. A DBS3900 configured with other cabinets supports a
maximum of 12 RRUs.
● In initial deployment scenarios, the auxiliary cabinet such as the battery
cabinet or transmission cabinet, if required, is positioned on the left side of
the cabinet housing main equipment. In capacity expansion scenarios, unless
otherwise specified, the original cabinets remain in the original positions and
new cabinets are added to the right side of the original cabinets. In special
scenarios, new cabinets can be added to the left side of the original cabinets.
The configuration principles for a DBS3900 using an APM30H series cabinet
are as follows:
● An APM30H can be installed side by side with only one TMC11H or stacked
on a maximum of two IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts. (An
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T can be stacked on another cabinet
of the same type.)
● An APM30H/TMC11H can be installed on the ground or stacked on an
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T.
● An APM30H (Ver.D) can be installed side by side with only one IBBS700D/
IBBS700T.
● If both a battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are configured, the
battery cabinet is preferentially positioned on the left side of the cabinet
housing main equipment, and the transmission cabinet is stacked on the
battery cabinet or positioned on the left side of the battery cabinet.
The configuration principles for a DBS3900 using a TP48600A are as follows:
● A TP48600A can be installed together with a TMC11H (Ver.D)/TMC11H
(Ver.E) side by side.
● A TP48600A can be installed together with an IBB300D/IBBS300T/IBBS700D/
IBBS700T side by side.
Restrictions on the cabinet configurations in a base station (Ver.D+Ver.E)
● If a Ver.E cabinet is installed on a Ver.D base, the cabling capability at the
bottom of the Ver.E cabinet is the same as that of a Ver.D cabinet.
● If an APM30H (Ver.E) supplies power to a Ver.D series battery cabinet, the
power distribution capability of the APM30H (Ver.E) is the same as that of an
APM30H (Ver.D).
● If an APM30H (Ver.E) is stacked on an RFC (Ver.D), the cabling capability at
the bottom of the APM30H (Ver.E) is the same as that of an APM30H (Ver.D).

NOTE

For details about the configuration principles of a DBS3900 base station using APM5950H/
APM5950H-L/APM5930 series cabinets, see Combination Principles of APM5950H Series
Cabinets/Combination Principles of APM5950H-L Series Cabinets/Combination
Principles of APM5930 Series Cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 277


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Configuration Principles of BBUs in Applicable Cabinets


● When a DBS3900 is configured with an APM or TMC series cabinet and a
TP48600A, the DBS3900 can be a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode
base station. When a DBS3900 is configured with an OMB series cabinet, the
DBS3900 can be only a single- or dual-mode base station.
● When a single- or dual-mode base station is configured with only one BBU,
the BBU is installed in the basic cabinet.
● When a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with one BBU,
the BBU is installed in the basic cabinet.
● When a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with two BBUs:
– If two BBUs are configured during initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H/APM5930(AC)/APM5950H/APM5950H-L, and
transmission equipment is installed in a TMC11H/APM5930(DC)/
APM5900H/APM5900H-L.
– If there is space for a second BBU in the APM30H/APM5930(AC)/
APM5950H/APM5950H-L during capacity expansion, the BBU is
preferentially installed in the APM30H/APM5930(AC)/APM5950H/
APM5950H-L. Otherwise, the BBU is installed in a TMC11H/
APM5930(DC)/APM5900H/APM5900H-L.

BBU Installed in an APM5950H/APM5900H


An APM5950H that is installed side by side with or stacked with BBC series
cabinets can supply power to a maximum of 27 RRUs. The following table
describes the mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-92 RRU power distribution scheme

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs LOAD12 to LOAD17 -


(power consumption per ports on the
RRU ≤ 800 W) EPU07A-01/02

Seventh to twenty- 4 PDU06D-01 modulesa One PDU06D-01 can


seventh RRUs (power supply power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

Seventh to twenty- ● 2 PDU06D-01 ● One PDU06D-01 can


seventh RRUs modules: 12 RRUs supply power to 6
● 12 RRUs (power (power consumption RRUs.
consumption per RRU per RRU ≤ 800 W) ● One PDU03D-03 can
≤ 800 W) ● 3 PDU03D-03 supply power to 3
● 9 RRUs (800 W < modulesa: 9 RRUs RRUs.
power consumption (800 W < power
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) consumption per RRU
≤ 1400 W)

a: The PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03 is configured in the EPU07A-01/02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 278


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet configurations given different backup power
requirements, requirements on space for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-93 Cabinet configurations

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Combination


Supply p Customer Configurat
Power Equipment ion
Requir
ement

110 V No Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H


AC or backup 7U
220 V power Two BBUs: ≤
AC 4U

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H


21 U
Two BBUs: ≤
18 U

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 BBC5600D/


50Hs 7U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
and Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC 4U BBC5200T/BBC5300D/
series BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/
cabinet IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
s IBBS300D/IBBS300Ta
initially
configu Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H+1
red on 21 U BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
a 1:1 Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V/
ratio 18 U BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
BBC5200D-L/IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+2 BBC5600Ds/


50Hs 7U BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
and Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/
BBC 4U BBC5200Ts/BBC5300Ds/
series BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/
cabinet IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
s IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
initially
configu Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H+2
red on 21 U BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
a 1:2 Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/
ratio 18 U BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 279


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Combination


Supply p Customer Configurat
Power Equipment ion
Requir
ement

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 BBC5600D-V/


7U BBC5600A-V+1 BBC5600Db/
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A
4U

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H+1


21 U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V/
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
18 U BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
BBC5600D/BBC5600A/
BBC5200D-L

a: When the APM5950H series cabinets are used with the BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T, the carrier
configuration capability depends on the circuit breaker capability of the old
battery cabinet. When the APM5950H series cabinets are used with the
BBC5200D-L, the carrier configuration capability depends on the backup power
capability of the old battery cabinet.
b: In lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration scenarios, it is recommended
that the discharge power of the lithium batteries be greater than the total
power of the entire base station. This prevents the lithium battery protection
due to insufficient power supply capacity of lead-acid batteries in the later
period of the discharge which causes the entire base station to be powered off.

When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 280


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-157 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 281


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950Hs and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the BBC5600D as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 282


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-158 Configurations of cabinets when APM5950Hs and BBC/IBBS series


cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 283


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 284


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950Hs and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the single-or dual-mode base
station and BBC5600D as an example.
NOTE

Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration of 1 BBC5600D/BBC5600A and 1 BBC5600D-V/


BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T or 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V and 1 BBC5200D-L can be used to provide backup
power for the APM5950H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 285


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-159 APM5950Hs and BBC/IBBS series cabinets initially configured on a


1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 286


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 287


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L


An APM5950H-L that is installed side by side with or stacked with BBC series
cabinets can supply power to a maximum of 15 RRUs. The following table
describes the mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-94 RRU power distribution scheme

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs LOAD8 to LOAD13 ports -


(power consumption per on the EPU04A-01/02
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to fifteenth 2 PDU06D-01 modulesa One PDU06D-01 can


RRUs (power supply power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

Seventh to fifteenth 3 PDU03D-03 modulesa One PDU03D-03 can


RRUs (800 W < power supply power to 3 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
1400 W)

a: The PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03 is configured in the EPU04A-01/02.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations given different backup power
requirements, requirements on space for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-95 Cabinet configurations

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

110 V No Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L


AC or backup 7U
220 V power
AC Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1
21 U APM5900H-L

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


50H-Ls 7U BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
and BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V/
BBC BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
series BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
cabinet BBC5200D-L/IBBS200D/
s IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
initially IBBS300T
configu

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 288


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

red on Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


a 1:1 21 U APM5900H-L+1 BBC5600D/
ratio BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC5200T/BBC5300D/
BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+2


50H-Ls 7U BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
and BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/
BBC BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
series BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
cabinet BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/
s IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
initially IBBS300Ts
configu
red on Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1
a 1:2 21 U APM5900H-L+2
ratio BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/
BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


7U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V+1
BBC5600D/BBC5600Aa

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


21 U APM5900H-L+1 BBC5600D-
V/BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC5200T/BBC5300D/
BBC5300T/IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T+1 BBC5600D/
BBC5600A/BBC5200D-L

a: In lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration scenarios, it is recommended


that the discharge power of the lithium batteries be greater than the total
power of the entire base station. This prevents the lithium battery protection
due to insufficient power supply capacity of lead-acid batteries in the later
period of the discharge which causes the entire base station to be powered off.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 289


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-160 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 290


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-161 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950H-Ls and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the BBC5600A as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 291


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-162 Configurations of cabinets when APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series


cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 292


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-163 Configurations of cabinets when APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series


cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 293


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950H-Ls and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the single-or dual-mode base
station and BBC5600A as an example.
NOTE

Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration of 1 BBC5600D/BBC5600A and 1 BBC5600D-V/


BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T or 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V and 1 BBC5200D-L can be used to provide backup
power for the APM5950H-L.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 294


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-164 APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series cabinets initially configured on a


1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 295


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-165 APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series cabinets initially configured on a


1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 296


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM5930(AC)/APM5930(DC)


An APM5930(AC) that is installed side by side with or stacked with BBC series
cabinets can supply power to a maximum of 21 RRUs. The following table
describes the mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-96 RRU power distribution scheme

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs LOAD12 to LOAD17 -


(power consumption per ports on the
RRU ≤ 800 W) EPU05A-11/12

Seventh to twenty-first 3 PDU06D-01 modules One PDU06D-01 can


RRUs (power supply power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

Seventh to twenty-first ● 2 PDU06D-01 ● One PDU06D-01 can


RRUs modules: 9 RRUs supply power to 6
● 9 RRUs (power (power consumption RRUs.
consumption per RRU per RRU ≤ 800 W) ● One EPU02D-02/
≤ 800 W) ● 2 EPU02D-02/ DCDU16D/
● 6 RRUs (800 W < DCDU16D/ PDU03D-03/
power consumption PDU03D-03/ BDU70-03 can supply
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) BDU70-03 modules/3 power to 3 RRUs. One
SDU60-02 modulesa: SDU60-02 can supply
6 RRUs (800 W < power to 2 RRUs. The
power consumption EPU02D-02 is used as
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) an example in figures.

a: The BDU70-03 and SDU60-02 are configured in the EPU05A subrack.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations given different backup power
requirements, requirements on space for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-97 Cabinet configurations

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

110 V No Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)


AC or backup 5U
220 V power Two BBUs: ≤
AC 3U

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 297


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


16 U APM5930(DC)
Two BBUs: ≤
14 U

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


30(AC) 5U BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
cabinet Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
s and 3U BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/
BBC BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
series BBC5600A-V
cabinet
s Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1
initially 16 U APM5930(DC)+1
configu Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
red on 14 U BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
a 1:1 BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/
ratio BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-V

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+2


30(AC) 5U BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
cabinet Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
s and 3U BBC5200D-Ls/BBC5600Ds/
BBC BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
series BBC5600A-Vs
cabinet
s Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1
initially 16 U APM5930(DC)+2
configu Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
red on 14 U BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
a 1:2 BBC5200D-Ls/BBC5600Ds/
ratio BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
BBC5600A-Vs

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


5U BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
3U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V+1
BBC5200D-L/BBC5600Da/
BBC5600A

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 298


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


16 U APM5930(DC)+1
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
14 U BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V+1
BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/
BBC5600A

a: In lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration scenarios, it is recommended


that the discharge power of the lithium batteries be greater than the total
power of the entire base station. This prevents the lithium battery protection
due to insufficient power supply capacity of lead-acid batteries in the later
period of the discharge which causes the entire base station to be powered off.

When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 299


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-166 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 300


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5930(AC) cabinets and
BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the
cabinet configurations given different requirements on space for customer
equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 301


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-167 Configurations of cabinets when APM5930(AC) cabinets and BBC


series cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 302


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5930(AC) cabinets and
BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V cabinets are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet
configurations given different requirements on space for customer equipment and

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 303


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

carrier configurations are shown in the following figures. These figures use a
single- or dual-mode base station as an example.
NOTE

● Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration 1 BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/


BBC5300T and 1 BBC5200D-L is supported to provide backup power for the
APM5930(AC) cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 304


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-168 APM5930(AC) cabinets and BBC series cabinets initially configured
on a 1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 305


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 306


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM30H (Ver.E)/TMC11H (Ver.E)


An APM30H (Ver.E) that is installed side by side with or stacked with a Ver.E
cabinet can supply power to a maximum of 21 RRUs. The following table describes
the mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-98 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth LOAD9 to LOAD14 ports -


RRUs on the EPU05A-07/09

Seventh to 3 PDU03D-02 modules One PDU03D-02 can supply


fifteenth RRUs power to three RRUs.

Sixteenth to 1 PDU01D-01+1 ODM One PDU01D-01 and one ODM


twenty-first RRUs can be used together to supply
power to six RRUs.

NOTE

For details about BBU installation in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base
station, see Configuration Principles of BBUs in Applicable Cabinets. The following
figures use a base station configured with two BBUs as an example.

The APM30H (Ver.E) can be used with Ver.D cabinets to power a maximum of 15
RRUs. For details about cabinet configurations, see BBU Installed in an APM30H
(Ver.D)/TMC11H (Ver.D).
When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 307


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-169 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different requirements
on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the
following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 308


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-170 Cabinet configurations when backup power is required and


APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure. This figure uses the single- or
dual-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 309


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-171 Cabinet configurations when backup power is required and


APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/
BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station given
different backup power requirements, requirements on space for customer
equipment, and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 310


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-99 Cabinet configurations


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Custome Configur
Require r ation
ment Equipme
nt

110 V AC No Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 ODM


or 220 V backup BBU: ≤ 5
AC power U
Two
BBUs: ≤ 3
U

Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 TMC11H + 1


BBU: ≤ 6 ODM
U
Two
BBUs: ≤ 4
U

APM30Hs Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 IBBS200D/


and BBU: ≤ 5 IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS200D U IBBS300T/BBC5600D/
s/ Two BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
IBBS200T BBUs: ≤ 3 BBC5600A-V + 1 ODM
s initially U
configure
d on a Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 TMC11H + 1
1:1 ratio BBU: ≤ 6 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
Two BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V + 1
BBUs: ≤ 4 ODM
U

APM30Hs Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 2 IBBS200D/


and BBU: ≤ 5 IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS200D U IBBS300T/BBC5600D/
s/ Two BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
IBBS200T BBUs: ≤ 3 BBC5600A-V + 1 ODM
s/ U
IBBS300D
s/ Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 TMC11H + 2
IBBS300T BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
s initially U IBBS300D/IBBS300T/
configure Two BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
d on a BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V + 1
1:2 ratio 14 U ODM

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 311


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM30H (Ver.D)/TMC11H (Ver.D)


NOTE

APM30H (Ver.D) is shortened to APM30H, and TMC11H (Ver.D) is shortened to TMC11H.

Single- or dual-mode base station

An APM30H can supply power to a maximum of 15 RRUs. When a base station is


configured with 7 to 12 RRUs, another DCDU-12B must be added to the APM30H.
When a base station is configured with 13 to 15 RRUs, an ODM and an OFD must
be configured.

When a single- or dual-mode base station is configured with only one BBU, the
BBU is installed in the APM30H.

When backup power is not required, the cabinet application scenarios of a single-
or dual-mode base station given different spaces for customer equipment and
carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-172 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different requirements
on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the single- or dual-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 312


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-173 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/BBC5600Ds/
BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure. This figure uses the single- or
dual-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 313


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-174 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially
configured on a 1:2 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS700Ds/
IBBS700Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure. This figure uses the single- or
dual-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 314


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-175 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS700Ds/IBBS700Ts are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station given different backup power requirements, requirements on space for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-100 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Power Backup Space Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power for Configur
Require Custom ation
ment er
Equipm
ent

110 V AC or No ≤5U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H


220 V AC backup
power ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 TMC11H

≤4U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 315


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power for Configur
Require Custom ation
ment er
Equipm
ent

≤ 15 U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


+1 ODM+1 OFD

≤ 15 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


+1 TMC11H

≤ 15 U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


+1 TMC11H+1 ODM+1 OFD

APM30H ≤5U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 IBBS200D/


s and IBBS200T/BBC5600D/
IBBS200 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
Ds/ BBC5600A-V
IBBS200
Ts ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 TMC11H + 1
initially IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
configur BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
ed on a BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V
1:1 ratio ≤4U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)
+ 1 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V

≤4U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


+ 1 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V + 1
ODM + 1 OFD

≤ 15 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


+ 1 TMC11H+1 IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/BBC5600D/
BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-V

≤ 15 U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


+ 1 TMC11H + 1 IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/BBC5600D/
BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-V + 1 ODM + 1
OFD

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 316


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power for Configur
Require Custom ation
ment er
Equipm
ent

● APM ≤5U ≤ 6 RRUs ● 1 APM30H + 2 IBBS200D/


30Hs IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
and IBBS300T/BBC5600D/
IBBS2 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
00Ds/ BBC5600A-V
IBBS2 ● 1 APM30H + 1 IBBS700D/
00Ts/ IBBS700T
IBBS3
00Ds/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RRUs ● 1 APM30H + 1 TMC11H
IBBS3 + 2 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
00Ts IBBS300D/IBBS300T/
initial BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
ly BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V
confi ● 1 APM30H + 1 TMC11H
gured + 1 IBBS700D/IBBS700T
on a
1:2 ≤4U ≤ 12 RRUs ● 1 APM30H (with one
ratio DCDU) + 2 IBBS200Ds/
● APM IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
30Hs IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/
and BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
IBBS7 BBC5600A-Vs
00Ds/ ● 1 APM30H (with one
IBBS7 DCDU) + 1 IBBS700D/
00Ts IBBS700T
initial
ly ≤4U ≤ 15 RRUs ● 1 APM30H (with one
confi DCDU) + 2 IBBS200Ds/
gured IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
on a IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/
1:1 BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
ratio BBC5600A-Vs + 1 ODM+1
OFD
● 1 APM30H (with one
DCDU) + 1 IBBS700D/
IBBS700T + 1 ODM + 1
OFD

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 317


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power for Configur
Require Custom ation
ment er
Equipm
ent

≤ 15 U ≤ 12 RRUs ● 1 APM30H (with one


DCDU) + 1 TMC11H+2
IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/
BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs
● 1 APM30H (with one
DCDU) + 1 TMC11H + 1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T

≤ 15 U ≤ 15 RRUs ● 1 APM30H (with one


DCDU) + 1 TMC11H + 2
IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/
BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs
+ 1 ODM + 1 OFD\
● 1 APM30H (with one
DCDU) + 1 TMC11H + 1
IBBS700D/IBBS700T + 1
ODM + 1 OFD

NOTE

When APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/


BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio and more than six RRUs are configured,
ensure that two or more 100 Ah battery packs are configured in each IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V to avoid overcurrent of a single battery
pack.

Triple- or quadruple-mode base station


When two BBUs are configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
BBUs are installed as follows:
● If two BBUs are configured during initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H, and transmission equipment is installed in a
TMC11H.
● If there is space for a second BBU in the APM30H during capacity expansion,
the BBU is installed in the APM30H. Otherwise, the BBU is installed in a
TMC11H.
When one BBU is configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
position of the BBU is indicated by BBU0 in the following figure.
When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 318


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example. In the following figure, illustrations a and b show the scenarios of new
site deployment and illustration c shows a capacity expansion scenario.

Figure 1-176 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example. In the following figure, illustrations a and b show the scenarios of new
site deployment and illustration c shows a capacity expansion scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 319


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-177 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts are
initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example. In the following figure, illustrations a and b show the scenarios of new
site deployment and illustration c shows a capacity expansion scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 320


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-178 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are
initially configured on a 1:2 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS700Ds/
IBBS700Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different requirements
on space for customer equipment are shown in the following figure. This figure
uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 321


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-179 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS700Ds/IBBS700Ts/
BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a
1:1 ratio

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station given different backup power requirements, requirements on space
for customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-101 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Custome Configur
Require r ation
ment Equipme
nt

110 V AC No ≤2U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


or 220 V backup +1 ODM+1 OFD
AC power
≤ 13 U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)
+1 TMC11H+1 ODM+1 OFD

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 322


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Custome Configur
Require r ation
ment Equipme
nt

APM30Hs ≤2U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)


and + 1 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS200D IBBS300D/IBBS300T/
s/ BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
IBBS200T BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V + 1
s initially ODM + 1 OFD
configure
d on a ≤ 13 U ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM30H (with one DCDU)
1:1 ratio + 1 TMC11H + 1 IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/BBC5600D/
BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-V + 1 ODM + 1
OFD

● APM3 ≤2U ≤ 15 RRUs ● 1 APM30H (with one


0Hs DCDU) + 2 IBBS200Ds/
and IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS20 IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/
0Ds/ BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
IBBS20 BBC5600A-Vs + 1 ODM + 1
0Ts/ OFD
IBBS30 ● 1 APM30H (with one
0Ds/ DCDU) + 1 IBBS700D/
IBBS30 IBBS700T + 1 ODM + 1
0Ts OFD
initiall
y ≤ 13 U ≤ 15 RRUs ● 1 APM30H (with one
config DCDU) + 1 TMC11H + 2
ured IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
on a IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/
1:2 BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
ratio BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs
● APM3 + 1 ODM + 1 OFD
0Hs ● 1 APM30H (with one
and DCDU) + 1 TMC11H + 1
IBBS70 IBBS700D/IBBS700T + 1
0Ds/ ODM + 1 OFD
IBBS70
0Ts
initiall
y
config
ured
on a
1:1
ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 323


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM30H (Ver.C)


Single- or dual-mode base station
When backup power is not required, the cabinet configurations of a single- or
dual-mode base station given different spaces for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-180 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure. This figure uses the single- or
dual-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 324


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-181 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure. This figure uses the single- or
dual-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 325


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-182 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts are initially
configured on a 1:2 ratio

A single DBS3900 can be configured with a maximum of 12 RRUs. An APM30H


can be connected to a maximum of 6 RRUs with 6 groups of RRU power cables,
which contain 12 groups of 2-wire fiber optic cables.
A single- or dual-mode base station can be configured with only one BBU, which
is installed in the APM30H. When 7 to 12 RRUs are configured, two APM30Hs are
required. The BBU is installed in the basic APM30H, which is on the left.
The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station given different backup power requirements, requirements on space for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 326


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-102 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurati
Requir Equipmen on
ement t

110 V AC or No ≤5U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H


220 V AC backup
power ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 TMC11H

≤ 12 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs

≤ 23 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+1 TMC11H

APM30 ≤5U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 IBBS200D/


Hs and IBBS200T
IBBS20
0Ds/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 TMC11H+1
IBBS20 IBBS200D/IBBS200T
0Ts ≤ 12 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+2 IBBS200Ds/
initially IBBS200Ts
configu
red on ≤ 23 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+1 TMC11H+2
a 1:1 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
ratio

APM30 ≤5U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H+2 IBBS200Ds/


Hs and IBBS200Ts
IBBS20
0Ds/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 TMC11H+2
IBBS20 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
0Ts ≤ 12 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+4 IBBS200Ds/
initially IBBS200Ts
configu
red on ≤ 23 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+1 TMC11H+4
a 1:2 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
ratio

Triple- or quadruple-mode base station


The configuration principles for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station are as
follows:
● When two BBUs are configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station,
BBU 0 is installed in the basic APM30H on the left, and BBU 1 is installed in
the extension APM30H on the right.
● When one BBU is configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
position of the BBU is indicated by BBU0 in the following figure.
When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 327


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-183 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 328


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-184 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts are
initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 329


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-185 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts are
initially configured on a 1:2 ratio

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station given different backup power requirements, requirements on space
for customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-103 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurati
Requirem Equipme on
ent nt

110 V AC No ≤ 10 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs


or 220 V backup
AC power ≤ 21 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+1 TMC11H

APM30Hs ≤ 10 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+2 IBBS200Ds/


and IBBS200Ts

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 330


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurati
Requirem Equipme on
ent nt

IBBS200D ≤ 21 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+1 TMC11H+2


s/ IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
IBBS200Ts
initially
configure
d on a 1:1
ratio

APM30Hs ≤ 10 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+4 IBBS200Ds/


and IBBS200Ts
IBBS200D
s/ ≤ 21 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 APM30Hs+1 TMC11H+4
IBBS200Ts IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts
initially
configure
d on a 1:2
ratio

BBU Installed in a TP48600A


Single- or dual-mode base station
A single- or dual-mode base station is configured with one BBU. A TP48600A
provides power to a maximum of 12 RRUs.
When no battery cabinet is configured initially, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the single- or dual-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 331


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-186 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


no battery cabinet is configured initially

When backup power is required in a base station and TP48600As and IBBS700Ds/
IBBS700Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the single- or dual-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 332


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-187 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and TP48600As and IBBS700Ds/IBBS700Ts are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the single- or dual-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 333


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-188 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the single- or dual-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 334


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-189 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station when


backup power is required and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts are initially
configured on a 1:2 ratio

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base
station given different backup power requirements, requirements on space for
customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-104 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configur
Requirem Equipmen ation
ent t

110 V AC or No battery ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A


220 V AC cabinet is
configured ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 TMC11H
initially. (Ver.C)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 335


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configur
Requirem Equipmen ation
ent t

TP48600A ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS700T/


s and IBBS700D
IBBS700Ds
/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS700T/
IBBS700Ts IBBS700D+1 TMC11H
initially (Ver.C)
configured
on a 1:1
ratio

TP48600A ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS300T/


s and IBBS300D
IBBS300Ds
/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS300T/
IBBS300Ts IBBS300D+1 TMC11H
initially (Ver.C)
configured
on a 1:1
ratio

TP48600A ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+2 IBBS300Ts/


s and IBBS300Ds
IBBS300Ds
/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+2 IBBS300Ts/
IBBS300Ts IBBS300Ds+1 TMC11H
initially (Ver.C)
configured
on a 1:2
ratio

Triple- or quadruple-mode base station


The configuration principles for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station are as
follows:
● When two BBUs are configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station,
BBU 0 is installed in the 2 U space under the DCDU-11C in the equipment
compartment, and BBU 1 is installed in the 2 U space under BBU 0.
● When one BBU is configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
position of the BBU is indicated by BBU0 in the following figure.
When no battery cabinet is configured initially, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 336


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-190 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


with 48 V 300 Ah backup power

When backup power is required in a base station and TP48600As and IBBS700Ds/
IBBS700Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 337


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-191 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and TP48600As and IBBS700Ds/IBBS700Ts are
initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 338


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-192 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts are
initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given
different requirements on space for customer equipment are shown in the
following figure. This figure uses the triple- or quadruple-mode base station as an
example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 339


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-193 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


when backup power is required and TP48600As and IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts are
initially configured on a 1:2 ratio

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode


base station given different backup power requirements, requirements on space
for customer equipment, and carrier configurations.

Table 1-105 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configur
Requirem Equipmen ation
ent t

110 V AC or No battery ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A


220 V AC cabinet is
configured ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 TMC11H
initially. (Ver.C)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 340


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configur
Requirem Equipmen ation
ent t

TP48600A ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS700T/


s and IBBS700D
IBBS700Ds
/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS700T/
IBBS700Ts IBBS700D+1 TMC11H
initially (Ver.C)
configured
on a 1:1
ratio

TP48600A ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS300T/


s and IBBS300D
IBBS300Ds
/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+1 IBBS300T/
IBBS300Ts IBBS300D+1 TMC11H
initially (Ver.C)
configured
on a 1:1
ratio

TP48600A ≤5U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+2 IBBS300Ts/


s and IBBS300Ds
IBBS300Ds
/ ≤ 16 U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TP48600A+2 IBBS300Ts/
IBBS300Ts IBBS300Ds+1 TMC11H
initially (Ver.C)
configured
on a 1:2
ratio

BBU Installed in an OMB (Ver.C)


Each OMB configured in a DBS3900 can supply power to six RRUs. RRUs can be
installed on a pole, wall, angle steel, or U-steel.
The cabinet configurations of a DBS3900 using an OMB (Ver.C) are shown in the
following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 341


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-194 Cabinet configurations of a base station in which the BBU is


installed in an OMB (Ver.C)

If OMBs are configured and backup power is required in a DBS3900, each OMB
can be configured together with one or two IBBS20Ds to supply power to three
RRUs.

Figure 1-195 Cabinet configurations of a base station in which the BBU is


installed in an OMB (Ver.C) and backup power is required

BBU Installed in an MRE1000


When the DBS3900 uses an MRE1000 boost voltage direct current (BVDC) cabinet,
each MRE1000 cabinet can be configured with an ODM03H-01 to provide power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 342


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

for a maximum of 16 book RRUs and the RRUs can be installed on a pole, wall,
angle steel, or U-steel. This configuration scenario is shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-196 BBU installed in an MRE1000 BVDC

When a DBS3900 is configured with an MRE1000 225–400 V DC cabinet, each


MRE1000 uses the ODM03H-02 to provide power for a maximum of eight Easy
Macros (AAUs). These AAUs can be installed on a pole, wall, or the top of a pole.
● Star topology: Four ODM03H-02s are configured to provide power for eight
Easy Macros (AAUs), as shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-197 MRE1000 225–400 V DC cabinet in star topology

● Chain topology: A single chain can be configured with a maximum of three


ODM03H-02s to provide power for six AAU5940s, as shown in the following
figure on the left. A single site can be configured with two chains, which

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 343


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

support a maximum of eight AAU5940s, as shown in the following figure on


the right.

Figure 1-198 MRE1000 225–400 V DC cabinet in chain topology

● Star+chain topology: A single chain can be configured with a maximum of


three ODM03H-02s and a single site supports a maximum of eight AAU5940s,
as shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-199 MRE1000 225–400 V DC cabinet in star+chain topology

1.2.5.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS3900 is installed outdoors and
supplied with DC power.
The following table describes the scenarios where BBUs are installed outdoors and
the DBS3900 is supplied with DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 344


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-106 BBU installation scenarios


BBU Installation Scenario Description Reference
Position

APM5900H The BBU is installed in BBU Installed in an


an APM5900H and RRUs APM5900H
are installed remotely.
The APM5900H supplies
power to the BBU and
RRUs.

APM5900H-L The BBU is installed in BBU Installed in an


an APM5900H-L and APM5900H-L
RRUs are installed
remotely. The
APM5900H-L supplies
power to the BBU and
RRUs.

APM5930(DC) The BBU is installed in BBU Installed in an


an APM5930(DC) and APM5930(DC)
RRUs are installed
remotely. The
APM5930(DC) supplies
power to the BBU and
RRUs.

TMC11H (Ver.E) The BBU is installed in a BBU Installed in a


TMC11H (Ver.E) and TMC11H (Ver.E)
RRUs are installed
remotely. The TMC11H
(Ver.E) supplies power to
the BBU and RRUs.

TMC11H (Ver.D) The BBU is installed in a BBU Installed in a


TMC11H (Ver.D) and TMC11H (Ver.D)
RRUs are installed
remotely. The TMC11H
(Ver.D) supplies power to
the BBU and RRUs.

TMC11H (Ver.C) The BBU is installed in a BBU Installed in a


TMC11H (Ver.C) and TMC11H (Ver.C)
RRUs are installed
remotely. The TMC11H
(Ver.C) supplies power to
the BBU and RRUs.

OMB (Ver.C) The BBU is installed in BBU Installed in an


an OMB (Ver.C) and OMB (Ver.C)
RRUs are installed
remotely. The OMB
(Ver.C) supplies power to
the BBU and RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 345


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

The following refers to the TMC11H (Ver.D), TMC11H (Ver.C), and TMC11H (Ver.E) as
TMC11H.

Cabinet Configuration Principles for a DBS3900


For details, see Cabinet Configuration Principles for a DBS3900.

BBU Installed in an APM5900H


When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of
27 RRUs. The following table describes the mapping between the number of RRUs
and power equipment.

Table 1-107 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs DCDU15D (LOAD0 to -


(power LOAD5 ports)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to twenty- 4 DCDU-12Bs One DCDU-12B can supply power


seventh RRUs to 6 RRUs.
(power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to twenty- ● 2 DCDU-12Bs: 12 ● One DCDU-12B can supply


seventh RRUs RRUs (power power to 6 RRUs.
● 12 RRUs (power consumption per ● One DCDU16D-02 can supply
consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W) power to 3 RRUs.
RRU ≤ 800 W) ● 3 DCDU16D-02s: 9
● 9 RRUs (800 W RRUs (800 W <
< power power
consumption per consumption per
RRU ≤ 1400 W) RRU ≤ 1400 W)

When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of


27 RRUs and the cabinet configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 346


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-200 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 347


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 348


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-108 Cabinet configurations


Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 18 RRUs 1 APM5900H-L (2 DCDU-12Bs


11 U (power +3 DCDU16D-02sa)
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5900H-L (4 DCDU-12Bs)


11 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 18 RRUs 2 APM5900H-Ls (1 DCDU-12B


25 U (power +3 DCDU16D-02s)
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 2 APM5900H-Ls (3 DCDU-12Bs)


25 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

a: The DCDU-12B and DCDU16D-02 to be added for capacity expansion must be


installed in the space for customer equipment.

BBU Installed in an APM5900H-L


When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of
15 RRUs. The following table describes the mapping between the number of RRUs
and power equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 349


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-109 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs DCDU15D (LOAD0 to -


(power LOAD5 ports)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to 2 DCDU-12Bs One DCDU-12B can supply power


fifteenth RRUs to 6 RRUs.
(power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to 3 DCDU16D-02s: 9 One DCDU16D-02 can supply


fifteenth RRUs (800 RRUs (800 W < power to 3 RRUs.
W < power power consumption
consumption per per RRU ≤ 1400 W)
RRU ≤ 1400 W)

When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of


15 RRUs and the cabinet configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 350


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-201 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario (single cabinet)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 351


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-202 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario (two cabinets)

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 352


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-110 Cabinet configurations


Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM5900H-L (3


11 U (power DCDU16D-02sa)
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5900H (2 DCDU-12Bs)


11 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 6 RRUs 2 APM5900Hs (3


25 U (power DCDU16D-02s)
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 2 APM5900Hs (1 DCDU-12B)


25 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

a: The DCDU-12B and DCDU16D-02 to be added for capacity expansion must be


installed in the space for customer equipment.

BBU Installed in an APM5930(DC)


When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of
21 RRUs. The following table describes the mapping between the number of RRUs
and power equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 353


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-111 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs DCDU15D (LOAD0 to -


(power LOAD5 ports)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to twenty- 3 DCDU-12Bs One DCDU-12B can supply power


first RRUs (power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to twenty- ● 2 DCDU-12Bs: 9 ● One DCDU-12B can supply


first RRUs RRUs (power power to 6 RRUs.
● 9 RRUs (power consumption per ● One EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/
consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W) DCDU16D-02 can supply
RRU ≤ 800 W) ● 2 EPU02D-02s/ power to 3 RRUs.
● 6 RRUs (800 W DCDU16Ds/
< power DCDU16D-02s: 6
consumption per RRUs (800 W <
RRU ≤ 1100 W) power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 1100 W)

When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of


21 RRUs and the cabinet configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 354


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-203 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 355


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Table 1-112 Cabinet configurations

Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC Single BBU: ≤ 5 ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5930(DC) cabinet (3


U (power DCDUs+2 EPU02D-02s/
Two BBUs: ≤ 3 consumption DCDU16Ds/DCDU16D-02s)
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+6 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1100
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 356


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

Single BBU: ≤ 6 ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(DC) cabinet (4


U (power DCDUs)
Two BBUs: ≤ 4 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 2 APM5930(DC) cabinets (3


16 U (power DCDUs+2 EPU02D-02s/
Two BBUs: ≤ 14 consumption DCDU16Ds/DCDU16D-02s)
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+6 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1100
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 2 APM5930(DC) cabinets (4


17 U (power DCDUs)
Two BBUs: ≤ 15 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

BBU Installed in a TMC11H (Ver.E)


When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet configurations of a base station are
shown in the following figure.
NOTE

For details about BBU installation in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base
station, see Configuration Principles of BBUs in Applicable Cabinets. The following
figures use a base station configured with two BBUs as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 357


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-204 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Table 1-113 Cabinet configurations

Power Supply Space for Carrier Cabinet


Customer Configuratio Configuration
Equipment n

-48 V DC ≤6U ≤ 21 RRUs 1 TMC11H (with two


DCDUs)

≤ 17 U ≤ 21 RRUs 2 TMC11Hs (with


three DCDUs)

BBU Installed in a TMC11H (Ver.D)


Single- or dual-mode base station

When a single- or dual-mode base station is configured with only one BBU, the
BBU is installed in the TMC11H.

When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-


mode base station with different spaces for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 358


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-205 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

A single DBS3900 can be configured with a maximum of 12 RRUs. A TMC11H can


provide power for a maximum of 12 RRUs with 12 groups of RRU power cables,
which contain 24 groups of 2-wire fiber optic cables.
When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-
mode base station with different spaces for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are listed in the following table.

Table 1-114 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC ≤9U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 TMC11H (with one


DCDU)

≤8U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TMC11H (with two


DCDUs)

Triple- or quadruple-mode base station


When two BBUs are configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
BBUs are installed as follows:
● In the initial deployment scenario, two BBUs are configured. The BBUs are
installed in a TMC11H (with a BBU3900 and -48 V DC power input) and
transmission equipment is installed in another TMC11H (only providing
transmission space).
● In the capacity expansion scenario, if there is space for a second BBU in a
TMC11H (with the BBU3900 and -48 V DC power input), the BBU is
preferentially installed in the TMC11H (with the BBU3900 and -48 V DC
power input). Otherwise, it is installed in a TMC11H (only providing
transmission space).
When one BBU is configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
position of the BBU is indicated by BBU0 in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 359


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or


quadruple-mode base station are shown in the following figure. In the following
figure, illustrations a and b show the scenarios of new site deployment and
illustration c shows a capacity expansion scenario.

Figure 1-206 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or


quadruple-mode base station are listed in the following table.

Table 1-115 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


Power Supply Space for Carrier Cabinet
Customer Configuratio Configuration
Equipment n

-48 V DC ≤6U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TMC11H (with two


DCDUs)

≤ 17 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 TMC11Hs (with


three DCDUs)

BBU Installed in a TMC11H (Ver.C)


Single- or dual-mode base station
When a single- or dual-mode base station is configured with only one BBU, the
BBU is installed in the TMC11H. When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 360


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station with different spaces for


customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-207 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

A single DBS3900 can be configured with a maximum of 12 RRUs. A TMC11H can


provide power for a maximum of 12 RRUs with 12 groups of RRU power cables,
which contain 24 groups of 2-wire fiber optic cables.
When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-
mode base station with different spaces for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are listed in the following table.

Table 1-116 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station


Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC ≤9U ≤ 6 RRUs 1 TMC11H (with one


DCDU)

≤8U ≤ 12 RRUs 1 TMC11H (with two


DCDUs)

Triple- or quadruple-mode base station


The configuration principles for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station are as
follows:
● When two BBUs are configured, BBU 0 is installed in the basic TMC11H,
which is on the left; BBU 1 is installed in the extension TMC11H, which is on
the right.
● When one BBU is configured for a triple- or quadruple-mode base station, the
position of the BBU is indicated by BBU0 in the following figure.
When -48 V DC power is provided, the cabinet configurations of a triple- or
quadruple-mode base station are shown in the following figure and are listed in
the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 361


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-208 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


supplied with -48 V DC power

Table 1-117 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station


Power Supply Space for Carrier Cabinet
Customer Configuratio Configuration
Equipment n

-48 V DC ≤ 18 U ≤ 12 RRUs 2 TMC11Hs

BBU Installed in an OMB (Ver.C)


Each OMB configured in a DBS3900 can supply power to six RRUs. RRUs can be
installed on a pole, wall, U-steel, or angle steel.
The cabinet configurations of a DBS3900 using an OMB (Ver.C) are shown in the
following figure.

Figure 1-209 Cabinet configurations of a base station in which the BBU is


installed in an OMB (Ver.C)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 362


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.2.3 Indoor AC Scenarios


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS3900 is installed indoors and
supplied with AC power.
The following table describes the scenarios where the DBS3900 is supplied with
AC power and the BBU is installed indoors.

Table 1-118 Installation scenarios


BBU Scenario Description Reference
Installation
Position

IMB03 The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an IMB03


IMB03 and the RRUs are
installed remotely. The IMB03
supplies power to the BBU and
RRUs.

IMB05 The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an IMB05


IMB05 and the RRUs are
installed remotely. The IMB05
supplies power to the BBU and
RRUs.

IFS06 The BBU is installed in an IMB03 Installation Guide


IMB03. The IMB03 and RRUs
are installed on an IFS06.

BBU Installed in an IMB03


When external 110 V or 220 V AC power is provided, an AC/DC power device or
ETP48100-B1 is required to supply power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the
following figure.

Figure 1-210 BBU installed in an IMB03 (without backup power)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 363


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is
installed in an IMB03 and there is no backup power.

Table 1-119 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is installed in an
IMB03 (without backup power)
Power Supply Cabinet and Module Configuration

110 V/220 V 1 IMB03+1 AC/DC power device+1


RRU

1 IMB03+1 ETP48100-B1+3 RRUs

BBU Installed in an IMB05


When external 220 V AC power is provided, an ETP48100-B1 can be configured to
supply power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-211 BBU installed in an IMB05

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is
installed in an IMB05 and there is no backup power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 364


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-120 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is installed in an
IMB05
Power Supply Cabinet and Module Configuration

220 V single-phase 1 IMB05+1 BBU+1 ETP48100-B1+2


RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

1 IMB05+1 BBU+1 ETP48100-B1+1


RRU (800 W < power consumption per
RRU ≤ 1100 W)

1.2.5.2.4 Indoor DC Scenarios


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS3900 is installed indoors and
supplied with DC power.
The following table describes the scenarios where the BBU is installed indoors and
the DBS3900 is supplied with DC power.

Table 1-121 Installation scenarios


BBU Scenario Description Reference
Installation
Position

19-inch rack The 19-inch rack can be BBU Installed in a 19-Inch


provided by Huawei or the Rack
customer. The 19-inch rack
provided by Huawei is an
INS12.
The BBU and DCDU-11B/
DCDU-12B are installed in a
19-inch rack, and RRUs are
installed outdoors. The
DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B supplies
power to the BBU and outdoor
RRUs.

Wall The BBU and DCDU-11B/ BBU Installed on a Wall


DCDU-12B are installed on a
wall, and RRUs are installed
outdoors. The DCDU-11B/
DCDU-12B supplies power to
the BBU and outdoor RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 365


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Scenario Description Reference


Installation
Position

Indoor The BBU is installed indoors. BBU Installed Indoors and


RRUs are remotely installed RRUs Installed Outdoors
outdoors. The APM30H (Ver.C)/ (Powered by an APM30H)
APM30H (Ver.D)/APM30H
(Ver.E) monitors and supplies
power to the RRUs only.

IMB03 The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an IMB03


IMB03 and the RRUs are
installed outdoors. The IMB03
supplies power to the BBU and
outdoor RRUs.

The BBU is installed in an


IMB03. The IMB03 and RRUs
are installed in an IFS06.

IMB05 The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an IMB05


IMB05 and the RRUs are
installed outdoors. The IMB05
supplies power to the BBU and
outdoor RRUs.

IBC10 The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an IBC10


IBC10. The DCDU-12C supplies
power to the BBU.

ILC29 The BBUs are installed in an BBU Installed in an ILC29


(Ver.E) ILC29 (Ver.E) and RRUs are (Ver.E)
installed outdoors. The ILC29
(Ver.E) supplies power to the
BBUs and RRUs.

BBU Installed in a 19-Inch Rack


When -48 V DC power is provided, the BBU and DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B can be
installed in a 19-inch rack, and RRUs can be remotely installed outdoors. In this
scenario, the DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B supplies power to the BBU and RRUs.
The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode
base station.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 366


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-212 Cabinet configurations of a single- or dual-mode base station

The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-


mode base station configured with two BBUs. A triple- or quadruple-mode base
station can also be configured with a single BBU, and the cabinet configurations in
this scenario are the same as those in the preceding figure.

Figure 1-213 Cabinet configurations of a triple- or quadruple-mode base station

BBU Installed on a Wall


When -48 V DC power is provided, the BBU and DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B can be
installed indoors on a wall, and RRUs can be remotely installed outdoors. In this
scenario, the DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B supplies power to the BBU and RRUs, as
shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 367


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-214 BBU installed on a wall

BBU Installed Indoors and RRUs Installed Outdoors (Powered by an


APM30H)
When the BBU is installed indoors and supplied with -48 V DC power, RRUs can be
installed outdoors and powered and monitored by an APM30H (Ver.C)/APM30H
(Ver.D)/APM30H (Ver.E). The APM30H (Ver.C)/APM30H (Ver.D)/APM30H (Ver.E)
can be supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power. The following figure shows the
installation scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 368


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-215 BBU installed indoors and RRUs installed outdoors

BBU Installed in an IMB03


When -48 V DC power is supplied, the BBU can be installed in an IMB03, which
supplies power to the BBU and six outdoor RRUs, as shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 369


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-216 BBU installed in an IMB03

BBU Installed in an IMB05


When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBU can be installed in an IMB05,
which supplies power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 370


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-217 BBU installed in an IMB05

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 371


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is
installed in an IMB05.

Table 1-122 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is installed in an
IMB05
Power Cabinet and Module Configuration
Supply

-48 V DC 1 IMB05+1 BBU+2 DCDU-12Bs+12 RRUs (power consumption


per RRU ≤ 800 W)

1 IMB05+1 BBU+2 EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds+6 RRUs (800 W <


power consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

1 IMB05+1 BBU+1 DCDU-12B+1 EPU02D-02/DCDU16D+9 RRUs


(6 RRUs: power consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W; 3 RRUs: 800 W
< power consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

BBU Installed in an IBC10


When -48 V DC power is supplied, the BBU can be installed in an IBC10. The IBC10
supplies power to the BBU and universal switching unit (USU), as shown in the
following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 372


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-218 BBU installed in an IBC10

BBU Installed in an ILC29 (Ver.E)


The cabinet configurations of an ILC29 (Ver.E) are described as follows:
● A single cabinet supports a maximum of two BBUs.
● A single cabinet supports a maximum of 36 optical fibers.
When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBU can be installed in an ILC29
(Ver.E), which supplies power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the following
figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 373


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-219 BBU installed in an ILC29 (Ver.E)

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is
installed in an ILC29 (Ver.E).

Table 1-123 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is installed in an
ILC29 (Ver.E)
Power Supply Cabinet and Module Configuration

-48 V DC 1 ILC29 (Ver.E)+2 BBUs+3 EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds/


DCDU16D-02s+5 DCDU-12Bs+9 RRUs (800 W < power
consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)+21 RRUs (power
consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 374


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.3 Application Scenarios of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3910A


This section describes outdoor AC and DC scenarios for a DBS3900 configured with
the BBU3910A.

1.2.5.3.1 Outdoor AC Scenario


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS3900 is installed outdoors and
is supplied with AC power.

The following table describes BBU3910A installation scenarios of a DBS3900 in


which BBU3910As are installed outdoors and AC power is supplied.

Table 1-124 BBU3910A installation scenarios

BBU Installation Scenario Scenario Description

On a wall or pole The BBU and OPM50M are installed


on a pole or wall, RRUs are remotely
installed, and the OPM50M supplies
power to the BBU and RRUs.

The following table describes the configurations of a base station with different
requirements for backup power capacities and carrier configurations.

Table 1-125 Configurations of a DBS3900

Power Back Carrie Base Station Illustration


Supply up r Configuration
Powe Config
r uratio
Requi n
reme
nt

110 V No 3 1 OPM50M+1 BBU3910A Figure 1-220


AC or backu RRUs +3 RRUs
220 V p
AC powe 6 2 OPM50Ms+1
r RRUs BBU3910A+6 RRUs

The 3 1 OPM50M+1 BBU3910A Figure 1-221


OPM RRUs +3 RRUs+1 IBBS20D/
50Ms IBBS20L
and
IBBS2
0Ds/
IBBS2
0Ls
are
config

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 375


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Back Carrie Base Station Illustration


Supply up r Configuration
Powe Config
r uratio
Requi n
reme
nt

ured 6 2 OPM50Ms+1
on a RRUs BBU3910A+6 RRUs+2
1:1 IBBS20Ds/IBBS20Ls
ratio.

The 3 1 OPM50M+1 BBU3910A


OPM RRUs +3 RRUs+2 IBBS20Ds/
50Ms IBBS20Ls
and
IBBS2 6 2 OPM50Ms+1
0Ds/ RRUs BBU3910A+6 RRUs+4
IBBS2 IBBS20Ds/IBBS20Ls
0Ls
are
config
ured
on a
1:2
ratio.

The following figure shows the application scenario of a DBS3900 when no


backup power is required.

Figure 1-220 Application scenario of a DBS3900 (without backup power)

The following figure shows the application scenario of a DBS3900 when backup
power is required.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 376


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-221 Application scenario of a DBS3900 (with backup power)

1.2.5.3.2 Outdoor DC Scenario


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS3900 is installed outdoors and
is supplied with DC power.
The following table describes the installation scenario of the BBU3910A for an
outdoor DBS3900 site that is supplied with DC power.

Table 1-126 BBU3910A installation scenario


BBU Installation Position Scenario Description

On a wall or pole The BBU and RRUs are separately


installed on different poles or on the
same or different walls. The DCDU is
installed in a third-party cabinet and
provides DC power for the BBU and
RRUs.

When supplied with -48 V DC power, the DBS3900 can use two configurations, as
described in the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 377


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-127 Configurations of a DBS3900

Power Supply Base Station Illustration


Configuration

-48 V DC ● 1 BBU3910A+3 RRUs Figure 1-222


● 1 BBU3910A+6 RRUs

The following figure shows the application scenario of the DBS3900 configured
with one BBU3910A and six RRUs.

Figure 1-222 DBS3900 application scenarios

1.2.5.4 Application Scenario of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3910C


This section describes the installation scenario of the BBU3910C for an outdoor
DBS3900.

The following table and Figure 1-223 describe the installation scenario of the
BBU3910C for an outdoor DBS3900.

Table 1-128 BBU3910C installation scenarios

BBU Installation Scenario Scenario Description

On a wall or pole The BBU and RRU are separately


installed on different poles or on the
same or different walls. An ICC100
provides power for the BBU and RRU.

When supplied with -48 V DC power, the DBS3900 configured with the BBU3910C
can use the configurations described in the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 378


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-129 Configurations of a DBS3900 configured with a BBU3910C

Power Supply Base Station Configuration

-48 V DC 1 BBU3910C+1 RRU

Figure 1-223 BBU3910C installation scenario

1.2.5.5 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Configured with the BBU3900 or


BBU3910
This section describes the power requirements of a DBS3900 using different
cabinets and configured with a BBU3900 or BBU3910. If the existing cabinets of a
DBS3900 have been restructured to possess the same capabilities as APM30H
(Ver.D) or TMC11H (Ver.D) cabinets, the power requirements of these cabinets
must be the same as those of APM30H (Ver.D) or TMC11H (Ver.D) cabinets used
by a DBS3900. If the existing cabinets of a DBS3900 have been restructured to
possess the same capabilities as APM30H (Ver.E) or TMC11H (Ver.E) cabinets, the
power requirements of these cabinets must be the same as those of APM30H
(Ver.E) or TMC11H (Ver.E) cabinets used by a DBS3900.

The following table describes the power requirements when customer's equipment
is used to supply power to the BBU.

Table 1-130 Power requirements

Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

-48 V 1x20 A/1 P 2x2.5 mm2 ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


(0.0039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 379


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.5.1 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM5950H and having the peak power.

AC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS3900


supplied with AC power and using an APM5950H.

Table 1-131 Power requirements

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 6 or 7 PSUs 1x80 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (default) a black ft)
jacket and
4 or 5 PSUs 1x50 A/3 P four core
2 or 3 PSUs 1x32 A/3 P wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)

220 V AC 5 to 7 PSUs 1x125 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (by default) (L and N),
each with
4 PSUs 1x100 A/1 P a single
3 PSUs 1x80 A/1 P core wire,
two
insulation

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 380


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

2 PSUs 1x50 A/1 P layers, and


a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 PSUs 1x125 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC (by default) wires (L1,
dual-live-wire L2, and N),
4 PSUs 1x100 A/2 P each with
3 PSUs 1x80 A/2 P a single
core wire,
2 PSUs 1x50 A/2 P two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)

1.2.5.5.2 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM5900H and having the peak power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 381


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

An APM5900H is configured with one DCDU15D by default in outdoor DC


scenarios. In capacity expansion scenarios, additional DCDU-12B/DCDU16D-02 can
be configured. Table 1-132, Table 1-133 and Table 1-134 describe the power
requirements of a DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Table 1-132 Power requirements of a DCDU15D


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m


consumption per 2),two groups of (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)
● 1 FAN02I

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 382


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),two groups of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 800 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 560 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 400 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 383


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

Table 1-133 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) ≤ 10 m


consumption per (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 2 BBUs
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 2 BBUs
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 2 BBUs
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 2 BBUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 384


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

Table 1-134 Power requirements of a DCDU16D-02 (2x100 A/1 P circuit breakers


are recommended)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


(power 2),one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 385


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2),one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 386


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 387


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.3 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H-L


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM5950H-L and having the peak power.

AC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of a DBS5900 using an


APM5950H-L.

Table 1-135 Power requirements


Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length
Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 PSUs 1x50 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase a black ft)
2 or 3 PSUs 1x32 A/3 P jacket and
four core
wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 388


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 PSUs 1x100 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (L and N),
3 PSUs 1x80 A/1 P each with
2 PSUs 1x50 A/1 P a single
core wire,
two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)

110 V AC or 4 PSUs 1x100 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC wires (L1,
dual-live-wire 3 PSUs 1x80 A/2 P L2, and N),
2 PSUs 1x50 A/2 P each with
a single
core wire,
two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 389


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.5.4 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H-L


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM5900H-L and having the peak power.

DC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

An APM5900H-L is configured with one DCDU15D by default in outdoor DC


scenarios. In capacity expansion scenarios, additional DCDU-12B/DCDU16D-02 can
be configured. Table 1-136, Table 1-137 and Table 1-138 describe the power
requirements of a DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Table 1-136 Power requirements of a DCDU15D

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m


consumption per 2),two groups of (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W) DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 390


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),one group of DC
RRU ≤ 400 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

Table 1-137 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) ≤ 10 m


consumption per (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 1 BBU
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 1 BBU
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 391


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 392


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-138 Power requirements of a DCDU16D-02 (2x100 A/1 P circuit breakers


are recommended)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


(power 2),one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1200 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1200 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 393


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 394


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 395


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.5 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(AC)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM5930(AC) and having the peak power.

AC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS3900


supplied with AC power and using an APM5930(AC).

Table 1-139 Power requirements


Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length
Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x50 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) a black ft)
jacket and
2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P four core
(by default) wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 396


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 5 1x125 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (by default) (L and N),
each with
4 1x100 A/1 P a single
3 1x80 A/1 P core wire,
two
2 1x50 A/1 P insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x125 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC (by default) wires (L1,
dual-live-wire L2, and N),
4 1x100 A/2 P each with
3 1x80 A/2 P a single
core wire,
2 1x50 A/2 P two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 397


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.5.6 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(DC)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM5930(DC) and having the peak power.

DC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

An APM5930(DC) is configured with a DCDU15D by default in outdoor DC power


scenarios. In capacity expansion scenarios, additional DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S modules can be configured. Table 1-140, Table
1-142, and Table 1-141 describe the power requirements of a DCDU15D,
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D-02/EPU02B, respectively. Table 1-143 lists
the power requirements of an EPU02S. Table 1-351 lists the power requirements
of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-140 Power requirements of a DCDU15D


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m


consumption per 2),two groups of (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)
● 1 FAN02G

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 398


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),two groups of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 800 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 560 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 399


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),one group of DC
RRU ≤ 400 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

Table 1-141 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (800 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


power 2),one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption per 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

3 RRUs (800 W < 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of DC
power consumption
per RRU ≤ 1100 W) input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 400


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Table 1-142 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


(power 2), one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 401


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2),one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Table 1-143 Power requirements of an EPU02S

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


power 2), one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption per 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 402


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power default) 2), two groups of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low smoke
● 1 BBU (power zero halogen)
consumption per
BBU ≤ 1420 W)

3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of DC
power consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 W 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


< power consumption 2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 1600 W) DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Table 1-144 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


power 2), one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption per
BBU ≤ 1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 403


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power default) 2), two groups of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low smoke
● 1 BBU (power zero halogen)
consumption per
BBU ≤ 1420 W)

3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


power consumption 2), one group of DC
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) input power cables

2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 W 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


< power consumption 2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 1600 W) DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 404


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 405


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.7 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
distributed base station using the APM30H (Ver.E) and having the peak power.

AC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor distributed


base station supplied with AC power and using the APM30H (Ver.E).

Table 1-145 Power requirements of a distributed base station using the APM30H
(Ver.E)

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x40 A/3 P Cable with a ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) black jacket ft)
and four core
2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P wires, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 6 mm2
(0.0093 in.2)

220 V AC 5 1x100 A/1 P Two wires (L


single-phase and N), each
4 1x80 A/1 P with a single
core wire, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 406


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

3 1x63 A/1 P sectional area


of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x100 A/2 P Three wires


120 V AC (L1, L2, and
dual-live-wire 4 1x80 A/2 P N), each with
3 1x63 A/2 P a single core
wire, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

1.2.5.5.8 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.D)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM30H (Ver.D) and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS3900
supplied with AC power and using the APM30H (Ver.D).

Table 1-146 Power requirements when the APM30H (Ver.D) is used

Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC three- 1x40 A/3 P 6 mm2 (0.0093 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


phase 2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 407


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


phase 2)

110 V AC dual- 1x100 A/2 P


live-wire

1.2.5.5.9 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.C)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the APM30H (Ver.C) and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS3900
supplied with AC power and using the APM30H (Ver.C).

Table 1-147 Power requirements when the APM30H (Ver.C) is used


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 40 m (131.23 ft)


phase 2)

110 V AC dual- 1x63 A/2 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


live-wire 2)

220 V AC three- 1x25 A/3 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in. ≤ 40 m (131.23 ft)


phase 2)

1.2.5.5.10 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.E)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the TMC11H (Ver.E) and having the peak power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 408


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

DC Input Scenario
When an outdoor DBS3900 is supplied with DC power and uses the TMC11H
(Ver.E), a DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 can be configured in the TMC11H (Ver.E). Table 1-148 lists
the power requirements of a DCDU-12B. Table 1-149 lists the power requirements
of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Table 1-150 lists the power requirements of an
EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B. Table 1-151 lists the power requirements of an
EPU02S. Table 1-152 lists the power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-148 Power requirements when the TMC11H (Ver.E) is used


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


consumption per group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 640 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
default) groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W)+3 cables
RRUs (power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 640 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 2 BBUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 409


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 640 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 0 or 1 BBU
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 400 cables
W)
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 2 BBUs
groups of DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 400 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 0 or 1 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables
W)
● 2 BBUs

● 6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables
W)
● 0 or 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 560 cables
W)
● 0 or 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 410


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-149 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 10 m (32.81


(power one group of DC ft)
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 411


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 0 BBU 2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),


two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-150 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1200 W)
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1100 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 412


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-151 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1200 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1200 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 413


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-152 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1200 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1200 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 414


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 415


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 416


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.11 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.D)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the TMC11H (Ver.D) and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

DC Input Scenario
When an outdoor DBS3900 is supplied with DC power and uses the TMC11H
(Ver.D), a DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02
can be configured in the TMC11H (Ver.D). Table 1-153 lists the power
requirements of a DCDU-12B. Table 1-154 lists the power requirements of a
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Table 1-155 lists the power requirements of an EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02.

Table 1-153 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 417


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 560
W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 418


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)
● Transmission 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
equipment groups of DC input power
(power cables
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(560 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 650
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU < 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (300 W
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 419


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)
consumption ≤ 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
350 W) groups of DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU < 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 400 halogen)
W)
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (400 W
groups of DC input power
< power
cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 6 RRUs (560 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 650 halogen)
W)
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 1 or 2 BBUs
groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 420


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 7 to 9 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P+1x63 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


(power A/1 P groups of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 or 2 BBUs

● 7 to 9 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(300 W < +1x63 A/1 P group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one
per RRU ≤ 400
group of DC input power
W)
cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs
2x63 A/1 P+1x63 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), three
A/1 P groups of DC input power
cables

● 7 to 9 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power +1x80 A/1 P group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 560 halogen)
W)
16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one
● 1 or 2 BBUs group of DC input power
cables

2x80 A/1 P+1x80 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), three


A/1 P (by groups of DC input power
default) cables

● 12 RRUs 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


(power groups of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 or 2 BBUs

● 12 RRUs (300 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


W < power +1x80 A/1 P group of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 400
16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one
W)
group of DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 421


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

2x63 A/1 P+1x80 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), three


A/1 P groups of DC input power
cables

● 12 RRUs 2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), two


(power groups of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 560 halogen)
W)
4x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), four
● 1 or 2 BBUs
default) groups of DC input power
cables

Table 1-154 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
(5) Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU (power
groups of DC input power
consumption ≤
cables (low smoke zero
1000 W)
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 422


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
(5) Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU (power
groups of DC input power
consumption ≤
cables (low smoke zero
1000 W)
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-155 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/


EPU02S-02
Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 423


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 424


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● When more than six RRUs are configured, another DCDU-12B is required.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.12 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.C)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the TMC11H (Ver.C) and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

DC Input Scenario
Table 1-156 describes the power requirements of the DCDU in an outdoor
DBS3900 supplied with DC power and using the TMC11H (Ver.C).

Table 1-156 Power requirements


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 425


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 560
W) 2x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 426


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (300 W
2x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 427


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 400 halogen)
W)
2x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (400 W
groups of DC input power
< power
cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 428


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(560 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 650
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(560 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 650
W) 2x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

In an outdoor DBS3900 supplied with DC power, a heater must be installed in a


TMC11H, and one more AC input must be added. The following table describes
the power requirements of the heater.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 429


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-157 Power requirements of a heater


P Minimum Requirement for Cross-Sectional Area of the Input C
o Circuit Breakers on Customer Power Cable a
w Equipment b
e l
r e
S L
u e
p n
p g
l t
y h
R
e
q
u
i
r
e
m
e
n
t

2 1x10 A/1 P 1.5 mm2 (0.0023 in.2) ≤


2 1
0 5
V m
A (
C 4
si 9
n .
g 2
l 1
e f
- t
p )
h
a
s
e

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 430


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w, RRU5903,
RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w, RRU5513t,
RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256, RRU3259,
RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m, RRU3959, RRU3959a,
RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953, RRU3953w,
RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962, RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972, AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the specifications
of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the full
configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do not meet
the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the circuit breakers
during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 431


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the circuit
breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption need to be
added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● When more than six RRUs are configured, another DCDU-11B is required.

1.2.5.5.13 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the MRE1000


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the MRE1000 and having the peak power.

AC Input Scenario
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS3900


supplied with AC power and using the MRE1000.

Table 1-158 Power requirements of the MRE1000

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 3 1x63 A/1 P Two wires (L ≤ 15 m (49.21


single-phase and N), each ft)
2 1x40 A/1 P with a single
core, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 16 mm2
(0.025 in.2)

110 V AC 3 1x63 A/2 P Three wires


dual-live-wire (L1, L2, and
N), each with
a single core,
two insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 16 mm2
(0.025 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 432


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.5.14 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the OMB (Ver.C) and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
Table 1-159 describes the power requirements of a DBS3900 supplied with AC
power and using the OMB (Ver.C).

Table 1-159 Power requirements when the OMB (Ver.C) is used


Power Supply Product Minimum Cross- Cable
Configuration Requirement for Section Lengt
Circuit Breakers al Area h
on Customer of the Requir
Equipment Input ement
Power
Cable

220 V AC single- 1 PSU 20 A/1 P 4 mm2 ≤ 15


phase (0.0062 m
2 PSUs 32 A/1 P (49.21
in.2)
110 V AC dual- 1 PSU 20 A/2 P ft)
live-wire
2 PSUs 32 A/2 P

DC Input Scenario
Table 1-160, Table 1-161, and Table 1-162 describe the power requirements of a
DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/
EPU02S-02 in a DBS3900 using the OMB (Ver.C), respectively.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 433


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-160 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B when the OMB (Ver.C) is used
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 50 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2)
consumption
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 80 A/1 P
(power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 63 A/1 P
(power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power 2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 434


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

consumption 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


per RRU ≤ 400 2)
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


(power 2)
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 125 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power 2)
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
W) 2)

● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption 2)
per RRU ≤ 300
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 435


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


< power 2)
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption 2)
per RRU ≤ 300
W) 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption 2)
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
450 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 436


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)
● Transmission 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
equipment 2)
(power
consumption ≤
200 W)

Table 1-161 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 when the OMB


(Ver.C) is used (recommended circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables
1400 W)
● 1 BBU

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables
1100 W)
● 1 BBU

Table 1-162 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/


EPU02S-02
Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 437


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 438


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.15 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the IMB05, IMB03, IFS06, 19-
inch Rack, or Wall for Installation
This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 (with the peak power) using the IMB05, IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch rack, or
wall for installation.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
Power requirements of a DBS3900 configured with an IMB03 and supplied with AC
power are described in Table 1-163.

Table 1-163 Power requirements when the IMB05/IMB03 and ETP48100-B1 are
used
Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment

220 V AC 1 PSU 1x20 A/1 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 in.2) ≤ 40 m


single- (131.23
phase 2 1x32 A/1 P ft)
PSUs

110 V AC 1 PSU 1x20 A/2 P


dual-live-
wire 2 1x32 A/2 P
PSUs

The following table describes the power requirements of an indoor DBS3900


supplied with AC power and using the IMB03+IFS06.

Table 1-164 Power requirements when the IMB03+IFS06 and EPS4890 are used
Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment

220 V AC three- 1x16 A/3 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 in.2) ≤ 15 m


phase (49.21 ft)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 439


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x32 A/1 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2)


phase

110 V AC dual- 1x32 A/2 P


live-wire

DC Input Scenario
The following table describes the power requirements when customer's equipment
is used to supply power to the BBU.

Table 1-165 Power requirements when customer's equipment is used to supply


power
Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Require
on Customer ment
Equipment

-48 V DC 1x20 A/1 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 in.2) ≤ 15 m


(49.21 ft)

A DBS3900 using a 19-inch rack, IMB03, or wall for installation can be supplied
with external DC power distributed by the DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02. Table 1-166 lists the power requirements of a DCDU-11B. Table
1-167 lists the power requirements of a DCDU-12B. Table 1-168, Table 1-169,
and Table 1-170 list the power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 440


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-166 Power requirements when a DCDU-11B supplies power and a 19-inch
rack, IMB03, or wall is used for installation
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 560
W) 2x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 441


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (300 W
< power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 442


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

consumption 2x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


per RRU ≤ 400 groups of DC input power
W) cables
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 400 halogen)
W)
2x63 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (400 W
groups of DC input power
< power
cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 443


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(560 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 650
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(560 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 650
W) 2x80 A 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 444


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-167 Power requirements when a DCDU-12B supplies power and a 19-inch
rack, IMB05, IMB03, or wall is used for installation
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 560
W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 445


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(400 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables (low smoke zero
consumption halogen)
per RRU ≤ 400
W) 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(300 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 446


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


(560 W < group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 650
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU < 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (300 W
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption group of DC input power
per RRU < 300 cables (low smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 3 RRUs (400 W
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
< power
groups of DC input power
consumption
cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 447


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 400 halogen)
W)
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 3 RRUs (400 W
groups of DC input power
< power
cables
consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 6 RRUs (560 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


< power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 650 halogen)
W)
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 1 or 2 BBUs
groups of DC input power
cables

● 7 to 9 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P+1x63 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


(power A/1 P groups of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 or 2 BBUs

● 7 to 9 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(300 W < +1x63 A/1 P group of DC input power
power cables
consumption
16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one
per RRU ≤ 400
group of DC input power
W)
cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs
2x63 A/1 P+1x63 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), three
A/1 P groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 448


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 7 to 9 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power +1x80 A/1 P group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 560 halogen)
W)
16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one
● 1 or 2 BBUs group of DC input power
cables

2x80 A/1 P+1x80 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), three


A/1 P (by groups of DC input power
default) cables

● 12 RRUs 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


(power groups of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 or 2 BBUs

● 12 RRUs (300 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


W < power +1x80 A/1 P group of DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 400
16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one
W)
group of DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs cables

2x63 A/1 P+1x80 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), three


A/1 P groups of DC input power
cables

● 12 RRUs 2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), two


(power groups of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ 560 halogen)
W)
4x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), four
● 1 or 2 BBUs
default) groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 449


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-168 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 when the IMB03 is


used (recommended circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 450


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-169 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 when the IMB05 is


used (recommended circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


(power group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU (power
groups of DC input power
consumption ≤
cables (low smoke zero
1420 W)
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU (power
groups of DC input power
consumption ≤
cables (low smoke zero
1420 W)
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 451


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-170 Power requirements when a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 supplies power


and a 19-inch rack or wall is used for installation (recommended circuit breaker
specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


(power groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
2100 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU (power
groups of DC input power
consumption ≤
cables (low smoke zero
1420 W)
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 1 BBU (power
groups of DC input power
consumption ≤
cables (low smoke zero
2100 W)
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 452


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for the Input Power Cable(3) Length
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)
● 1 BBU (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
consumption ≤ groups of DC input power
1420 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


(power group of DC input power
consumption cables (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1100 W)
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
● 0 BBU
groups of DC input power
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements of a DBS3900 where an


EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S supplies power and a 19-inch rack is used
for installation.

Table 1-171 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements of a DBS3900 where an


EPU02S-02 supplies power and a 19-inch rack or an indoor wall is used for
installation.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 453


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-172 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 10 m (32.81


(1100 W ≤ one group of DC ft)
power input power cables
consumption (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
● 1 BBU (power
default) two groups of DC
consumption ≤
input power cables
1420 W)
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(1100 W ≤ one group of DC
power input power cables
consumption (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1400 W)
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
● 0 BBU
default) two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),


(1400 W < default) two groups of DC
power input power cables
consumption (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1600 W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(1400 W < one group of DC
power input power cables
consumption (low smoke zero
per RRU ≤ halogen)
1600 W)
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
● 0 BBU
default) two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 454


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),


(power default) two groups of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
2100 W)

The following table describes the power requirements of an indoor DBS3900


supplied with DC power and using the IMB03+IFS06.

Table 1-173 Power requirements when the IMB03+IFS06 are used


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V DC 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2) ≤ 15 m


(49.21 ft)
+24 V DC 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)
1x160 A/1 P

For a DBS3900 using an IMB05 or wall for installation, there are two scenarios
when the DCDU-12E supplies power. Table 1-174 describes the power
requirements of a DCDU-12E in the BBU centralized installation scenarios. Table
1-175 describes the power requirements of a DCDU-12E in distributed BBU and
RRU installation scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 455


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-174 Power requirements of a DCDU-12E (BBU centralized installation


scenarios)
Product Minimum Circuit Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Breaker Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Requirement on Power Cable(3)
Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 5 BBU5900s 2x100 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), two groups of
consumption per DC input power
BBU ≤ 1420 W) cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Table 1-175 Power requirements of a DCDU-12E (distributed BBU and RRU


installation scenarios)
Product Minimum Circuit Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Breaker Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Requirement on Power Cable(3)
Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables
W)
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
● 1 BBU (power
2),two groups of
consumption ≤
1420 W) DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables (low
W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2100 W)

4 to 6 RRUs 2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power 2), two groups of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 800 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 456


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 457


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● When more than six RRUs are configured, another DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B is required.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.16 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the TP48600A


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the TP48600A and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of the AC-powered


TP48600A.

Table 1-176 Power requirements in AC scenarios

Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable Length


Supply Configuratio Requirement Sectional Requirement
n for Circuit Area of the
Breakers on Input Power
Customer Cable
Equipment

220 V AC 7 PSUs+1 63 A/3 P 10 mm2 ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase SOU (recommende (0.016 in.2) ft)
d)

4 to 6 PSUs+1 40 A/3 P
SOU

4 to 7 PSUs+1 63 A/3 P
HAU+1 SOU

220 V AC 7 PSUs+1 125 A/1 P 35 mm2 ≤ 15 m (49.21


single-phase SOU (recommende (0.054 in.2) ft)
d)

6 PSUs+1 125 A/1 P


SOU

5 PSUs+1 100 A/1 P


SOU

4 PSUs+1 80 A/1 P
SOU

6 PSUs+1 125 A/1 P


HAU+1 SOU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 458


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable Length


Supply Configuratio Requirement Sectional Requirement
n for Circuit Area of the
Breakers on Input Power
Customer Cable
Equipment

5 PSUs+1 125 A/1 P


HAU+1 SOU

4 PSUs+1 100 A/1 P


HAU+1 SOU

110 V AC 7 PSUs+1 125 A/2 P 35 mm2 ≤ 15 m (49.21


dual-live-wire SOU (recommende (0.054 in.2) ft)
d)

6 PSUs+1 125 A/2 P


SOU

5 PSUs+1 100 A/2 P


SOU

4 PSUs+1 80 A/2 P
SOU

1.2.5.5.17 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the IBC10


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS3900 using the IBC10 and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

DC Input Scenario
The following table describes the power requirements of an indoor DBS3900
supplied with DC power and using the IBC10.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 459


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-177 Power requirements in DC scenarios


Power Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Equipment Configuratio Requirement Area of the Input Length
n(3) for Circuit Power Cable(2) Require
Breakers on ment
Customer
Equipment(1)

0#DCDU-12C ● 2 first- 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


level USUs 2), one group of DC (32.81
(power input power cables ft)
consumpti
on of each 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
USU ≤ 850 2),two groups of
W) DC input power
● 1 second- cables
level USU
(power
consumpti
on ≤ 505
W)
● 2 fan
assemblies
(power
consumpti
on of each
fan
assembly ≤
300 W)

1#DCDU-12C 5 BBUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per BBU ≤
700 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

2#DCDU-12C 5 BBUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per BBU ≤
700 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 460


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) Remarks about minimum requirements for circuit breakers on the customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A and
2x80 A.
(2) When two power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(3) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.5.18 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
distributed base station (with the peak power) using an ILC29 (Ver.E).

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of the DCDU-12B in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the DCDU-12B provides power only for the BBUs and fan
assembly.

Table 1-178 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 or 2 BBUs 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per BBU ≤ cables
1800 W)
● 1 FAN (power
consumption ≤
730 W)

The following table describes the power requirements of the DCDU-12B in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the DCDU-12B provides power only for the RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 461


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-179 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

3 RRUs (power 2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)
consumption per default) 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 1100 W) DC input power
cables

1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of

DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 300 W) DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 462


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

3 RRUs (power 1x32 A/1 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 300 W) DC input power
cables

The following table describes the power requirements of the DCDU16D in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the DCDU provides power only for the RRUs.

Table 1-180 Power requirements of a DCDU16D (recommended circuit breaker


specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1100 W ≤ 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 463


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table describes the power requirements of the EPU02D-02 in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the EPU02D-02 is powered by external equipment.

Table 1-181 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs 2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), two groups of
consumption per 2x80 A/1 P
DC input power
RRU ≤ 1100 W) cables

The following table describes the power requirements of the EPU02S in an ILC29
(Ver.E) when the EPU02S is powered by external equipment.

Table 1-182 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 464


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements of the EPU02S-02 in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the EPU02S-02 is powered by external equipment.

Table 1-183 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 465


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 466


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 467


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.6 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Configured with a BBU3910A


This section describes power requirements of a DBS3900 configured with a
BBU3910A.

AC Input Scenario
In AC power scenarios, an OPM50M (Ver.B) is configured to provide power for the
BBU and RRUs. The following table lists the power requirements.

Table 1-184 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

● 3 RRUs (power 1x32 A/1 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 ≤ 100 m (328.08


consumption in.2) to 4 mm2 ft)
per RRU ≤ 800 (0.0062 in.2), one
W) group of DC input
● 1 BBU3910A power cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

In AC power scenarios, an OPM15M (Ver.B) is configured to provide power for the


BBU and RRUs. The following table lists the power requirements.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 468


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-185 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

● 1 RRU (power 1x16 A/1 P 1.3 mm2 (0.0023 ≤ 100 m (328.08


consumption in.2) to 2.5 mm2 ft)
per RRU ≤ 800 (0.0039 in.2), one
W) group of DC input
● 1 BBU3910A power cables

In AC power scenarios, an OPM50M is configured to provide power for the BBU


and RRUs. The following table lists the power requirements.

Table 1-186 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x20 A 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 ≤ 100 m (328.08


phase in.2) ft)

110 V AC dual-
live-wire

DC Input Scenario
In DC power scenarios, a DCDU-12B is configured to provide power for the BBU
and RRUs. The following table lists the power requirements.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 469


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-187 Power requirements in DC scenarios


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 300 cables
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(400 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ 560 smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 1 BBU
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
● Transmission 2), two groups of
equipment
DC input power
(power
cables
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 470


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


(400 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(300 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ 400 smoke zero
W) halogen)
● 1 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
● Transmission 2), two groups of
equipment
DC input power
(power
cables
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


(300 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


consumption 2), one group of
per RRU ≤ 300 DC input power
W) cables (low
● 3 RRUs (300 W smoke zero
< power halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 471


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

consumption 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


per RRU ≤ 400 2), two groups of
W) DC input power
● 1 BBU cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


consumption 2), one group of
per RRU ≤ 300 DC input power
W) cables (low
● 3 RRUs (400 W smoke zero
< power halogen)
consumption
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
per RRU ≤ 560
2), two groups of
W)
DC input power
● 1 BBU
cables
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

● 3 RRUs (300 W 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


< power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 400 cables (low
W) smoke zero
● 3 RRUs (400 W halogen)
< power
2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption
2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 560
W) DC input power
cables
● 1 BBU
● Transmission
equipment
(power
consumption ≤
350 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 472


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 473


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.

1.2.5.7 Power Requirements of a DBS3900 Configured with a BBU3910C


This section describes power requirements of a DBS3900 configured with a
BBU3910C.

If the BBU3910C is powered by an ICC100, see ICC100-N5 Solar Controller User


Manual for the power requirements.

If the BBU3910C is powered by customer equipment, the following table describes


the power requirements.

Table 1-188 Power requirements of a BBU3910C

Po Minimum Requirement for Cross-Sectional Area of the Ca


we Circuit Breakers on Customer Input Power Cable ble
r Equipment Le
Su ng
pp th
ly Re
qu
ire
m
en
t

-4 1x16 A/1 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) ≤


8 15
V m
DC (4
9.2
1
ft)

1.2.5.8 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Configured with a


BBU3900 or BBU3910
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 configured
with a BBU3900 or BBU3910 in different power supply scenarios. If the existing
cabinets of a DBS3900 have been restructured to possess the same capabilities as
APM30H (Ver.D) or TMC11H (Ver.D) cabinets, the power distribution schemes for
these cabinets must be the same as those for APM30H (Ver.D) or TMC11H (Ver.D)
cabinets used by a DBS3900. If the existing cabinets of a DBS3900 have been
restructured to possess the same capabilities as APM30H (Ver.E) or TMC11H
(Ver.E) cabinets, the power distribution schemes for these cabinets must be the
same as those for APM30H (Ver.E) or TMC11H (Ver.E) cabinets used by a
DBS3900.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 474


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.8.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using an
APM5950H in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU (EPU07A-01 or EPU07A-02)
in the cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to
other components.
The EPU distributes two AC power outputs to the junction box on the left side of
the cabinet. The junction box then distributes four AC power outputs to the service
outlet unit (SOU) and heater.
The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
Figure 1-224 and Figure 1-225 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-189 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses in a base station.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-224 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H in a 220 V AC single-


phase or three-phase scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/
PDU01D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 475


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-225 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H in a 110 V AC dual-


live-wire scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/PDU01D-02)

Table 1-189 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in an APM5950H in AC


scenarios

Power Specificatio Specifications Specifications of the Circuit


Supply ns of the of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Upper-Level Breaker for
Circuit the AC
Breaker for Output
the PSU

220 V AC ● 220 V AC Heater and ● RRU (LOAD12 to LOAD17,


single- three- SOU: 1x16 A power consumption per RRU ≤
phase/ phase: (MCB) 800 W): 6x30 A (FUSEa)
three- 1x80 A/3 ● RRU (2 PDU06D-01s, power
phase P consumption per RRU ≤ 800
● 220 V AC W): 12x30 A (FUSE)
single- ● RRU (3 PDU03D-03s, power
phase: consumption per RRU ≤ 1400
1x125 A/1 W): 9x50 A (MCB)
P
● BBU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
110 V AC 1x125 A/2 P Heater and ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
dual-live- SOU: 1x16 A
wire (MCB) ● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/EMUB: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/TMC: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● BBC: 1x30 A (FUSE)

a: MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b: FUSE: fuse

When the AC input is used for an APM5950H, the PDU01D-02 provides two DC
outputs for the transmission cabinet APM5900H. The transmission cabinet
provides power for the transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 476


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

components through the DC power distribution box. The following figure shows
the power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-226 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-190 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios

Cabinet Type Power Equipment Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

APM5900H DCDU15D ● TM: 10x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to


serving as a LOAD9)a
transmission ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)
cabinet

NOTE

When a second BBU is installed in the transmission cabinet, the second BBU obtains power
from the APM5950H.

1.2.5.8.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using an
APM5900H that serves as the power cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 477


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


An APM5900H can be configured when a DBS5900 base station is supplied with
-48 V DC power. The DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, or DCDU16D-02 provides DC power
to the BBUs, RRUs, fan assembly, and other components. Figure 1-227, Figure
1-228, and Figure 1-229 show the power distribution schemes of a DCDU15D,
DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Figure 1-227 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H (configured with a


DCDU15D)

Figure 1-228 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H (configured with a


DCDU-12B)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 478


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-229 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H (configured with a


DCDU16D-02)

Table 1-191 Fuse specifications of the APM5900H in -48 V DC scenarios


Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Equipment the DC Output

APM5900H DCDU16D-0 ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB) (LOAD0 to LOAD2)


serving as a 2 ● BBU/TM/FAN: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD3 to
power LOAD6) a
cabinet

APM5900H DCDU15D ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to LOAD5)


serving as a ● BBU/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD6 to LOAD9)
power
cabinet ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)

APM5900H DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


serving as a ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet ● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

a: MCB:
miniature
circuit
breaker
b: FUSE: fuse

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from "LOAD6", "LOAD7", "LOAD8", and "LOAD9"
ports on a DCDU15D. When a second BBU is configured, the second BBU obtains power
from another DCDU.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 479


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.8.3 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5950H-L


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using an
APM5950H-L in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU (EPU04A-01 or EPU04A-02)
in the cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to
other components.
The EPU distributes two AC power outputs to the junction box on the left side of
the cabinet. The junction box then distributes four AC power outputs to the service
outlet unit (SOU) and heater.
The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
Figure 1-230 and Figure 1-231 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-192 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses in a base station.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-230 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H-L in a 220 V AC single-


phase or three-phase scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/
PDU01D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 480


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-231 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H-L in a 110 V AC dual-


live-wire scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/PDU01D-02)

Table 1-192 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in an APM5950H-L in


AC scenarios

Power Specificatio Specifications Specifications of the Circuit


Supply ns of the of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Upper-Level Breaker for
Circuit the AC
Breaker for Output
the PSU

220 V AC 4x32 A Heater and ● RRU (LOAD8 to LOAD13,


single- SOU: 1x16 A power consumption per RRU ≤
phase/ (MCBa) 800 W): 6x30 A (FUSEb)
three- ● RRU (2 PDU06D-01s, power
phase consumption per RRU ≤ 800
110 V AC 4x32 A Heater and W): 12x30 A (FUSE)
dual-live- SOU: 1x16 A ● RRU (3 PDU03D-03s, power
wire (MCB) consumption per RRU ≤ 1400
W): 9x50 A (MCB)
● BBU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/EMUB: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/TMC: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● BBC: 1x30 A (FUSE)

a: MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b: FUSE: fuse

When the AC input is used for an APM5950H-L, the PDU01D-02 provides two DC
outputs for the transmission cabinet APM5900H-L. The transmission cabinet
provides power for the transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 481


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

components through the DC power distribution box. The following figure shows
the power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-232 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-193 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios

Cabinet Type Power Equipment Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

APM5900H-L DCDU15D ● TM: 10x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to


serving as a LOAD9)a
transmission ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)
cabinet

NOTE

When a second BBU is installed in the transmission cabinet, the second BBU obtains power
from the APM5950H-L.

1.2.5.8.4 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5900H-L


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using an
APM5900H-L that serves as the power cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 482


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

An APM5900H-L is configured with one DCDU15D by default in outdoor DC


scenarios. In capacity expansion scenarios, additional DCDU-12B/DCDU16D-02 can
be configured. Table 1-194, Table 1-195 and Table 1-196 describe the power
requirements of a DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Table 1-194 Power requirements of a DCDU15D


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m


consumption per 2),two groups of (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W) DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 483


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),one group of DC
RRU ≤ 400 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

Table 1-195 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) ≤ 10 m


consumption per (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 1 BBU
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 1 BBU
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 484


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 485


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-196 Power requirements of a DCDU16D-02 (2x100 A/1 P circuit breakers


are recommended)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


(power 2),one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1200 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1200 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 486


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 487


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 488


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.2.5.8.5 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(AC)


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using an
APM5930(AC) in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

AC Input Scenario
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS5900


supplied with AC power and using an APM5930(AC).

Table 1-197 Power requirements

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x50 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) a black ft)
jacket and
2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P four core
(by default) wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 489


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 5 1x125 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (by default) (L and N),
each with
4 1x100 A/1 P a single
3 1x80 A/1 P core wire,
two
2 1x50 A/1 P insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x125 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC (by default) wires (L1,
dual-live-wire L2, and N),
4 1x100 A/2 P each with
3 1x80 A/2 P a single
core wire,
2 1x50 A/2 P two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 490


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.8.6 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM5930(DC)


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using an
APM5930(DC) that serves as the power cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


An APM5930(DC) can be configured when a DBS5900 base station is supplied
with -48 V DC power. The power distribution box DCDU15D, DCDU-12B,
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, or EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S in the APM5930(DC) is
used to supply power to the BBUs, RRUs, fan assembly, and other components.
Figure 1-233, Figure 1-234, and Figure 1-235 show the power distribution
schemes for a DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, respectively.
Figure 1-236 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02D-02. Figure
1-237 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02B. Figure 1-238 shows
the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S. Figure 1-239 shows the power
distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Figure 1-233 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the DCDU15D)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 491


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-234 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the DCDU-12B)

Figure 1-235 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 492


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-236 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02D-02)

Figure 1-237 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02B)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 493


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-238 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02S)

Figure 1-239 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02S-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 494


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-198 Fuse specifications of an APM5930(DC) in -48 V DC scenarios


Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Equipment the DC Output

APM5930(DC DCDU16D/ ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB) (LOAD0 to LOAD2)


) serving as a DCDU16D-0 ● BBU/TM/FAN: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD3 to
power 2 LOAD6)
cabinet

APM5930(DC DCDU15D ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to LOAD5)


) serving as a ● BBU/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD6 to LOAD9)
power
cabinet ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)

APM5930(DC DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet ● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

APM5930(DC EPU02D-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x30 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

APM5930(DC EPU02B ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

APM5930(DC EPU02S ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

APM5930(DC EPU02S-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from "LOAD6", "LOAD7", "LOAD8", and "LOAD9"
ports on a DCDU15D. When a second BBU is configured, the second BBU obtains power
from another DCDU or EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02.

1.2.5.8.7 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a distributed base station
using the APM30H (Ver.E) in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 495


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU (EPU05A-07 or EPU05A-09)
in the cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to
other components.

The EPU divides the AC input into two AC outputs.


● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.

The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-240 and Figure 1-241 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-199 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses in a base station.

Figure 1-240 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 220 V AC
single-phase scenario (configured with the PDU03D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 496


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-241 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 110 V AC
dual-live-wire scenario (configured with the PDU03D-02)

Table 1-199 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.E)
in AC scenarios

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 2x40 A+1x25 A Heater and SOU: ● LOAD9 to


phase/three- 1x16 A (MCB) LOAD14: 6x30
phase A (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A
(FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TM: 4x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMC: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBS: 1x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 497


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 1x100 A ● Heater: 1x16 A ● RRU (slot 7):


live-wire (MCB) 3x30 A (FUSE)
● SOU: 1x16 A ● RRU (slot 8):
(MCB) 3x30 A (FUSE)
● RRU (slot 9):
3x30 A (FUSE)

NOTE

The BBU is preferentially powered by the "LOAD0" and "LOAD1" ports on an EPU. If there is
a standby power board or a second BBU, the standby power board or second BBU obtains
power from "LOAD5" and "LOAD6" ports.

When the cabinet requires a DCDU16D/EPU02D/EPU02D-02, the EPU05A must be


configured with two PDU01D-01 modules that obtain power from the EPU05A
(converting AC input power into DC power) and distribute it to the DCDU16D/
EPU02D/EPU02D-02. The power distribution schemes are shown in Figure 1-242
and Figure 1-243. The specifications of circuit breakers and fuses are listed in the
following table.
NOTE

The scheme for the DCDU16D/EPU02D-02 to obtain power from the PDU01D-01 is similar
to that for the EPU02D. The following figure uses the EPU02D as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 498


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-242 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 220 V AC
single-phase scenario (configured with the EPU02D)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 499


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-243 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 110 V AC
dual-live-wire scenario (configured with the EPU02D)

Table 1-200 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.E)
in AC scenarios
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 2x40 A+1x25 A Heater and SOU: ● LOAD9 to


phase/three- 1x16 A (MCB) LOAD14: 6x30
phase A (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 500


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 1x100 A ● Heater: 1x16 A ● FAN: 1x30 A


live-wire (MCB) (FUSE)
● SOU: 1x16 A ● TM: 4x30 A
(MCB) (FUSE)
● TMC: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBS: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RRU (slot 7):
3x30 A (FUSE)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
8): 1x100 A
(MCB)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
9): 1x100 A
(MCB)

NOTE

The BBU is preferentially powered by the "LOAD0" and "LOAD1" ports on an EPU. If there is
a standby power board or a second BBU, the standby power board or second BBU obtains
power from "LOAD5" and "LOAD6" ports.

The following figure shows the EPU02D or EPU02D-02 power distribution scheme.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 501


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-244 EPU02D or EPU02D-02 power distribution scheme

A DCDU16D supplies power to RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 1400 W). The
following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D.

Figure 1-245 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D

The following table lists the circuit breaker or fuse specifications of a DCDU16D
providing DC power outputs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 502


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-201 Specifications of circuit breakers or fuses for a DCDU16D

Power Circuit Breaker/Fuse Specifications


Equipment Terminal

DCDU16D LOAD0 to LOAD2 -48 V DC power output: 3x50


A (RRU)

LOAD3 to LOAD6 -48 V DC power output: 4x30


A (BBU)

When the APM30H (Ver.E) uses the AC power supply, one DC output is supplied to
the transmission cabinet. The transmission cabinet provides power supply for the
transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other components in the cabinet
through the DC power distribution box, as shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-246 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-202 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios

Cabinet Type Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

TMC11H (Ver.E) serving as a ● TM: 7x30 A (FUSE)


transmission cabinet ● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 503


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.8.8 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.D)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using the
APM30H (Ver.D) in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU05A-03 or EPU05A-05 in the
cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to other
components.
The EPU divides the AC input into two AC outputs.
● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.
The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-247 and Figure 1-248 show the power distribution schemes for the
APM30H (Ver.D) in 220 V AC and 110 V AC scenarios. Table 1-203 lists the
specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.D) in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios.

Figure 1-247 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.D) in 220 V AC
single-phase scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 504


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-248 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.D) in 110 V AC
dual-live-wire scenarios

Table 1-203 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.D)
in AC scenarios

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 2x40 A+1x25 A Heater and SOU: ● BAT: 1x125 A/2
phase/three- 1x16 A (MCB) P (MCB)
phase ● RFC: 1x125 A
110 V AC dual- 1x100 A Heater: 1x16 A (MCB)
live-wire (MCB) ● RRU 0 to RRU
SOU: 1x16 A 5: 6x30 A
(MCB) (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A
(FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TM: 4x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMC: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBS: 1x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 505


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When the APM30H (Ver.D) uses AC power supply, the AC power is converted into
several DC outputs. One DC output is supplied to the transmission cabinet. Then,
the DC power distribution box in the transmission cabinet provides the power for
the transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other components, as shown in the
following figure.

Figure 1-249 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-204 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios


Cabinet Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

TMC11H (Ver.D) serving as a ● TM: 7x30 A (FUSE)


transmission cabinet ● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

If voltage boosting power distribution is required, a DCDU16D/EPU02D/


EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 can be configured to convert an external
-48 V DC power input. Figure 1-250 shows the power distribution scheme for an
EPU02D/EPU02D-02. Figure 1-251 shows the power distribution scheme for a
DCDU16D. Figure 1-252 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02B.
Figure 1-253 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S. Figure 1-254
shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 506


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-250 EPU02D or EPU02D-02 power distribution scheme

Figure 1-251 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 507


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-252 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02B is


configured

Figure 1-253 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02S is


configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 508


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-254 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an


EPU02S-02 is configured

1.2.5.8.9 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the APM30H (Ver.C)
This section describes the power distribution schemes for a DBS3900 using the
APM30H (Ver.C) in 110 V AC, +24 V DC, and 220 V AC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU (EPU03A-03 or EPU03A-05)
in the cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to
other components.

The EPU divides one AC input into two AC outputs.


● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.

The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBU, RRUs, and other equipment.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-255 and Figure 1-256 show the power distribution schemes for the
APM30H (Ver.C) in 220 V AC and 110 V AC scenarios. Table 1-205 lists the
specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.C) in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 509


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-255 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.C) in 220 V AC
single-phase scenarios

Figure 1-256 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.C) in 110 V AC
dual-live-wire scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 510


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-205 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.C)
in AC scenarios
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the EPS AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 3x20 A (MCB) ● Heater and ● BAT: 1x160 A


phase/three- SOU: 1x15 A (MCB)
phase (MCB) ● RRU: 6x25 A
110 V AC dual- 1x63 A (MCB) ● Heater: 1x15 A (MCB)
live-wire (MCB) ● TMC: 1x30 A
● SOU: 1x15 A (MCB)
(MCB) ● FAN: 1x15 A
(FUSE)
● BBU: 2x25 A
(FUSE)
● TEC: 1x15 A
(FUSE)
● TM: 4x15 A
(FUSE)

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers in the
transmission cabinet in AC scenarios.

Table 1-206 Specifications of the circuit breakers in the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios
Cabinet Specifications of the Circuit Breaker
for the DC Output

Transmission cabinet ● TM: 7x12 A (MCB)+1x6 A (MCB)


● FAN: 1x6 A (MCB)

When the APM30H (Ver.C) uses AC power supply, the AC power is converted into
several DC outputs. One DC output is supplied to the transmission cabinet. Then,
the DC power distribution box in the transmission cabinet provides the power for
the transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other components, as shown in the
following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 511


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-257 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers in the
transmission cabinet in AC scenarios.

Table 1-207 Specifications of the circuit breakers in the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios
Cabinet Specifications of the Circuit Breaker
for the DC Output

Transmission cabinet ● TM: 2x6 A (MCB)+2x12 A (MCB)


+5x25 A (MCB)
● FAN: 1x25 A (MCB)

1.2.5.8.10 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.D) or
TMC11H (Ver.E)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a distributed base station
using a TMC11H (Ver.D) or TMC11H (Ver.E) in -48 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


When a distributed base station uses -48 V DC power, a TMC11H can be
configured and the DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/
EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 in the TMC11H distributes the power to BBUs, RRUs,
fan assembly, and other components. Figure 1-258 shows the power distribution
scheme for a DCDU-12B. Figure 1-259 shows the power distribution scheme for a
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Figure 1-260 shows the power distribution scheme for
an EPU02D/EPU02D-02. Figure 1-261 shows the power distribution scheme for an

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 512


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

EPU02B. Figure 1-262 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S.
Figure 1-263 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Figure 1-258 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when a DCDU-12B


is configured in the TMC11H

Figure 1-259 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when a DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02 is configured in the TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 513


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-260 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02D


or EPU02D-02 is configured in the TMC11H

Figure 1-261 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02B is


configured in the TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 514


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-262 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02S is


configured in the TMC11H

Figure 1-263 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an


EPU02S-02 is configured in the TMC11H

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the TMC11H in -48 V DC
scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 515


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-208 Specifications of the fuses in the TMC11H in -48 V DC scenarios

Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse


Equipment for the DC Output

When the DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet ● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

When the DCDU16D/ ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB)


TMC11H is DCDU16D-02 ● BBU/FAN/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

When the EPU02D ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 2x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet ● FAN: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)

When the EPU02D-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 2x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet ● FAN: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)

When the EPU02B ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

When the EPU02S ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

When the EPU02S-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from the "LOAD6" and "LOAD7" ports on the
DCDU-12B. If there is a standby power board or a second BBU, a second DCDU-12B must
be configured so that the standby power board or second BBU can obtain power from the
"LOAD6" and "LOAD7" ports on the second DCDU-12B.

1.2.5.8.11 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.C)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using the
TMC11H (Ver.C) in -48 V DC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 516


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


When a DBS3900 uses -48 V DC power, the DCDU-11B in the TMC11H (Ver.C)
distributes the power to the BBU, RRUs, fan assembly, and other components, as
shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-264 Power distribution scheme for the TMC11H (Ver.C) in -48 V DC
scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers in the TMC11H
(Ver.C) in -48 V DC scenarios.

Table 1-209 Specifications of the circuit breakers in the TMC11H (Ver.C) in -48 V
DC scenarios

Cabinet Specifications of the Circuit Breaker


for the DC Output

TMC11H (Ver.C) ● RRU 0 to RRU 5: 6x25 A (MCB)


● BBU or TM: 2x25 A (MCB)
● TM: 1x25 A (MCB)
● FAN: 1x25 A (MCB)

1.2.5.8.12 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the MRE1000


This section describes the power distribution scheme in a DBS3900 using the
MRE1000 in 220 V AC or 110 V AC scenarios.

When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU03A-21 in the cabinet converts
the AC power into DC power and distributes power to other components.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 517


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

After going through the AC power distribution box (PDB) of the MRE1000, an AC
power input is divided into four AC power outputs as follows:
● Three outputs for the heater or heating film
● One output for the SOU
In an MRE1000 BVDC cabinet, the BDU65-03 is used to convert the AC power to
DC power, which is then provided to the BBU, Book RRUs, or other devices in the
cabinet. In an MRE1000 225-400 V DC cabinet, the HSU (C28005G1) is used to
convert the AC power to DC power, which is then provided to the BBU, Easy
Macro, or other devices in the cabinet.

Power Distribution Scheme of the MRE1000 BVDC Cabinet


Figure 1-265 shows the power distribution scheme of the MRE1000 cabinet with
220 V AC single-phase and 110 V AC inputs. Table 1-210 lists the specifications of
the circuit breakers and fuses in the MRE1000 cabinet.

Figure 1-265 Power distribution scheme for the MRE1000 BVDC cabinet in AC
input scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 518


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-210 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the MRE1000 BVDC
cabinet in AC scenarios
Power Specifica Specifications Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/
Supply tions of of the Circuit Fuse for the DC Output
the Breaker for the
Upper- AC Output
Level
Circuit
Breaker
for the
PSU

220 V 1x63 A/2 Heater and ● Book RRU (BDU65 in slot 3): 3x30 A
AC P SOU: 1x16 A/1 (FUSE)
single- P+N (MCB) ● Book RRU (BDU65 in slot 4): 3x30 A
phase (FUSE)
110 V ● Book RRU (BDU65 in slot 5): 3x30 A
AC (FUSE)
dual-
live-wire ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

Power Distribution Scheme of the MRE1000 225-400 V DC Cabinet


The power distribution scheme of the MRE1000 225-400 V DC cabinet with 220 V
AC single-phase and 110 V AC inputs is shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 519


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-266 Power distribution scheme for the MRE1000 225-400 V DC cabinet
in AC input scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 520


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-211 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the MRE1000
225-400 V DC cabinet in AC scenarios
Power Specifica Specifications Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/
Supply tions of of the Circuit Fuse for the DC Output
the Breaker for the
Upper- AC Output
Level
Circuit
Breaker
for the
PSU

220 V 1x63 A/2 Heater and ● ODM03H-02: 8x2x25 A (FUSE)


AC P SOU: 1x16 A/1 ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
single- P+N (MCB)
phase ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

110 V ● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)


AC ● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)
dual-
live-wire

1.2.5.8.13 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the OMB (Ver.C)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using the
OMB (Ver.C) in 110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When external 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is provided, the ETP48100-A1 in an
OMB (Ver.C) converts the AC power into DC power and distributes the DC power
to other components in the cabinet. The following figure shows the power
distribution scheme.

Figure 1-267 Power distribution scheme for the OMB (Ver.C) in 220 V AC or 110 V
AC scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 521


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a
base station.

Table 1-212 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a base station using
the OMB (Ver.C)
Application Scenario Power Supply Specifications of the
Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
the DC Output

OMB (Ver.C) 220 V AC single-phase or ● RRU 0 to RRU 5: 6x30


110 V AC dual-live-wire A (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSEa)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

a. FUSE: fuse

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


Figure 1-268 shows the power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02
in the OMB (Ver.C) in a -48 V DC scenario. Figure 1-269 shows the power
distribution scheme for a PDU10D. Figure 1-270 shows the power distribution
scheme for an EPU02D/EPU02D-02. Figure 1-271 shows the power distribution
scheme for an EPU02B. Figure 1-272 shows the power distribution scheme for an
EPU02S. Figure 1-273 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Figure 1-268 Power distribution scheme for the OMB (Ver.C) in -48 V DC
scenarios when a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 is configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 522


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-269 Power distribution scheme for the OMB (Ver.C) in -48 V DC
scenarios when a PDU10D is configured

Figure 1-270 Power distribution scheme for the OMB (Ver.C) in -48 V DC
scenarios when an EPU02D/EPU02D-02 is configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 523


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-271 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02B is


configured

Figure 1-272 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02S is


configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 524


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-273 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an


EPU02S-02 is configured in the TMC11H

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a
base station if an OMB (Ver.C) is configured with a PDU10D/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/
EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02.

Table 1-213 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a base station
Applicati Power Power Equipment Specifications of the Circuit
on Supply Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Scenario

OMB -48 V DC PDU10D/EPU02D ● RRU 0 to RRU 5: 6x30 A


(Ver.C) (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

OMB -48 V DC DCDU16D/ ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB)


(Ver.C) DCDU16D-02 ● BBU/FAN/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE)

OMB -48 V DC EPU02D-02 ● RRU 0 to RRU 2: 3x30 A


(Ver.C) (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

OMB -48 V DC EPU02B ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A (FUSE)


(Ver.C) ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 525


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Applicati Power Power Equipment Specifications of the Circuit


on Supply Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Scenario

OMB -48 V DC EPU02S ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


(Ver.C) ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

OMB -48 V DC EPU02S-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


(Ver.C) ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

1.2.5.8.14 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the IMB05, IMB03,
IFS06, 19-Inch Rack, or Wall for Installation
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using the
IMB05, IMB03, IFS06, 19-inch rack, or wall for installation in 110 V AC, 220 V AC,
-48 V DC, and +24 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied, the ETP48100-B1 in the cabinet
converts the AC power into DC power and distributes the DC power to other
components. The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a
DBS3900 using an IMB05 or IMB03 in 220 V AC single-phase or 110 V AC dual-
live-wire scenarios.

Figure 1-274 Power distribution scheme for the IMB03 or IMB05 configured with
an ETP48100-B1 in 220 V AC or 110 V AC scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a
base station.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 526


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-214 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a base station
Application Scenario Power Supply Specifications of the
Circuit Breaker/Fuse
for the DC Output

IMB03 or IMB05 220 V AC single-phase or 110 ● RRU: 1x30 A


V AC dual-live-wire ● SPARE: 2x30 A
● BBU: 1x30 A

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


When -48 V DC power supply is used, an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/
EPU02S-02/DCDU-11B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/DCDU-12B distributes the power
to BBUs, RRUs, and other components, as shown in Figure 1-278, Figure 1-279,
Figure 1-280, Figure 1-281, Figure 1-275, Figure 1-277, and Figure 1-276.

Figure 1-275 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when a DCDU-11B


is configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 527


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-276 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when a DCDU-12B


is configured

Figure 1-277 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC input scenarios when a


DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 is configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 528


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-278 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02D


or EPU02D-02 is configured

Figure 1-279 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02B

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 529


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-280 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02S

Figure 1-281 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02S-02

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 530


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-215 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a base station
Application Power Supply Power Specifications of the
Scenario Equipment Circuit Breaker/Fuse
for the DC Output

IMB03, IMB05, -48 V DC DCDU-11B ● RRU 0 to RRU 5:


IMB03+IFS06, wall, 6x25 A (MCB)
or 19-inch rack ● BBU or TM: 2x25 A
(MCB)
● TM: 1x25 A (MCB)
● FAN: 1x25 A (MCB)

IMB03, IMB05, -48 V DC DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


IMB03+IFS06, wall, ● TM/BBU: 2x30 A
or 19-inch rack (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

IMB05/IMB03, -48 V DC DCDU16D/ ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB)


wall, or 19-inch DCDU16D-02 ● BBU/FAN/TM: 4x30
rack A (FUSE)

IMB03, IMB05, -48 V DC EPU02D ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A


IMB03+IFS06, wall, (FUSE)
or 19-inch rack ● BBU: -48 V 2x30 A
(FUSE)
● FAN: -48 V 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● SPARE: -48 V 1x30
A (FUSE)

IMB03, IMB05, -48 V DC EPU02D-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x30 A


IMB03+IFS06, wall, (FUSE)
or 19-inch rack ● BBU: -48 V 2x30 A
(FUSE)
● FAN: -48 V 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● SPARE: -48 V 1x30
A (FUSE)

IMB03, IMB05, -48 V DC EPU02B ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A


IMB03+IFS06, wall, (FUSE)
or 19-inch rack ● BBU/FAN/TM: -48 V
4x30 A (FUSE)

IMB03, IMB05, -48 V DC EPU02S/ ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


IMB03+IFS06, wall, EPU02S-02 ● BBU/FAN/TM: -48 V
or 19-inch rack 4x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 531


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.2.5.8.15 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the TP48600A


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 using the
TP48600A in 110 V AC and 220 V AC scenarios.
When the TP48600A uses 110 V AC or 220 V AC power supply, the PDU05A-03
divides the AC power and the ETP converts the AC power into DC power. Then the
DCDU-11C or DCDU-11B distributes the DC power to the BBU, RRUs, transmission
equipment, and other components.
The PDU05A-03 divides one AC input into five AC outputs.
● One AC output is connected to the AC junction box on the right side of the
cabinet door, and divided into four AC outputs, which are then provided for
the HAU.
● Three AC outputs are connected to the PSUs and converted by the PSUs to DC
power outputs, which are then provided for the DCDU-11C or DCDU-11B,
storage batteries, and other components.
● One AC output is provided for the SOU.
Figure 1-282 shows the power distribution scheme in 220 V AC three-phase
scenarios when the DCDU-11B is used. Table 1-216 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers.
The power distribution scheme in 220 V AC single-phase or 110 V AC dual-live-
wire scenarios is the same as that in 220 V AC three-phase scenarios. To support
different types of power supply, the power input terminals need to be connected
to different short-circuiting bars, as shown in Figure 1-283.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 532


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-282 Power distribution scheme in 220 V AC three-phase scenarios when


the DCDU-11B is used

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 533


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-216 Specifications of the circuit breakers


Power Distribution Specifications of the Specifications of the
Device Circuit Breaker for the Circuit Breaker for the
AC Output DC Output

PDU05A-03 ● PSU1/5: 1x40 A -


● PSU2/6: 1x40 A
● PSU3/4/7: 1x63 A
● HEATER: 1x25 A
● SOU: 1x10 A

ETP - ● DCDU-11C: LOAD0


(1x100 A)
● DCDU-11B: LOAD3
(1x200 A) and LOAD5
(1x200 A)
● TMC11H (Ver.C):
LOAD1 (1x100 A) and
LOAD2 (1x100 A)
● Storage battery:
LOAD6 (1x400 A)
● SPARE: LOAD4 (1x200
A)

DCDU-11C - ● CCU: LOAD0 (1x6 A)


● CMUF: LOAD1 (1x6
A)
● TMa: LOAD2 (1x12 A)
● TM: LOAD3 (1x12 A)
● BBU: LOAD4 to
LOAD7 (4x25 A)
● CMUF: LOAD8 (1x25
A)
● IBBS: LOAD9 (1x25 A)

DCDU-11B - ● RRUs: LOAD0 to


LOAD5 (6x25 A)
● SPARE: LOAD6 to
LOAD9 (4x25 A)

a. TM: transmission equipment

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 534


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-283 Configuration of short-circuiting bars

1.2.5.8.16 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the IBC10


This section describes the power distribution scheme in a DBS3900 using the
IBC10 in -48 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme for the IBC10 in DC Scenarios


If the IBC10 is supplied with -48 V DC power, the DCDU-12C modules in the
cabinet provide DC power for USUs, BBUs, and fan assemblies. The following
figure shows the power distribution schemes for these DCDU-12C modules.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 535


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-284 Power distribution scheme for the IBC10 in -48 V DC scenarios

1.2.5.8.17 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a distributed base station
using the ILC29 (Ver.E) cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

The following figure shows the components in an ILC29 (Ver.E).


NOTE

The DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 and EPU02D-02 installation positions are similar. The figure
uses the EPU02D-02 as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 536


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-285 Components in an ILC29 cabinet

The power distribution schemes for the five DCDU-12B modules in the cabinet are
different from each other, as described in Table 1-217. Table 1-218 lists the
specifications of DC output fuses in these modules.

Table 1-217 Power distribution schemes for DCDU-12B modules


Pow LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA
er D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9
Distr
ibuti
on
Mod
ule

DCD RRU RRU RRU - - - - - - -


U-12 18 19 20
B (4)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 537


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Pow LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA
er D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9
Distr
ibuti
on
Mod
ule

DCD - BBU BBU BBU BBU FAN BBU BBU BBU BBU
U-12 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
B (0) (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE
U0) U0) U1) U1) U0) U0) U1) U1)

DCD RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU - - - -


U-12 12 13 14 15 16 17
B (3)

DCD RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU - - - -


U-12 6 7 8 9 10 11
B (2)

DCD RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU - - - -


U-12 0 1 2 3 4 5
B (1)

Table 1-218 Specifications of the DC output fuses in DCDU-12B modules


Application Power Supply Specifications of the DC Output Fuse
Scenario

DCDU-12B -48 V DC RRU: 3x30 A (FUSE)


(4)

DCDU-12B -48 V DC ● BBU 0: 4x30 A (FUSE)


(0) ● BBU 1: 4x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN 0: 1x30 A (FUSE)

DCDU-12B -48 V DC RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


(3)/
DCDU-12B
(2)/
DCDU-12B
(1)

Table 1-219 describes the power distribution schemes for the three EPU02D-02/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 modules in the cabinet. Table 1-220 lists the specifications of
DC output fuses in these modules.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 538


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-219 Power distribution scheme for EPU02D-02/EPU02S-02 modules


Pow BDU 0 BDU 1
er
Distr LOA LOA N/A LOA LOA N/A
D0 D1 D0 D1 LOA LOA LOA LOA
ibuti
D0 D1 D2 D3
on
Mod
ule

EPU0 RRU/ RRU/ - RRU/ - - - - - -


2D-0 AAU AAU AAU
2/ (6) (7) (8)
EPU0
2S/
EPU0
2S-0
2 (2)

EPU0 RRU/ RRU/ - RRU/ - - - - - -


2D-0 AAU AAU AAU
2/ (3) (4) (5)
EPU0
2S/
EPU0
2S-0
2 (1)

EPU0 RRU/ RRU/ - RRU/ - - - - - -


2D-0 AAU AAU AAU
2/ (0) (1) (2)
EPU0
2S/
EPU0
2S-0
2 (0)

Table 1-220 Specifications of the DC output fuses in EPU02D-02/EPU02S/


EPU02S-02 modules
Power Power Supply Specifications of the DC Output Fuse
Distribution
Module

EPU02D-02 -48 V DC RRU: -57 V 3x30 A (FUSE)

EPU02S -48 V DC RRU: -57 V 3x28 A

EPU02S-02 -48 V DC RRU: -57 V 3x28 A

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 539


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-399 describes the power distribution scheme for the three DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02 modules in the cabinet. Table 1-400 lists the specifications of DC
output circuit breakers in these modules.

Table 1-221 Power distribution scheme for DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 modules


Power LOAD0 LOAD1 LOAD2 LOAD3 LOAD4 LOAD5 LOAD6
Distrib
ution
Module

DCDU1 RRU/AA RRU/AA RRU/AA - - - -


6D (2) U (6) U (7) U (8)

DCDU1 RRU/AA RRU/AA RRU/AA - - - -


6D (1) U (3) U (4) U (5)

DCDU1 RRU/AA RRU/AA RRU/AA - - - -


6D (0) U (0) U (1) U (2)

Table 1-222 Specifications of the DC output circuit breakers in DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02 modules
Power Distribution Power Supply Specifications of the
Module Circuit Breaker for the
DC Output

DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 -48 V DC RRU/AAU: -48 V 3x50A


(MCB)

1.2.5.9 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Configured with a


BBU3910A
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 configured
with a BBU3910A.

AC Input Scenario
When AC power is supplied, the power is fed into an SPM60A for surge protection
and then into an OPM50M. The OPM50M converts AC power into DC power and
then supplies it to the BBU and RRUs.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 supplied
with AC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 540


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-286 Power distribution scheme for a DBS3900 supplied with AC power

The following table lists specifications of fuses in the OPM50M.

Table 1-223 Specifications of fuses in the OPM50M


Power Supply Fuse Specifications

220 V AC single-phase or 110 V AC ● BBU3910A: 1x30 A (FUSE)


dual-live-wire ● RRU: 3x30 A (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)

DC Input Scenario
When DC power is supplied, it is fed into the DCDU-12B, which then provides
power for the BBU, RRUs, and other devices, as shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-287 Power distribution scheme in DC scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 541


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists specifications of fuses in the DCDU-12B.

Table 1-224 Specifications of fuses in the DCDU-12B


Power Supply Fuse Specifications

-48 V DC ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

1.2.5.10 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS3900 Configured with a


BBU3910C
If the BBU3910C is powered by an ICC100, see ICC100-N5 Solar Controller User
Manual for the power requirements.

1.2.5.11 Cables and Cable Connections in a DBS3900


This section lists the reference sections in 3900 Series Base Station Cables for cable
connections in a DBS3900.
For cable connections for a DBS3900, see topics related to Cable Connections in
3900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Table 1-225 Cable connections


Cabine Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi Intercon CPRI
t Used Connections Signal Cable on Cable nection Cable
by a Connections Connectio Signal Connectio
DBS39 ns Cable ns
00 Connecti
ons

APM59 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


50H Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
APM5950H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
APM5950H Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 542


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabine Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi Intercon CPRI


t Used Connections Signal Cable on Cable nection Cable
by a Connections Connectio Signal Connectio
DBS39 ns Cable ns
00 Connecti
ons

APM59 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


00H Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
APM5900H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
APM5900H Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

APM30 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


H Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
(Ver.C) a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
APM30H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
(Ver.C) APM30H Series Base Connectio Series
(Ver.C) Stations ns Base
Stations

APM30 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


H Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
(Ver.D) a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
APM30H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
(Ver.D) APM30H Series Base Connectio Series
(Ver.D) Stations ns Base
Stations

APM30 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


H(Ver. Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
E)/ a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
BBC52 Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
00D-L/ APM30H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
BBC53 (Ver.E) APM30H Series Base Connectio Series
00T-L (Ver.E) Stations ns Base
Stations

TMC11 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


H Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
(Ver.C) a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
TMC11H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
(Ver.C) TMC11H Series Base Connectio Series
(Ver.C) Stations ns Base
Stations

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 543


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabine Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi Intercon CPRI


t Used Connections Signal Cable on Cable nection Cable
by a Connections Connectio Signal Connectio
DBS39 ns Cable ns
00 Connecti
ons

TMC11 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


H Connections in Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
(Ver.D) a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
TMC11H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
(Ver.D) TMC11H Series Base Connectio Series
(Ver.D) Stations ns Base
Stations

TMC11 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


H Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
(Ver.E) a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
TMC11H Using the 3900 Cable 3900
(Ver.E) TMC11H Series Base Connectio Series
(Ver.E) Stations ns Base
Stations

OMB Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


(Ver.C) Connections in Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
/IMB03 a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using an OMB a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
(Ver.C) or Using an OMB 3900 Cable 3900
IMB03 (Ver.C) or Series Base Connectio Series
IMB03 Stations ns Base
Stations

TP486 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


00A Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
TP48600A Using the 3900 Cable 3900
TP48600A Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

IBC10 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
IBC10 Using the 3900 Cable 3900
IBC10 Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 544


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabine Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi Intercon CPRI


t Used Connections Signal Cable on Cable nection Cable
by a Connections Connectio Signal Connectio
DBS39 ns Cable ns
00 Connecti
ons

MRE10 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


00 Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
MRE1000 Using an 3900 Cable 3900
MRE1000 Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

ILC29 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS5900 ns for Signal ns for
ILC29 (Ver.E) Using the 3900 Cable 3900
ILC29 (Ver.E) Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

IMB05 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
Using the a DBS5900 ns for Signal ns for
IMB05 Using the 3900 Cable 3900
IMB05 Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

IBBS20 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI


D/ Connections in Signal Cable on Cable Interconn Cable
IBBS20 a DBS3900 Connections in Connectio ection Connectio
L Configured a DBS3900 ns for Signal ns for
with a Using a 3900 Cable 3900
BBU3910A BBU3910A Series Base Connectio Series
Stations ns Base
Stations

1.2.6 BTS3900C
This section describes cabinets, power requirements, power distribution schemes,
cables, and cable connections of a BTS3900C.

1.2.6.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS3900C


The BTS3900C, an outdoor compact mini base station, is classified into BTS3900C
WCDMA and BTS3900C (Ver.C), in terms of cabinet versions.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 545


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists cabinets supported by a BTS3900C.


Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Cabinet Configuration

BTS3900C WCDMA This cabinet is used in For components


UMTS scenarios and configured in a
consists of an OMB and BTS3900C WCDMA
an RRU subrack. The cabinet, see Components
BTS3900C WCDMA in a BTS3900C Cabinet.
cabinet can be supplied
with AC or DC power. An
OMB houses a BBU. An
RRU subrack houses an
RRU.

BTS3900C (Ver.C) This cabinet is used in For components


UMTS or multimode configured in a
scenarios and consists of BTS3900C (Ver.C)
an OMB (Ver.C) and an cabinet, see Components
RRU subrack. The in a BTS3900C Cabinet.
BTS3900C (Ver.C) cabinet
can be supplied with AC
or DC power. An OMB
(Ver.C) houses a BBU. An
RRU subrack houses an
RRU.

The following figure shows the exteriors of a BTS3900C WCDMA cabinet and a
BTS3900C (Ver.C) cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 546


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-288 Exteriors of BTS3900C cabinets

1.2.6.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900C


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a BTS3900C WCDMA and
a BTS3900C (Ver.C).

1.2.6.2.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900C WCDMA


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following tables, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when AC power is supplied to a
BTS3900C.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 547


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-226 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x10 A/1 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 ≤ 40 m (131.23 ft)


phase in.2)
110 V AC dual-
live-wire

DC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when DC power is supplied to a
BTS3900C.

Table 1-227 Power requirements in DC scenarios


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

-48 V DC 1x16 A/1 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


2)

1.2.6.2.2 Power Requirements of a BTS3900C (Ver.C)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when AC power is supplied to a
BTS3900C.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 548


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-228 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x20 A/1 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


phase 2)

110 V AC dual- 1x20 A/2 P


live-wire

DC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when DC power is supplied to a
BTS3900C.

Table 1-229 Power requirements in DC scenarios


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

-48 V DC 1x32 A/1 P 4 mm2 (0.0062 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


2)

1.2.6.3 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS3900C


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900C WCDMA and a
BTS3900C (Ver.C) supplied with different power.

1.2.6.3.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900C WCDMA


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900C cabinet supplied
with 110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power.

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


When -48 V DC power is supplied, it is fed into the DC power distribution box,
which then distributes the DC power to the BBU, RRUs, and other components, as
shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 549


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-289 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of circuit breakers in a BTS3900C


supplied with -48 V DC power.

Table 1-230 Specifications of circuit breakers in a BTS3900C supplied with -48 V


DC power

Power Supply Specifications of the Circuit Breaker


for the DC Output

-48 V DC ● RRU: 1x20 A


● BBU: 1x12 A
● TM: 1x12 A
● FAN: 1x12 A

1.2.6.3.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a BTS3900C (Ver.C)


This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS3900C cabinet supplied
with 110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When a BTS3900C is supplied with 110 V AC or 220 V AC, the ETP48100-A1 in the
OMB converts the one AC input into two DC outputs and provides the DC power
for the PDU10D-01.

The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a cabinet supplied
with 110 V AC or 220 V AC power, and Table 1-231 lists the specifications of fuses
in it.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 550


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

When 220 V AC single-phase power is used, the live wire must be connected to a circuit
breaker.

Figure 1-290 Power distribution scheme for a BTS3900C cabinet supplied with 220
V or 110 V AC power

Table 1-231 Fuse specifications for a BTS3900C cabinet supplied with 110 V AC or
220 V AC power
Power Supply Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

220 V AC single-phase ● RRU: 1x30 A

110 V AC dual-live-wire ● BBU: 1x30 A


● FAN: 1x30 A
● SPARE: 1x30 A

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


When a BTS3900C cabinet is supplied with -48 V DC power, the PDU10D-01 in the
OMB converts the one DC input into several DC outputs and distributes the DC
power to modules such as the BBU, HEUB, and RRU.
The following shows the power distribution scheme for a cabinet supplied with
-48 V DC power, and Table 1-232 lists the specifications of fuses in the base
station.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 551


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-291 Power distribution scheme for a BTS3900C cabinet supplied with -48
V DC power

Table 1-232 Fuse specifications for a BTS3900C cabinet supplied with -48 V DC
power
Power Supply Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

-48 V DC ● RRU: 1x30 A


● BBU: 1x30 A
● FAN: 1x30 A
● SPARE: 1x30 A

1.2.6.4 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS3900C


This section lists the reference sections in 3900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS3900C.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS3900C, see the following sections:
● For cables in a BTS3900C (Ver.C) cabinet, see BTS3900C (Ver.C) Cable List.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 552


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cable Connections
For cable connections for a BTS3900C, see topics related to Cable Connections in
3900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Table 1-233 Cable connections


Base Station Power Cable Monitoring Signal Transmiss
Connections Cable Connections ion Cable
Connecti
ons

BTS3900C BTS3900C (Ver.C) Power BTS3900C (Ver.C) Transmissi


(Ver.C) Cable Connections Monitoring Signal on Cable
Cable Connections Connectio
ns

1.3 5900 Series Base Stations


5900 series base stations include the DBS5900, BTS5900, BTS5900L, BTS5900A,
and DBS5900A.
5900 series base stations are divided into the following categories:
● Indoor macro base stations: BTS5900 and BTS5900L
● Outdoor macro base station: BTS5900A
● Distributed base station: DBS5900 and DBS5900A

1.3.1 BTS5900
This section describes cabinets, cabinet applications, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, cables, and cable connections of a BTS5900.

1.3.1.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS5900


The BTS5900 is an indoor macro base station, which can use the BTS5900 (Ver.A)
and BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) cabinets. A BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) cabinet is restructured
from a BTS3900 (Ver.A), BTS3900 (Ver.B), BTS3900 (Ver.C), or BTS3900 (Ver.D)
cabinet.
The following table lists the cabinets supported by a BTS5900.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 553


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-234 Cabinets supported by a BTS5900

Base Cabinet Cabinet Description Cabinet Configuration


Station Name

BTS5900 BTS5900 The cabinet receives For details, see Components in


(Ver.A) DC power input and BTS5900 Cabinets.
distributes DC power
to the BBU, RFUs,
RRUs, and fan
assembly.

BTS3900 The cabinet is For details, see Components in


(Ver.E_A~ restructured from a a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D).
D) BTS3900 (Ver.A),
BTS3900 (Ver.B),
BTS3900 (Ver.C), or
BTS3900 (Ver.D)
cabinet and can be
supplied with DC
power.

BTS5900 (Ver.A)
The following figure shows the exterior of a BTS5900 (Ver.A).

Figure 1-292 Exterior of a BTS5900 (Ver.A)

BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)
The BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) has the same exterior as the cabinet before restructured,
as shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 554


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-293 Exterior of a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)

1.3.1.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS5900


A BTS5900 supports different RF module configurations and spaces for customer
equipment. A BTS5900 can be configured with RFUs and RRUs together.

1.3.1.2.1 BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) Cabinet Applications


In a BTS5900 configured with RFUs and RRUs, a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) cabinet can
be installed alone, installed side by side with another BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)
cabinet, or stacked on another BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) cabinet.
The following table lists the cabinet applications of a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D).

Table 1-235 Cabinet applications


Cabinet Scenari BBU Configuration Maximum Number of Illustratio
Type o RF Modules n

BTS3900 Single 1 BBU3900/ ● 6 RFUs+6 RRUs Figure


(Ver.E_A cabinet BBU3910+1 (power 1-294
~D) BBU5900 consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 6 RFUs+3 RRUs
(800 W < power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 1100 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 555


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Scenari BBU Configuration Maximum Number of Illustratio


Type o RF Modules n

Cabinets 1 BBU3900/ ● 12 RFUs+6 RRUs Figure


installed BBU3910+1 (power 1-295
side by BBU5900 consumption per
side RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 12 RFUs+3 RRUs
(800 W < power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 1100 W)

Stacked 1 BBU3900/ ● 12 RFUs+6 RRUs Figure


cabinets BBU3910+1 (power 1-296
BBU5900 consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 12 RFUs+3 RRUs
(800 W < power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 1100 W)

When RFUs and RRUs are configured, a DCDU-12B, DCDU16D, DCDU16D-02, or


EPU02D-02 can be configured to provide power for RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 556


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-294 Single cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 557


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-295 Cabinets installed side by side

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 558


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-296 Stacked cabinets

1.3.1.2.2 BTS5900 (Ver.A) Cabinet Applications


In a BTS5900 configured with RFUs and RRUs, a BTS5900 (Ver.A) cabinet can be
installed alone, installed side by side with another BTS5900 (Ver.A) cabinet, or
stacked on another BTS5900 (Ver.A) cabinet.
The following table lists the cabinet applications of a BTS5900 (Ver.A).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 559


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-236 Cabinet applications


Cabinet Scenari BBU RF Module Power Illustration
Type o Configur Configuratio Module
ation n Configurati
on

BTS5900 Single 1 6 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


(Ver.A) cabinet BBU5900 RRUs (power illustration
consumption "2" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-297.
800 W)+3
RRUs (power
consumption
per RRU ≤
400 W)

6 RFUs+9 2 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power modules illustration
consumption "1" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-297.
800 W)

6 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W EPU02D-02
< power modules
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

6 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W DCDU16D/
< power DCDU16D-0
consumption 2 modules
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

2 6 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


BBU5900 RRUs (power illustration
s consumption "3" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-297.
800 W)

6 RFUs+3 1 -
RRUs (800 W EPU02D-02
< power
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 560


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Scenari BBU RF Module Power Illustration


Type o Configur Configuratio Module
ation n Configurati
on

6 RFUs+3 1 -
RRUs (800 W DCDU16D/
< power DCDU16D-0
consumption 2
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

Cabinet 1 12 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


s BBU5900 RRUs (power illustration
installe consumption "1" in Figure
d side per RRU ≤ 1-298.
by side 800 W)+3
RRUs (power
consumption
per RRU ≤
400 W)

12 RFUs+9 2 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power modules illustration
consumption "2" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-298.
800 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W EPU02D-02
< power modules
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W DCDU16D/
< power DCDU16D-0
consumption 2 modules
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

2 12 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


BBU5900 RRUs (power illustration
s consumption "1" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-298.
800 W)

12 RFUs+9 2 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power modules illustration
consumption "2" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-298.
800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 561


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Scenari BBU RF Module Power Illustration


Type o Configur Configuratio Module
ation n Configurati
on

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W EPU02D-02
< power modules
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W DCDU16D/
< power DCDU16D-0
consumption 2 modules
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

Stacked 1 12 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


cabinets BBU5900 RRUs (power illustration
consumption "1" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-300.
800 W)+3
RRUs (power
consumption
per RRU ≤
400 W)

12 RFUs+9 2 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power modules illustration
consumption "2" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-300.
800 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W EPU02D-02
< power modules
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W DCDU16D/
< power DCDU16D-0
consumption 2 modules
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

2 12 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


BBU5900 RRUs (power illustration
s consumption "1" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-301.
800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 562


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Scenari BBU RF Module Power Illustration


Type o Configur Configuratio Module
ation n Configurati
on

12 RFUs+9 2 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power modules illustration
consumption "2" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 1-301.
800 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W EPU02D-02
< power modules
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 -
RRUs (800 W DCDU16D/
< power DCDU16D-0
consumption 2 modules
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

When RFUs and RRUs are configured, a DCDU-12B, DCDU16D, DCDU16D-02, or


EPU02D-02 can be configured to provide power for RRUs. This section uses a
DCDU-12B as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 563


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-297 Single cabinet

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 564


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-298 Cabinets installed side by side (one BBU)

Figure 1-299 Cabinets installed side by side (two BBUs)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 565


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-300 Stacked cabinets (one BBU)

Figure 1-301 Stacked cabinets (two BBUs)

1.3.1.3 Power Requirements of a BTS5900


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)
and a BTS5900 (Ver.A).

1.3.1.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 566


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

When a BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) is supplied with DC power, the DCDU-12A/


DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02
configured in the cabinet provides power for BBUs, RFUs, RRUs, and other
modules in the cabinet. The DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 is powered by the customer's power
equipment. Table 1-237, Table 1-238, Table 1-239, and Table 1-240 list the
power requirements of a DCDU-12A, DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and
EPU02D-02/EPU02B, respectively. Table 1-241 lists the power requirements of an
EPU02S. Table 1-242 lists the power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-237 Power requirements of a base station configured with RFUs only
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)(4)

● 4 to 6 high- 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


power RFUs default) 2), two groups of

● 1 BBU3900 or DC input power


BBU3910 cables

1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2),low smoke zero
halogen

● 4 to 6 low- 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), one group of

● 1 BBU3900 or DC input power


BBU3910 cables

● 1 to 3 high- 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), one group of

● 1 BBU3900 or DC input power


BBU3910 cables

● 1 to 3 low- 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


power RFUs 2), one group of

● 1 BBU3900 or DC input power


BBU3910 cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 567


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the DRFU, GRFU, WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

Table 1-238 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 1 BBUa (power
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption ≤ 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables

a: When the power consumption per BBU does not exceed 1420 W, one power
board is configured in the BBU and needs to be powered by the DCDU-12B.
When the power consumption per BBU is greater than 1420 W and less than or
equal to 1800 W, two power boards are configured in the BBU and one of the
two power boards needs to be powered by other equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 568


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-239 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 569


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-240 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1100 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 570


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x63 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-241 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 571


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-242 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 572


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 573


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 574


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.1.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS5900 (Ver.A)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

When a BTS5900 (Ver.A) is supplied with DC power, the DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/


DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S configured in the cabinet
provides power for BBUs, RFUs, RRUs, and other modules in the cabinet. The
DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S is
powered by the customer's power equipment. Table 1-243, Table 1-244, Table
1-245, and Table 1-246 list the power requirements of a DCDU-12A, DCDU-12B,
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D-02/EPU02B, respectively. Table 1-247 lists
the power requirements of an EPU02S. Table 1-248 lists the power requirements
of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-243 Power requirements of a DCDU-12A

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 4 to 6 high- 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


power RFUs 2) (low smoke

● 1 BBU zero halogen)

2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

● 1 to 3 high- 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


power RFUs 2) (low smoke

● 1 BBU zero halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 575


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 4 to 6 low- 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


power RFUs 2) (low smoke

● 1 BBU zero halogen)

2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

● 1 to 3 low- 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


power RFUs 2) (low smoke

● 1 BBU zero halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the DRFU, GRFU, WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 576


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-244 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 1 BBUa (power
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption ≤ 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables

a: When the power consumption per BBU does not exceed 1420 W, one power
board is configured in the BBU and needs to be powered by the DCDU-12B.
When the power consumption per BBU is greater than 1420 W and less than or
equal to 1800 W, two power boards are configured in the BBU and one of the
two power boards needs to be powered by other equipment.

Table 1-245 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 577


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 578


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-246 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1100 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-247 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 579


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)
● 1 BBU (power 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤ default) 2), two groups of
1420 W) DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 580


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-248 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 581


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 582


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured in a DCDU, a maximum of six 8.2 mm2 (0.013 in.
2) power cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W)
and a maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for
RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.1.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900


This section describes the power distribution schemes for a BTS5900.
When DC power is supplied to a base station, the DCDU-12A can be configured in
the cabinet to provide power for the BBU, RFUs, and fan assembly, and the
DCDU-12B or EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 can be configured to provide
power for the BBU and RRUs.
Power Distribution Scheme for the DCDU-12A
The following figure shows the DCDU-12A power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-302 Power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12A

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the DCDU-12A.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 583


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-249 Fuse specifications of the DCDU-12A


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

DCDU-12A -48 V DC -48 V DC power


distribution
● RFU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● BBUa: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: 1x30 A (FUSE)

a: The BBU3900 or BBU3910 modules are used in BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) and


BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) cabinets.

Power Distribution Scheme for the DCDU-12B


The DCDU-12B can provide power for BBUs and RRUs. Figure 1-303 shows the
power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12B when it powers BBUs and RRUs.

Figure 1-303 Power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12B (powering BBUs and
RRUs)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the DCDU-12B.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 584


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-250 Fuse specifications of the DCDU-12B


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

DCDU-12B -48 V DC -48 V DC power


distribution
● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● BBUa: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

a: One DCDU-12B cannot supply power to the two power boards in the
BBU5900. One of the two power boards needs to be powered by other power
modules.

Power Distribution Scheme for the DCDU16D


The DCDU16D can provide power for BBUs, RRUs, fans, transmission equipment,
and other components. The following figure shows the power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-304 DCDU16D power distribution scheme

The following table lists the circuit breaker/fuse specifications of the DCDU16D.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 585


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-251 Circuit breaker/fuse specifications of the DCDU16D


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Circuit Breaker/
Fuse

DCDU16D -48 V DC -48 V DC power


distribution
● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB)
● BBU/FAN/TM: 4x30 A
(FUSE)

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02D-02


The following figure shows the EPU02D-02 power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-305 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02D-02

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02D-02.

Table 1-252 Fuse specifications of the EPU02D-02


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

EPU02D-02 -48 V DC -48 V DC power output:


4x30 A (BBU/FAN/TM)
(FUSE)
-57 V DC power output:
3x30 A (RRU) (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 586


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02B


The following figure shows the EPU02B power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-306 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02B

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02B.

Table 1-253 Fuse specifications of the EPU02B


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

EPU02B -48 V DC -48 V DC power output:


4x30 A (BBU/FAN/TM)
(FUSE)
-57 V DC power output:
6x30 A (RRU) (FUSE)

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02S


The following figure shows the EPU02S power distribution scheme.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 587


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-307 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02S

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02S.

Table 1-254 Fuse specifications of the EPU02S


Power Equipment External Power Supply DC Output Specifications

EPU02S -48 V DC -48 V DC power output:


4x30 A (BBU/FAN/TM)
(FUSE)
-57 V DC power output:
3x28 A (RRU)

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02S-02


The following figure shows the EPU02S-02 power distribution scheme.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 588


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-308 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02S-02

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02S-02.

Table 1-255 Fuse specifications of the EPU02S-02


Power Equipment External Power Supply DC Output Specifications

EPU02S-02 -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30


A (BBU/FAN/TM) (FUSE)
-57 V DC power output: 3x28
A (RRU)

1.3.1.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS5900


This section lists the reference sections in 5900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS5900.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS5900, see BTS5900 Cable List.

Cable Connections
For cable connections for a BTS5900, see topics related to Cable Connections in
5900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 589


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-256 Cable connections

Cabin Power Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI RF


et Cable Signal on Cable Intercon Cable Cable
Type Connecti Cable Connectio nection Connect Connec
ons Connection ns Signal ions tions
s Cable
Connecti
ons

BTS39 BTS3900 BTS3900 Transmissi BBU CPRI RF


00 (Ver.E_A~ (Ver.E_A~D) on Cable Interconn Cable Cable
(Ver.E D) Power Monitoring Connectio ection Connecti Connec
_A~D) Cable Signal ns for Signal ons for tions
Connectio Cable 5900 Cable 5900
ns Connection Series Base Connecti Series
s Stations ons Base
Stations
BTS59 BTS5900 BTS5900
00 (Ver.A) (Ver.A)
(Ver.A Power Monitoring
) Cable Signal
Connectio Cable
ns Connection
s

1.3.2 BTS5900L
This section describes cabinets, cabinet applications, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, cables, and cable connections of a BTS5900L.

1.3.2.1 Cabinets Supported by a BTS5900L


The BTS5900L is an indoor macro base station, which can use the BTS5900L
(Ver.A) and BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) cabinets. A BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) cabinet is
restructured from a BTS3900L (Ver.B), BTS3900L (Ver.C), or BTS3900L (Ver.D)
cabinet.

The following table lists the cabinets supported by a BTS5900L.

Table 1-257 Cabinets supported by a BTS5900L

Base Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Cabinet


Station Configuration

BTS5900L BTS5900L The cabinet receives For details, see


(Ver.A) DC power input and Components in a
distributes DC power BTS5900L Cabinet.
to the BBU, RFUs,
RRUs, and fan
assembly.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 590


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Base Cabinet Name Cabinet Description Cabinet


Station Configuration

BTS3900L The cabinet is For details, see


(Ver.E_B~D) restructured from a Components in a
BTS3900L (Ver.B), BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D).
BTS3900L (Ver.C), or
BTS3900L (Ver.D)
cabinet and can be
supplied with DC
power.

BTS5900L (Ver.A)
The following figure shows the exterior of a BTS5900L (Ver.A) cabinet.

Figure 1-309 Exterior of a BTS5900L (Ver.A)

BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)
The BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) has the same exterior as the cabinet before
restructured, as shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 591


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-310 Exterior of a BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)

1.3.2.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS5900L


A BTS5900L supports different RF module configurations and spaces for customer
equipment. A BTS5900L can be configured with RFUs and RRUs together.

1.3.2.2.1 BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) Cabinet Applications


When the BTS5900L is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)
can meet different requirements for power distribution, module configuration, and
space for customer equipment.
The following table lists the cabinet applications of a BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 592


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-258 Cabinet applications

Cabinet BBU Configuration Maximum Number of RF Illustration


Type Modules

BTS3900L 1 BBU3900/ ● 12 RFUs+6 RRUs (power Figure


(Ver.E_B~D) BBU3910+1 consumption per RRU ≤ 1-311
BBU5900 800 W)
● 12 RFUs+3 RRUs (800 W
< power consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400 W)

When RFUs and RRUs are configured, a DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, or


EPU02D-02 can be configured to provide power for RRUs.
NOTE

The installation positions of the DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D-02 are


similar. The following figure uses the DCDU-12B as an example.

Figure 1-311 Cabinet applications

1.3.2.2.2 BTS5900L (Ver.A) Cabinet Applications


A BTS5900L can be configured with RFUs and RRUs together.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 593


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

A single BTS5900L base station is configured with only one BTS5900L (Ver.A)
cabinet. The following table lists the cabinet applications when a BTS5900L base
station is configured with RFUs and RRUs.

Table 1-259 Cabinet applications


Cabinet BBU RF Module Power Module Illustration
Type Configuratio Configuration Configuration
n

BTS5900L 1 BBU5900 12 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


(Ver.A) RRUs (power illustration
consumption "1" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 800 1-312.
W)+3 RRUs
(power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)

12 RFUs+9 2 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power modules illustration
consumption "2" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 800 1-312.
W)

12 RFUs+6 2 EPU02D-02 -
RRUs (800 W < modules
power
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 DCDU16D/ -
RRUs (power DCDU16D-02
consumption modules
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

2 BBU5900s 12 RFUs+6 1 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power illustration
consumption "1" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 800 1-313.
W)+3 RRUs
(power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)

12 RFUs+9 2 DCDU-12B See


RRUs (power modules illustration
consumption "2" in Figure
per RRU ≤ 800 1-313.
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 594


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet BBU RF Module Power Module Illustration


Type Configuratio Configuration Configuration
n

12 RFUs+6 2 EPU02D-02 -
RRUs (800 W < modules
power
consumption
per RRU ≤
1100 W)

12 RFUs+6 2 DCDU16D/ -
RRUs (power DCDU16D-02
consumption modules
per RRU ≤
1400 W)

When RFUs and RRUs are configured, a DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, or


EPU02D-02 can be configured to provide power for RRUs. This section uses a
DCDU-12B as an example.

Figure 1-312 One BBU

Figure 1-313 Two BBUs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 595


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.2.3 Power Requirements of a BTS5900L


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)
and a BTS5900L (Ver.A).

1.3.2.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

When a BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) is supplied with DC power, the DCDU-12A/


DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02
configured in the cabinet provides power for BBUs, RFUs, RRUs, and other
modules in the cabinet. The DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 is powered by the customer's power
equipment. Table 1-260, Table 1-261, Table 1-262, and Table 1-263 list the
power requirements of a DCDU-12A, DCDU-12B, DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and
EPU02D-02/EPU02B respectively. Table 1-264 lists the power requirements of an
EPU02S. Table 1-265 lists the power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-260 Power requirements of a DCDU-12A

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable Length


Configuratio Requirement for the Input Power Cable Requirement
n(1) Circuit Breakers
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 7 to 12 2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), two ≤ 15 m (49.21


high- groups of DC input power ft)
power cables
RFUs
4x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), four
● 1 BBU3900
groups of DC input power
or
cables
BBU3910

● 7 to 12 2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), two


low-power groups of DC input power
RFUs cables
● 1 BBU3900
4x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), four
or
groups of DC input power
BBU3910
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 596


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable Length


Configuratio Requirement for the Input Power Cable Requirement
n(1) Circuit Breakers
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 6 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), low


high- smoke zero halogen
power
RFUs 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
groups of DC input power
● 1 BBU3900
cables
or
BBU3910

● 1 to 6 low- 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), low


power smoke zero halogen
RFUs
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
● 1 BBU3900
groups of DC input power
or
cables
BBU3910

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the DRFU, GRFU, WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 597


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-261 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 1 BBUa (power
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption ≤ 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables

a: When the power consumption per BBU does not exceed 1420 W, one power
board is configured in the BBU and needs to be powered by the DCDU-12B.
When the power consumption per BBU is greater than 1420 W and less than or
equal to 1800 W, two power boards are configured in the BBU and one of the
two power boards needs to be powered by other equipment.

Table 1-262 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 598


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 599


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-263 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1100 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-264 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 600


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)
● 1 BBU (power 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤ default) 2), two groups of
1420 W) DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 601


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-265 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 602


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 603


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.2.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS5900L (Ver.A)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

When a BTS5900L (Ver.A) is supplied with DC power, the DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/


DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 configured in
the cabinet provides power for BBUs, RFUs, RRUs, and other modules in the
cabinet. The DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/
EPU02S/EPU02S-02 is powered by the customer's power equipment. Table 1-266,
Table 1-267, and Table 1-268 list the power requirements of a DCDU-12A,
DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, respectively. Table 1-269 lists the power
requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B. Table 1-270 lists the power requirements
of an EPU02S. Table 1-271 lists the power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-266 Power requirements of a DCDU-12A

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable Length


Configuratio Requirement for the Input Power Cable Requirement
n(1)(5) Circuit Breakers
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 7 to 12 2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), two ≤ 15 m (49.21


high- groups of DC input power ft)
power cables (low smoke zero
RFUs halogen)
● 2 BBUs
4x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), four
groups of DC input power
cables

● 7 to 12 2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), two


low-power groups of DC input power
RFUs cables (low smoke zero
● 2 BBUs halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 604


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable Length


Configuratio Requirement for the Input Power Cable Requirement
n(1)(5) Circuit Breakers
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

4x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), four


groups of DC input power
cables

● 4 to 6 2x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), two


high- groups of DC input power
power cables
RFUs
4x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), four
● 1 or 2
groups of DC input power
BBUs
cables

● 1 to 6 low- 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two


power groups of DC input power
RFUs cables
● 1 or 2
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two
BBUs
groups of DC input power
cables

3x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), three


groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 605


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the DRFU, GRFU, WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) The capacity of circuit breakers for indoor macro base stations does not take into
account the power consumed by transmission equipment in the cabinet.

Table 1-267 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 1 BBUa (power
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption ≤ 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables

a: When the power consumption per BBU does not exceed 1420 W, one power
board is configured in the BBU and needs to be powered by the DCDU-12B.
When the power consumption per BBU is greater than 1420 W and less than or
equal to 1800 W, two power boards are configured in the BBU and one of the
two power boards needs to be powered by other equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 606


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-268 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 607


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-269 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1100 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 608


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x63 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-270 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 609


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-271 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 610


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 611


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 612


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured in a DCDU, a maximum of six 8.2 mm2 (0.013 in.
2) power cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W)
and a maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for
RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.2.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900L


This section describes the power distribution schemes for a BTS5900L.
When DC power is supplied to a base station, the DCDU-12A can be configured in
the cabinet to provide power for the BBU, RFUs, and fan assembly, and the
DCDU-12B or EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 can be configured to provide
power for the BBU and RRUs.
Power Distribution Scheme for the DCDU-12A
The following figure shows the DCDU-12A power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-314 Power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12A

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the DCDU-12A.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 613


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-272 Fuse specifications of the DCDU-12A


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

DCDU-12A -48 V DC -48 V DC power


distribution
● RFU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● BBUa: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: 1x30 A (FUSE)

a: The BBU3900 or BBU3910 modules are used in BTS3900 (Ver.E_A~D) and


BTS3900L (Ver.E_B~D) cabinets.

Power Distribution Scheme for the DCDU-12B


The DCDU-12B can provide power for BBUs and RRUs. Figure 1-315 shows the
power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12B when it powers BBUs and RRUs.

Figure 1-315 Power distribution scheme for the DCDU-12B (powering BBUs and
RRUs)

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the DCDU-12B.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 614


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-273 Fuse specifications of the DCDU-12B


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

DCDU-12B -48 V DC -48 V DC power


distribution
● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● BBUa: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

a: One DCDU-12B cannot supply power to the two power boards in the
BBU5900. One of the two power boards needs to be powered by other power
modules.

Power Distribution Scheme for the DCDU16D


The DCDU16D can provide power for BBUs, RRUs, fans, transmission equipment,
and other components. The following figure shows the power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-316 DCDU16D power distribution scheme

The following table lists the circuit breaker/fuse specifications of the DCDU16D.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 615


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-274 Circuit breaker/fuse specifications of the DCDU16D


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Circuit Breaker/
Fuse

DCDU16D -48 V DC -48 V DC power


distribution
● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB)
● BBU/FAN/TM: 4x30 A
(FUSE)

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02D-02


The following figure shows the EPU02D-02 power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-317 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02D-02

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02D-02.

Table 1-275 Fuse specifications of the EPU02D-02


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

EPU02D-02 -48 V DC -48 V DC power output:


4x30 A (BBU/FAN/TM)
(FUSE)
-57 V DC power output:
3x30 A (RRU) (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 616


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02B


The following figure shows the EPU02B power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-318 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02B

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02B.

Table 1-276 Fuse specifications of the EPU02B


Power Equipment External Power Supply Specifications of the DC
Output Fuse

EPU02B -48 V DC -48 V DC power output:


4x30 A (BBU/FAN/TM)
(FUSE)
-57 V DC power output:
6x30 A (RRU) (FUSE)

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02S


The following figure shows the EPU02S power distribution scheme.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 617


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-319 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02S

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02S.

Table 1-277 Fuse specifications of the EPU02S


Power Equipment External Power Supply DC Output Specifications

EPU02S -48 V DC -48 V DC power output:


4x30 A (BBU/FAN/TM)
(FUSE)
-57 V DC power output:
3x28 A (RRU)

Power Distribution Scheme for the EPU02S-02


The following figure shows the EPU02S-02 power distribution scheme.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 618


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-320 Power distribution scheme for the EPU02S-02

The following table lists the fuse specifications of the EPU02S-02.

Table 1-278 Fuse specifications of the EPU02S-02


Power Equipment External Power Supply DC Output Specifications

EPU02S-02 -48 V DC -48 V DC power output: 4x30


A (BBU/FAN/TM) (FUSE)
-57 V DC power output: 3x28
A (RRU)

1.3.2.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS5900L


This section lists the reference sections in 5900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS5900L.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS5900L, see BTS5900L Cable List.

Cable Connections
For cable connections for a BTS5900L, see topics related to Cable Connections in
5900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 619


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-279 Cable connections


Base Power Monitorin Transmissio BBU CPRI RF Cable
Stati Cable g Signal n Cable Interconn Cable Connecti
on Connecti Cable Connection ection Connec ons
ons Connectio s Signal tions
ns Cable
Connectio
ns

BTS3 BTS3900 BTS3900L Transmissio BBU CPRI CPRI


900L L (Ver.E_B~D n Cable Interconne Cable Cable
(Ver. (Ver.E_B~ ) Connections ction Connect Connecti
E_B~ D) Power Monitorin for 5900 Signal ions for ons for
D) Cable g Signal Series Base Cable 5900 5900
Connecti Cable Stations Connectio Series Series
ons Connectio ns Base Base
ns Stations Stations

BTS5 BTS5900 BTS5900L Transmissio BBU CPRI CPRI


900L L (Ver.A) (Ver.A) n Cable Interconne Cable Cable
(Ver. Power Monitorin Connections ction Connect Connecti
A) Cable g Signal for 5900 Signal ions for ons for
Connecti Cable Series Base Cable 5900 5900
ons Connectio Stations Connectio Series Series
ns ns Base Base
Stations Stations

1.3.3 BTS5900A
This section describes cabinets, cabinet applications, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, cables, and cable connections of a BTS5900A.

1.3.3.1 Cabinets Used by a BTS5900A


The BTS5900A is an outdoor separated macro base station, and it can be
constituted of cabinets with different functions.
The following table lists the cabinets used by a BTS5900A.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 620


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-280 Cabinets used by a BTS5900A


Base Cabinet Name Cabinet Description
Station

BTS5900A APM30H (Ver.E), TMC11H ● The BBCe is a battery cabinet


(Ver.E), RFC (Ver.C), RFC (Ver.D), that provides backup power
RFC (Ver.E), IBBS200D (Ver.C), for a site.
IBBS200D (Ver.D), IBBS200D
(Ver.E), IBBS200T (Ver.C),
IBBS200T (Ver.D), IBBS200T
(Ver.E), IBBS300D (Ver.A),
IBBS300T (Ver.A), BBC5200D-L,
APM30H (Ver.F_B~E), TMC11H
(Ver.F_B~E), IBBS200D
(Ver.F_B~E), IBBS200T
(Ver.F_B~E), IBBS300D
(Ver.F_B~E), or IBBS300T
(Ver.F_B~E)

a. APM30H: advanced power module with heat exchanger


b. TMC11H: transmission cabinet with heat exchanger
c. IBBS200T/IBBS300T: integrated backup battery system with TEC; IBBS200D/
IBBS300D: integrated backup battery system with direct ventilation
d. RFC: radio frequency cabinet
e. BBC: battery backup cabinet

Cabinet Exteriors
The following figure shows the common combinations of BTS5900A cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 621


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-321 Exteriors of cabinets used by BTS5900As

A: BTS5900A in AC scenarios without backup B: BTS5900A in AC scenarios with backup


power or in DC scenarios power provided by the IBBS200D

C: BTS5900A in AC scenarios with backup -


power provided by the IBBS300D

Cabinet Introduction
The following table lists cabinets applicable to the BTS5900A and the cabinet
configuration for reference.

Table 1-281 Cabinets used by a BTS5900A

Cabinet Cabinet Name Cabinet Configuration


Type

APM30H APM30H (Ver.E) For details, see Components in


series APM30Hs.
cabinets

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 622


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Cabinet Name Cabinet Configuration


Type

TMC11H TMC11H (Ver.E) For details, see Components in


series TMC11Hs.
cabinets

RFC series RFC (Ver.C), RFC (Ver.D), or RFC For details, see Components in
cabinets (Ver.E) RFCs.

IBBS ● IBBS200D (Ver.D), IBBS200D ● For details, see Components


series (Ver.C), or IBBS200D (Ver.E) in IBBS200Ds.
cabinets ● IBBS200T (Ver.D), IBBS200T ● For details, see Components
(Ver.C), or IBBS200T (Ver.E) in IBBS200Ts.
● IBBS300D (Ver.A) or ● For details, see Components
IBBS300T (Ver.A) in IBBS300Ds and
Components in IBBS300Ts.

BBC ● BBC5200D-L ● For details, see Components


series in a BBC5200D-L.
cabinets

Besides the preceding cabinets, some cabinets of earlier versions can be


restructured to have the same capability as Ver.F cabinets. The following table
describes such cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 623


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-282 Reused cabinets


Base Applica Cabinet Cabinet Power Power
Stati tion Name Description Requirement Distribution
on Scenari Scheme
o and
Cabinet
Configu
ration

BTS5 For APM30 Restructured The power Power


900A details, H from the requirements Distribution
see (Ver.F_B APM30H of a BTS5900A Schemes for a
BTS390 ~E) (Ver.B), using an BTS5900A
0A APM30H APM30H Using the
Installat (Ver.C), (Ver.F_B~E) are APM30H
ion APM30H the same as (Ver.F_B~E)
Guide (Ver.D), or those of a
for APM30H DBS5900 using
Enhanci (Ver.E) an
ng APM5930(AC).
Existing For details, see
Cabinet 1.3.4.3.5
s (Ver.F Power
Series). Requirements
of a DBS5900
Using the
APM5930(AC).

TMC11 Restructured Power The power


H from the Requirements distribution
(Ver.F_B TMC11H of a BTS5900A scheme for a
~E) (Ver.B), Using the BTS5900A
TMC11H TMC11H using a
(Ver.C), (Ver.F_B~E) TMC11H
TMC11H (Ver.F_B~E) is
(Ver.D), or the same as
TMC11H that for a
(Ver.E) DBS5900 using
an
APM5930(DC).
For details, see
1.3.4.4.6
Power
Distribution
Scheme for a
DBS5900
Using the
APM5930(DC).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 624


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Base Applica Cabinet Cabinet Power Power


Stati tion Name Description Requirement Distribution
on Scenari Scheme
o and
Cabinet
Configu
ration

IBBS200 Restructured - -
D from the
(Ver.F_B IBBS200D
~E) or (Ver.B),
IBBS200 IBBS200T
T (Ver.B),
(Ver.F_B IBBS200D
~E) (Ver.C),
IBBS200T
(Ver.C),
IBBS200D
(Ver.D),
IBBS200T
(Ver.D),
IBBS200D
(Ver.E), or
IBBS200T
(Ver.E)

1.3.3.2 Cabinet Applications Supported by a BTS5900A


Various cabinets can be configured for a BTS5900A to meet different requirements
for RF module configurations, backup power capacity, and spaces for customer
equipment. A BTS5900A can be configured with RFUs or with RFUs and RRUs
together.

1.3.3.2.1 BTS5900A Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


If a BTS5900A is configured with RFUs but without RRUs, different cabinet
configurations can be used for the BTS5900A in a single-, dual-, triple-, or
quadruple-mode scenario supplied with 110 V AC power, 220 V AC power, or -48 V
DC power.

Cabinet Configuration Principles for a BTS5900A


Maximum configuration principles for a single site
● A site can be configured with a maximum of 12 RFUs.
● Cabinets in a site must be installed side by side with a clearance of 40 mm
(1.57 in.) between them.
● When a site is configured with more than six RFUs and only one IBBS200D,
IBBS200T, IBBS300D, or IBBS300T, the IBBS200D, IBBS200T, IBBS300D, or
IBBS300T must be configured with at least two battery packs consisting of

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 625


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

100 Ah storage batteries to avoid overcurrent of a single battery pack during


discharging.
Principles for stacking and combining cabinets
● When an IBBS200D/IBBS200T/BBC5200D-L is stacked with a TMC11H, the
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/BBC5200D-L must be placed under the TMC11H. When
two IBBS200D/IBBS200T/BBC5200D-L cabinets are stacked, only cabinets of
the same type can be stacked. That is, an IBBS200D can only be stacked with
another IBBS200D. An IBBS200T can only be stacked with another IBBS200T. A
BBC5200D-L can only be stacked with another BBC5200D-L.
● When an IBBS300D/IBBS300T is stacked with a TMC11H, the IBBS300D/
IBBS300T must be placed under the TMC11H. When two IBBS300D/IBBS300T
cabinets are stacked, only cabinets of the same type can be stacked. That is,
an IBBS300D can only be stacked with another IBBS300D. An IBBS300T can
only be stacked with another IBBS300T.
● An IBBS200D or IBBS200T cannot be used together with an IBBS300D or
IBBS300T.
● An RFC can be stacked only with an APM30H or TMC11H, and the RFC must
be placed under the APM30H or TMC11H.
● If auxiliary cabinets, such as the battery cabinet IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T/BBC5200D-L or transmission cabinet TMC11H, are
required during initial site deployment, the auxiliary cabinets are positioned
on the left, and the basic cabinets are positioned on the right. If both a
battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are required, the battery cabinet is
positioned on the left side of the basic cabinet, and the transmission cabinet
is stacked on the battery cabinet or positioned on the left side of the battery
cabinet.
● During initial site deployment, space must be reserved for capacity expansion.
Unless otherwise stated, new cabinets are added to the right side of original
cabinets for capacity expansion and the original cabinets are not relocated. In
a special scenario, new cabinets can be added to the left side of original
cabinets.
Configuration restrictions on Ver.D+Ver.E cabinet combinations
● If a Ver.E cabinet is installed on a Ver.D base, the cabling capability at the
bottom of the Ver.E cabinet is the same as that of a Ver.D cabinet.
● If an APM30H (Ver.E) supplies power to a Ver.D series battery cabinet, the
power distribution capability of the APM30H (Ver.E) is the same as that of an
APM30H (Ver.D).
● If an APM30H (Ver.E) is stacked on an RFC (Ver.D), the cabling capability at
the bottom of the APM30H (Ver.E) is the same as that of an APM30H (Ver.D).
Configuration principles in single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode base
stations
● In a single- or dual-mode base station, only one BBU is configured. In a triple-
or quadruple-mode base station, two BBUs can be configured, and the second
BBU is installed in the 2 U space under the first BBU.
● A cabinet combination of one APM30H and one RFC is configured with one
BBU by default. This cabinet combination can be configured with a maximum
of two BBUs, and the power consumption of the two BBUs cannot exceed
1200 W.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 626


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● If two BBUs are configured during the initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H and transmission equipment is installed in a TMC11H.
● During capacity expansion, if there is space for a second BBU in an APM30H,
the second BBU is installed in the APM30H. If there is no space, the second
BBU is installed in a TMC11H.
NOTE

The cabinet configurations in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base station


configured with one BBU are the same as those in a triple- or quadruple-mode base station
configured with two BBUs. This section describes the cabinet configurations in a base
station configured with two BBUs.

Cabinet Configurations
● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
different space for customer equipment and carrier configurations but
without backup power in a 110 V or 220 V AC power supply scenario.

Figure 1-322 Cabinet configurations of a base station without backup power

NOTE

The preceding figure shows two configurations: (A) and (B). (A) refers to the initial
configuration of 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1 TMC11H. (B) refers to the initial configuration of 1
APM30H+1 RFC+1 TMC11H expanded to 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1 TMC11H.
● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by one battery cabinet as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 627


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-323 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by one battery cabinet

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by two battery cabinets as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Figure 1-324 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by two battery cabinets

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station


supplied with -48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 628


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-325 Cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with -48 V DC


power

The following table lists the cabinet configurations in the case of different power
inputs, backup power requirements, spaces for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-283 Cabinet configurations


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power BBU: ≤ 5 U
AC Two BBUs:
≤3U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 5 U
Two BBUs:
≤3U

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 629


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


power BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
by one ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
battery IBBS300D/IBBS300T
cabinet
Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


power BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
by two ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
battery IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
cabinets

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 630


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


BBU: ≤ 5 U IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

-48 V DC - Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 TMC11H+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 9 U
≤ 12 RFUs 1 TMC11H+2 RFCs
Two BBUs:
≤7U

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 20
U ≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs
Two BBUs:
≤ 18 U

1.3.3.2.2 BTS5900A Configured with RFUs and RRUs


If a BTS5900A is configured with RFUs and RRUs, different cabinet configurations
can be used for the BTS5900A in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode
scenario supplied with 110 V AC power, 220 V AC power, or -48 V DC power.

Cabinet Configuration Principles


Maximum configuration principles for a single site
● A single site supports a maximum of 6 RFUs+15 RRUs or 12 RFUs+9 RRUs.
● If a site is configured with RFUs and RRUs, the supported RRU specifications
are listed in the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 631


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-284 RRU specifications supported by a site configured with RFUs and
RRUs
RF Module Configuration RRU Specifications

6 RFUs+15 RRUs 6 RRUs (2x80 W power per RRU)+9


RRUs (2x40 W power per RRU)

12 RFUs+9 RRUs 9 RRUs (2x40 W power per RRU)

Configuration restrictions on Ver.D+Ver.E cabinet combinations


● If a Ver.D cabinet and a Ver.E cabinet are installed side by side or stacked in a
base station, the base station supports a maximum of six RFUs and nine
RRUs.
● A maximum of six 2x60 W RRUs and three 2x40 W RRUs can be configured.
Configuration principles in single-, dual-, triple-, and quadruple-mode base
stations
● In a single- or dual-mode base station, only one BBU is configured. In a triple-
or quadruple-mode base station, two BBUs can be configured, and the second
BBU is installed in the 2 U space under the first BBU.
● A cabinet combination of one APM30H and one RFC is configured with one
BBU by default. This cabinet combination can be configured with a maximum
of two BBUs, and the power consumption of the two BBUs cannot exceed
1200 W.
● If two BBUs are configured during the initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H and transmission equipment is installed in a TMC11H.
● During capacity expansion, if there is space for a second BBU in an APM30H,
the second BBU is installed in the APM30H. If there is no space, the second
BBU is installed in a TMC11H.
NOTE

The cabinet configurations in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base station


configured with one BBU are the same as those in a triple- or quadruple-mode base station
configured with two BBUs. This section describes the cabinet configurations in a base
station configured with two BBUs.

Cabinet Configuration
● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
different space for customer equipment and carrier configurations but
without backup power in a 110 V or 220 V AC power supply scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 632


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-326 Cabinet configurations of a base station without backup power

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by one battery cabinet as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 633


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-327 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by one battery cabinet

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station with
backup power provided by two battery cabinets as well as different space for
customer equipment and carrier configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 634


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-328 Cabinet configurations of a base station with backup power


provided by two battery cabinets

● The following figure shows the cabinet configurations of a base station


supplied with -48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 635


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-329 Cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with -48 V DC


power

The following table lists the cabinet configurations in the case of different power
inputs, backup power requirements, spaces for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 636


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-285 Cabinet configurations


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

110 V AC No backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC


or 220 V power BBU: ≤ 5 U +15 RRUs
AC Two BBUs:
≤3U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 5 U +9 RRUs
Two BBUs:
≤3U

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +15 RRUs TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +9 RRUs TMC11H
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 14 U

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


power BBU: ≤ 5 U +15 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
by one ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
battery IBBS300D/IBBS300T
cabinet
Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
BBU: ≤ 5 U +9 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-L
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +15 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 637


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1


BBU: ≤ 16 +9 RRUs IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5200D-L+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+1
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
TMC11H

Backup Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


power BBU: ≤ 5 U +15 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
provided Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
by two ≤3U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
battery IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
cabinets
Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
BBU: ≤ 5 U +9 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
Two BBUs: BBC5200D-Ls
≤3U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts

Single ≤ 6 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2


BBU: ≤ 16 +15 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+1 RFC+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

Single ≤ 12 RFUs ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2


BBU: ≤ 16 +9 RRUs IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
U BBC5200D-Ls+1
Two BBUs: TMC11H
≤ 14 U ● 1 APM30H+2 RFCs+2
IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
+1 TMC11H

-48 V DC - Single ≤ 6 RFUs 1 TMC11H+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 8 U +15 RRUs
Two BBUs:
≤6U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 1 TMC11H+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 9 U +9 RRUs
Two BBUs:
≤7U

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 638


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Customer Configurat
Requirem Equipmen ion
ent t

Single ≤ 6 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+1 RFC


BBU: ≤ 19 +15 RRUs
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 17 U

Single ≤ 12 RFUs 2 TMC11Hs+2 RFCs


BBU: ≤ 20 +9 RRUs
U
Two BBUs:
≤ 18 U

1.3.3.3 Power Requirements of a BTS5900A


This section describes the power requirements of a BTS5900A.

1.3.3.3.1 Power Requirements of a BTS5900A Using the APM30H (Ver.E)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

AC Input Scenario
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table lists the power requirements when AC power is supplied to the
base station.

Table 1-286 Power requirements in AC scenarios

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x40 A/3 P Cable with a ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) black jacket ft)
and four core
wires, two

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 639


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P insulation


(by default) layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 6 mm2
(0.0093 in.2)

220 V AC 5 1x100 A/1 P Two wires (L


single-phase (by default) and N), each
with a single
4 1x80 A/1 P core wire, two
3 1x63 A/1 P insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x100 A/2 P Three wires


120 V AC (by default) (L1, L2, and
dual-live-wire N), each with
4 1x80 A/2 P a single core
3 1x63 A/2 P wire, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs Only


The following table lists the power requirements when -48 V DC power is supplied
to a base station configured with RFUs only.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 640


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-287 Power requirements in DC input scenarios configured with RFUs only

Product Configuration(1) Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Requirem Input Power Cable(3) Length
ent for Requireme
Circuit nt
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipmen
t(2)

● 4 to 6 high-power RFUs 1x160 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 15 m


● 0 to 2 BBUs P one group of DC input (49.21 ft)
power cables (low
● Power consumption of
smoke zero halogen)
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W 2x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
P (by two groups of DC input
default) power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 2x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 2 BBUs P two groups of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment 1x100 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),
≤ 350 W P one group of DC input
power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 or 1 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W

● 0 to 3 high-power RFUs 1x100 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


● 0 to 2 BBUs P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment 2x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
≤ 350 W P two groups of DC input
power cables

● 0 to 3 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 or 1 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables
● Power consumption of
transmission equipment
≤ 350 W

● 4 to 6 high-power RFUs 1x160 A/1 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables (low
smoke zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 641


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Configuration(1) Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Requirem Input Power Cable(3) Length
ent for Requireme
Circuit nt
Breakers
on
Customer
Equipmen
t(2)

2x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


P (by two groups of DC input
default) power cables

● 0 to 3 high-power RFUs 1x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

● 4 to 6 low-power RFUs 1x80 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

● 0 to 3 low-power RFUs 1x63 A/1 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),


● 0 BBU P one group of DC input
power cables

NOTE

(1) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:


● If high-power RFUs and low-power RFUs are configured in one base station, the
specifications of the circuit breakers are based on the full configuration of high-power
RFUs.
● If the customer's power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RFUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RFUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.
● High-power RFUs include the LRFUe, WRFUd, MRFUd, MRFUe, WRFUe, CRFUd, and
CRFUe.
● Low-power RFUs include the WRFU, WRFUa, MRFU, and LRFU.
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 642


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a base station uses -48 V DC power and is configured with RFUs and RRUs,
external power equipment supplies power to the DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02, respectively.
● The DCDU-12A provides power for the RFUs and FAN 01D in the RFC. The
preceding table describes the power requirements of a DCDU-12A.
● The DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02 provides power
for RRUs. A DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02 is
configured as required. Table 1-288 lists the power requirements of a
DCDU-12B. Table 1-289 lists the power requirements of a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02. Table 1-290 lists the power requirements of an EPU02D/
EPU02D-02.

Table 1-288 Power requirements in DC input scenarios configured with RFUs and
RRUs
Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


consumption per group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
default) groups of DC input power
cables

9 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 643


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W)+3 cables
RRUs (power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 800 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 650 W) cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 644


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-289 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 10 m (32.81


(power one group of DC ft)
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 645


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),


two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-290 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 646


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w, RRU5903,
RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w, RRU5513t,
RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256, RRU3259,
RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m, RRU3959, RRU3959a,
RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953, RRU3953w,
RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962, RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972, AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 647


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the specifications
of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the full
configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do not meet
the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the circuit breakers
during base station capacity expansion.
● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the circuit
breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption need to be
added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.3.3.2 Power Requirements of a BTS5900A Using the APM30H (Ver.F_B~E)/


TMC11H (Ver.F_B~E)
This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured base
station that has the peak output power.

AC Input Scenario
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of a base station supplied
with AC power and using the APM30H (Ver.F_B~E).

Table 1-291 Power requirements

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x50 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) a black ft)
jacket and
four core
wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 648


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P ● PE cable


(by default) with a
cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)

220 V AC 5 1x125 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (by default) (L and N),
each with
4 1x100 A/1 P a single
3 1x80 A/1 P core wire,
two
2 1x50 A/1 P insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x125 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC (by default) wires (L1,
dual-live-wire L2, and N),
4 1x100 A/2 P each with
3 1x80 A/2 P a single
core wire,
two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 649


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

2 1x50 A/2 P ● PE cable


with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs but Without RRUs


The following table describes the power requirements of a base station supplied
with DC power and using the TMC11H (Ver.F_B~E) configured with RFUs but
without RRUs.

Table 1-292 Power requirements in a DC scenario where only RFUs are configured
and no RRU is configured
Product Minimum Requirements for Cable Length
Configuration Requirement for the Input Power Requirement
Circuit Breakers Cable
on Customer
Equipment

● 4 to 6 high- 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 15 m (49.21 ft)


power RFUs default) 2), two groups of

● 0 to 2 BBUs DC input power


cables
● Power
consumption
of transmission
equipment ≤
350 W

● 4 to 6 low- 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


power RFUs 2),two groups of
● 0 to 2 BBUs DC input power
cables
● Power
consumption
of transmission
equipment ≤
350 W

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 650


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for Cable Length


Configuration Requirement for the Input Power Requirement
Circuit Breakers Cable
on Customer
Equipment

● 0 to 3 high- 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


power RFUs 2), two groups of

● 0 to 2 BBUs DC input power


cables
● Power
consumption
of transmission
equipment ≤
350 W

● 0 to 3 low- 2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


power RFUs 2), one group of

● 0 to 2 BBUs DC input power


cables
● Power
consumption
of transmission
equipment ≤
350 W

● 4 to 6 high- 2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


power RFUs default) 2), two groups of

● 0 BBU DC input power


cables

● 0 to 3 high- 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


power RFUs 2), one group of

● 0 BBU DC input power


cables

● 4 to 6 low- 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


power RFUs 2), one group of

● 0 BBU DC input power


cables

● 0 to 3 low- 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


power RFUs 2), one group of

● 0 BBU DC input power


cables

DC Input Scenario Configured with RFUs and RRUs


When a base station uses -48 V DC power and is configured with RFUs and RRUs,
external power equipment supplies power to the DCDU-12A/DCDU-12B/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02, respectively.
● The DCDU-12A provides power for the RFUs and FAN 01D in the RFC. The
preceding table describes the power requirements of a DCDU-12A.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 651


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● The DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02 provides power


for RRUs. A DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02 is
configured as required. Table 1-293 lists the power requirements of a
DCDU-12B. Table 1-294 lists the power requirements of a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02. Table 1-295 lists the power requirements of an EPU02D/
EPU02D-02.

Table 1-293 Power requirements in DC input scenarios configured with RFUs and
RRUs
Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable
Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one ≤ 10 m


consumption per group of DC input power (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W)+3 cables (low smoke zero
RRUs (power halogen)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two
default) groups of DC input power
cables

9 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W)+3 cables
RRUs (power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 800 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 652


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Requirements for the Cable


Configuration(1) Requirement for Input Power Cable(3)(4) Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment(2)

2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


default) groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 560 W) cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), two


groups of DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 400 W) cables

6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 300 W) cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2), one


consumption per group of DC input power
RRU ≤ 650 W) cables

Table 1-294 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 10 m (32.81


(power one group of DC ft)
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 653


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 654


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-295 Power requirements of an EPU02D/EPU02D-02


Power Supply Minimum Cross-Sectional Area of Cable
Requirement for the Input Power Cable Length
Circuit Breakers Requirem
on Customer ent
Equipment

-48 V 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2), two ≤ 10 m


groups of DC input power (32.81 ft)
cables (low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 655


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w, RRU5903,
RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w, RRU5513t,
RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256, RRU3259,
RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m, RRU3959, RRU3959a,
RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953, RRU3953w,
RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962, RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972, AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are also
applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the circuit
breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are arranged based on
their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80 A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A,
and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 656


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the specifications
of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the full
configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do not meet
the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the circuit breakers
during base station capacity expansion.
● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the circuit
breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption need to be
added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.3.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900A


This section describes the power distribution schemes for a BTS5900A.

1.3.3.4.1 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900A Using the APM30H (Ver.E)
This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS5900A supplied with
110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power and using the APM30H (Ver.E).

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


If 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied, the AC power is converted to DC power
and distributed by the embedded power subrack unit (EPU05A) in an APM30H.
The EPU05A converts one AC power input into two AC power outputs:
● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.
The AC power input is converted by PSUs into DC power, which is supplied to the
battery cabinet, RFC, TMC11H, and other equipment.
Figure 1-330 and Figure 1-331 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-296 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 657


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-330 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H supplied with 220 V AC
single-phase power and configured with a PDU03D-02

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 658


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-331 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H supplied with 110 V AC
dual-live-wire power and configured with a PDU03D-02

Table 1-296 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H in an
AC-powered scenario
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 5x32 A/1 P Heater and SOU: ● RFC 1: 1x100 A


phase/three- (MCBa) 1x16 A (MCB) (MCB)
phase ● RFC 2: 1x100 A
(MCB)
● FAN: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● BBU_0: 1x30 A
(FUSEb)
● BBU_1: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMc: 4x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 659


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 5x32 A/1 P (MCB) Heater and SOU: ● TMCd: 1x30 A
live-wire 1x16 A (MCB) (FUSE)
● IBBSe: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RRU: 9x30 A
(FUSE)

a. MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b. FUSE: fuse
c. TM: transmission equipment
d. TMC: TMC11H
e. IBBS: fan in an IBBS200D/IBBS300D or TEC in an IBBS200T/IBBS300T

NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-332 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H supplied with 220 V AC
single-phase power and configured with a PDU03D-02

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 660


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-333 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H supplied with 110 V AC
dual-live-wire power and configured with a PDU03D-02

Table 1-297 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H in an
AC-powered scenario
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 5x32 A/1 P Heater and SOU: ● RFC 1: 1x100 A


phase/three- (MCBa) 1x16 A (MCB) (MCB)
phase ● RFC 2: 1x100 A
(MCB)
● FAN: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● BBU_0: 1x30 A
(FUSEb)
● BBU_1: 1x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 661


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 5x32 A/1 P (MCB) Heater and SOU: ● TMc: 4x30 A
live-wire 1x16 A (MCB) (FUSE)
● TMCd: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBSe: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RRU: 9x30 A
(FUSE)

a. MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b. FUSE: fuse
c. TM: transmission equipment
d. TMC: TMC11H
e. IBBS: fan in an IBBS200D/IBBS300D or TEC in an IBBS200T/IBBS300T

NOTE

The BBU is preferentially powered by the "LOAD0" and "LOAD1" ports on an EPU. If there is
a standby power board or a second BBU, the standby power board or second BBU obtains
power from "LOAD5" and "LOAD6" ports.

When the cabinet requires an EPU02D/EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, the


EPU05A must be configured with two PDU01D-01 modules, which get the DC
power from the EPU05A and distribute it to the EPU02D/EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02. The power distribution schemes are shown in Figure 1-334 and
Figure 1-335. The following table lists specifications of circuit breakers and fuses.
NOTE

The DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 and EPU02D/EPU02D-02 are connected in a similar way. The


following figure uses the EPU02D as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 662


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-334 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in 220 V AC single-phase
scenarios (configured with an EPU02D or EPU02D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 663


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-335 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H in 110 V AC dual-live-
wire scenarios (configured with an EPU02D or EPU02D-02)

Table 1-298 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H in an
AC-powered scenario
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 5x32 A/1 P Heater and SOU: ● RFC 1: 1x100 A


phase/three- (MCBa) 1x16 A (MCB) (MCB)
phase ● RFC 2: 1x100 A
(MCB)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 664


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 5x32 A/1 P (MCB) Heater and SOU: ● FAN: 1x30 A
live-wire 1x16 A (MCB) (FUSE)
● BBU_0: 1x30 A
(FUSEb)
● BBU_1: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMc: 4x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMCd: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBSe: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RRU (slot 7):
3x30 A (FUSE)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
8): 1x100 A
(MCB)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
9): 1x100 A
(MCB)

a. MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b. FUSE: fuse
c. TM: transmission equipment
d. TMC: TMC11H
e. IBBS: fan in an IBBS200D/IBBS300D or TEC in an IBBS200T/IBBS300T

The following figure shows power distribution scheme for an EPU02D/EPU02D-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 665


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-336 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02D/EPU02D-02

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


providing boosted-voltage and DC power outputs.

Table 1-299 Fuse specifications of an EPU02D or EPU02D-02


Power Fuse Terminal Specifications
Equipmen
t

EPU02D Slot 1 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) -57 V boosted-voltage power


Slot 2 (LOAD0 to LOAD2) output: 6x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU)

EPU02D-0 Slot 1 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) -57 V boosted-voltage power


2 Slot 2 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) output: 3x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(RRU)

The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 666


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-337 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02

The following table lists the circuit breaker or fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02 providing DC power outputs.

Table 1-300 Circuit breaker/fuse specifications of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02


Power Equipment Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse

DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 -48 V DC power output: 3x50 A (RRU) (MCB)

-48 V DC power output: 4x30 A


(BBU/FAN/TM) (FUSE)

If AC power is supplied to a BTS3900A, an APM30H distributes three DC outputs


to RFC 1, RFC 2, and a TMC11H, as shown in Figure 1-103 and Figure 1-104. The
DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other components in
an RFC. The DCDU-12B distributes power to the transmission equipment, fan
assembly, and other components in a TMC11H.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for an RFC and a
TMC11H. The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in an RFC and a
TMC11H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 667


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-338 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-
powered scenario

Table 1-301 Specifications of the fuses in the RFC and TMC11H in an AC-powered
scenario
Cabinet Type Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

RFC ● RFU 0 to RFU 5: 6x30 A (FUSE)


● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● Reserved: 3x30 A (FUSE)

TMC11H ● TM: 7x30 A (FUSE)


● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 668


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


If -48 V DC power is supplied, external power is directly supplied to an RFC. -48 V
DC power is directly supplied to the DC junction box in an RFC, which then
distributes the power to the DCDU-12A in an RFC and the DCDU-12C in a
TMC11H. A DCDU-12A distributes power to the RFUs, fan assembly, and other
components in an RFC. A DCDU-12C distributes power to the BBU, transmission
equipment, fan assembly, and other components in a TMC11H.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for an RFC and a
TMC11H. The specifications of the fuses in this scenario are the same as those in
AC scenarios, as listed in Table 1-77.

Figure 1-339 Power distribution scheme for the RFC and TMC11H supplied with
-48 V DC power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 669


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

The BBU is preferentially powered by the "LOAD6" and "LOAD7" ports on a DCDU. If there
is a standby power board or a second BBU, the standby power board or second BBU obtains
power from "LOAD4" and "LOAD5" ports.

1.3.3.4.2 Power Distribution Schemes for a BTS5900A Using the APM30H


(Ver.F_B~E)
This section describes power distribution schemes for a BTS5900A supplied with
110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power and using the APM30H (Ver.F_B~E).

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


If 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is supplied, the AC power is converted to DC power
and distributed by the embedded power subrack unit (EPU05A) in an APM30H.
The EPU05A converts one AC power input into two AC power outputs:
● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.
The AC power input is converted by PSUs into DC power, which is supplied to the
battery cabinet, RFC, TMC11H, and other equipment.
Figure 1-340 and Figure 1-341 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-302 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-340 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.F_B~E) in 220 V AC
single-phase scenarios

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 670


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-341 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.F_B~E) in 110 V AC
dual-live-wire scenarios

Table 1-302 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H
(Ver.F_B~E) in AC scenarios

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 5x32 A/1 P (MCB) Heater and SOU: ● RRU: 6x30 A
phase/three- 1x16 A (MCB) (FUSE)
phase (LOAD12 to
LOAD14)
● RRU (power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 800
W): 9x30 A
(FUSE) (2
PDU06D-01s)
● RRU (800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤
1200 W): 6x30
A (FUSE) (2
EPU02D-02s)
● BBU: 6x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 671


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 5x32 A/1 P (MCB) Heater and SOU: ● FAN: 1x30 A
live-wire 1x16 A (MCB) (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TM/EMUB:
1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/TMC: 2x30
A (FUSE)
● BBC: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RFC: 2x125 A
(MCB)
(PDU01D-02)

1.3.3.5 Cables and Cable Connections in a BTS5900A


This section lists the reference sections in 5900 Series Base Station Cables for
cables and cable connections in a BTS5900A.

Cable List
For cables in a BTS5900A, see BTS5900A Cable List.

Cable Connections
For cable connections for a BTS5900A, see topics related to Cable Connections in
5900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the reference links.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 672


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-303 Cable connections


Base Power Monitori Transmis BBU CPRI RF Cable
Statio Cable ng Signal sion Intercon Cable Connecti
n Connecti Cable Cable nection Connecti ons
ons Connecti Connecti Signal ons
ons ons Cable
Connecti
ons

BTS59 BTS5900A BTS5900A Transmiss BBU CPRI RF Cable


00A Power Monitorin ion Cable Interconn Cable Connectio
Cable g Signal Connectio ection Connectio ns
Connectio Cable ns for Signal ns for
ns Connectio 5900 Cable 5900
ns Series Connectio Series
Base ns Base
Stations Stations

1.3.4 DBS5900
A DBS5900 is a distributed base station. This section describes types of cabinets
and racks used by a DBS5900, deployment modes, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, and cable connections in different scenarios, to help users
plan and deploy a DBS5900.

1.3.4.1 Cabinets and Racks Used by a DBS5900


A DBS5900 is composed of cabinets and racks with different functions, meeting
requirements for power distribution, module configuration, and space for
customer equipment.

Cabinets and Racks


The following table lists cabinets and racks used by a DBS5900.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 673


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-304 Cabinets and racks used by a DBS5900


Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/ Cabinet/
Rack Name Description Rack Rack
Type Configurat Exterior
ion

APM595 ● APM5950H ● In AC scenarios For details, See


0Ha (Ver.A), where the external see Exterior of
series which is power supply is AC Configurati an
cabinets shortened power, an ons of the APM5950
to APM5950H (Ver.A) APM5950H H/
APM5950H cabinet supplies and APM5900
● APM5900H power to the BBUs, APM5900H. H.
(Ver.A), RRUs, and other
which is components, as well
shortened as other cabinets.
to ● In DC scenarios
APM5900H where the external
power supply is DC
power, an
APM5900H (Ver.A)
cabinet can be used
as a power cabinet
to supply power to
the BBUs or RRUs.
Alternatively, this
cabinet can be used
as a transmission
cabinet to provide
space for
transmission
equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 674


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/ Cabinet/


Rack Name Description Rack Rack
Type Configurat Exterior
ion

APM595 ● APM5950H- ● In AC scenarios, an For details, For details,


0H-L L (Ver.A), APM5950H-L (Ver.A) see see Figure
series which is supplies power to Configurati 1-343.
cabinets shortened the BBUs, RRUs, and ons of the
to other components, APM5950H
APM5950H- as well as other -L and
L cabinets. APM5900H
● APM5900H- ● In DC scenarios, an -L.
L (Ver.A), APM5900H-L (Ver.A)
which is can be used as a
shortened power cabinet to
to supply power to the
APM5900H- BBUs or RRUs.
L Alternatively, this
cabinet can be used
as a transmission
cabinet to provide
space for
transmission
equipment.

APM593 ● APM5930(A ● In AC scenarios, an For details, For details,


0 series C) (Ver.A), APM5930(AC) see see Figure
cabinets which is (Ver.A) supplies Component 1-344.
shortened power to the BBUs, s in
to RRUs, and other APM5930s.
APM5930(A components, as well
C) as other cabinets.
● APM5930(D ● In DC scenarios, an
C) (Ver.A), APM5930(DC)
which is (Ver.A) can be used
shortened as a power cabinet
to to supply power to
APM5930(D the BBUs or RRUs.
C) Alternatively, this
cabinet can be used
as a transmission
cabinet to provide
space for
transmission
equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 675


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/ Cabinet/


Rack Name Description Rack Rack
Type Configurat Exterior
ion

BBCb ● BBC5200D The BBC series cabinets For details, For details,
series ● BBC5200T are battery cabinets see: see:
cabinets and are used together ● Compon ● Figure
● BBC5300D with APM5950H-L/ ents in a 1-347
● BBC5300T APM5950H/APM5930/ BBC5200
APM30H series ● Figure
● BBC5200D- D 1-348
L cabinets to supply
backup power for sites. ● Compon ● Figure
● BBC5600D ents in a 1-349
● BBC5600D- BBC5200
T ● Figure
V 1-350
● BBC5600A ● Compon
ents in a ● Figure
● BBC5600A- BBC5300 1-347
V D ● Figure
● Compon 1-345
ents in a ● Figure
BBC5300 1-346
T
● Compon
ents in a
BBC5200
D-L
● Compon
ents in a
BBC5600
D
● Compon
ents in a
BBC5600
D-V
● Configur
ations of
a
BBC5600
A
● BBC5600
A-V
Hardwar
e
Descripti
on

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 676


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/ Cabinet/


Rack Name Description Rack Rack
Type Configurat Exterior
ion

IBC10c ● IBC10 An IBC10 (Ver.B) is an For details, For details,


(Ver.B) indoor 19-inch cabinet see see Figure
that receives DC power Component 1-351.
and transfers power to s in an
its components. The IBC10.
cabinet can house a
maximum of 10 BBUs
installed in centralized
mode.

ILC29d ILC29 (Ver.E) An ILC29 is an indoor For details, For details,


cabinet used in an see see Figure
indoor distributed base Component 1-352.
station. The cabinet of s in an
this type can be ILC29.
supplied with DC power
and provides DC power
for the BBU, fan
assembly, RRU, and
other modules.

IMB05e IMB05 An IMB05 is a mini For details, For details,


subrack used in an see see Figure
indoor distributed base Component 1-353.
station to provide AC or s in an
DC power. IMB05.

19-inch ● INS05 ● The INS05 subrack is For details, For details,


rack or ● INS12f a 19-inch device see: see:
subrack that can be installed ● INS05 ● Figure
● 19-inch in a non-Huawei 19-
rack Hardwar 1-354
inch cabinet or open e
provided by rack. A single INS05 ● Figure
an operator Descripti 1-355
supports centralized on
installation of five
BBUs. ● Compon
ents of
● The INS12 is an an
indoor medium- INS12
capacity rack that
provides 12 U space
for 19-inch
equipment.

IFS06g IFS06 An IFS06 is an indoor For details, For details,


floor installation see see
support and used for Component Exterior of
installing the IMB05 s of an an IFS06.
and RRUs. IFS06.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 677


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/ Cabinet/


Rack Name Description Rack Rack
Type Configurat Exterior
ion

IFS5906 IFS5906 An IFS5906 is an indoor For details, For details,


floor installation see IFS5906 see
support and used for Hardware IFS5906
stacking the IMS5906 Description. Hardware
and RRUs. Description
.

IMS5906 IMS5906 The IMS5906 is an For details, For details,


indoor mini subrack see see
used in a DBS5900 to IMS5906 IMS5906
support installation of Hardware Hardware
the BBU and DC Description. Description
distribution equipment. .

APM30H APM30H The APM30H provides For details, For details,


series (Ver.E) power for components see see
cabinets in it and to other Component Exteriors of
cabinets in AC s in APM30Hs.
scenarios. APM30Hs.

TMC11H TMC11H The TMC11H can serve For details, For details,
h series (Ver.E) as a power cabinet in see see
cabinets DC scenarios or as a Component Exteriors of
transmission cabinet s in TMC11Hs.
based on the TMC11Hs.
transmission space
requirement.

IBBSi ● IBBS200D The IBBS series cabinets For details, For details,
series (Ver.C) or are battery cabinets see: see:
cabinets IBBS200T and are used together ● Compon ● Exterior
(Ver.C) with APM30H series ents in s of
● IBBS200D cabinets to provide IBBS200 IBBS200
(Ver.D) or backup power for sites. Ds and Ds and
IBBS200T Compon Exterior
(Ver.D) ents in s of
● IBBS200D IBBS200 IBBS200
(Ver.E) or Ts Ts
IBBS200T ● Compon ● Exterior
(Ver.E) ents in of an
● IBBS300D IBBS300 IBBS300
(Ver.A) or Ds and D and
IBBS300T Compon Exterior
(Ver.A) ents in of an
IBBS300 IBBS300
Ts T

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 678


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet/ Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/Rack Cabinet/ Cabinet/


Rack Name Description Rack Rack
Type Configurat Exterior
ion

a: APM: advanced power module


b. BBC: battery backup cabinet
c. IBC10: indoor BBU cabinet
d. ILC29: indoor large cabinet
e. IMB05: indoor mini box
f. INS12: indoor normal support
g. IFS06: indoor floor installation support
h. TMC11H: transmission cabinet with heat exchanger
i. IBBS200T/IBBS300T: integrated backup battery system with TEC; IBBS200D/
IBBS300D: integrated backup battery system with direct ventilation

Some cabinets of earlier versions can be restructured to have the same capabilities
as Ver.F cabinets of the same series and be used in a DBS5900. The following table
describes the source cabinet, application scenarios and configurations of the
reused cabinets, as well as other information.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 679


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-305 Reused cabinets


Cabin Applicatio Cabinet Power Power Engineeri
et n Scenario Description Requirement Distributio ng
Nam and n Scheme Specificati
e Cabinet ons
Configurat
ion

APM3 See the Restructured The power The power The input
0H following from the requirements distribution power
(Ver.F path: 3900 APM30H of a DBS5900 scheme for specificati
_B~E) & 5900 (Ver.D), using an a DBS5900 ons,
Series APM30H APM30H using an equipment
Base (Ver.B), (Ver.F_B~E) APM30H specificati
Station APM30H are the same (Ver.F_B~E) ons, and
Product (Ver.C), or as those of a is the same environme
Document APM30H DBS5900 as that for a ntal
ation (Ver.E) using an DBS5900 specificati
(Hardware APM5930(AC). using an ons of a
Installatio For details, APM5930(A DBS5900
n) > see 1.3.4.3.5 C). For using an
Installatio Power details, see APM30H
n and Requirements 1.3.4.4.5 (Ver.F_B~E
Commissio of a DBS5900 Power ) is the
ning > Using the Distributio same as
Base APM5930(AC n Scheme those of a
Station ). for a DBS5900
Installatio DBS5900 using an
n Guide > Using the APM5930(
Installatio APM5930(A AC). For
n Guide C). details, see
for APM5930
Enhancing Hardware
Existing Descriptio
Cabinets > n.
DBS3900
Installatio
n Guide
for
Enhancing
Existing
Cabinets
(Ver.F
Series).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 680


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabin Applicatio Cabinet Power Power Engineeri


et n Scenario Description Requirement Distributio ng
Nam and n Scheme Specificati
e Cabinet ons
Configurat
ion

TMC1 See the Restructured The power The power The input
1H following from the requirements distribution power
(Ver.F path: 3900 TMC11H of a DBS5900 scheme for specificati
_B~E) & 5900 (Ver.D), using a a DBS5900 ons,
Series TMC11H TMC11H using a equipment
Base (Ver.B), (Ver.F_B~E) TMC11H specificati
Station TMC11H are the same (Ver.F_B~E) ons, and
Product (Ver.C), or as those of a is the same environme
Document TMC11H DBS5900 as that for a ntal
ation (Ver.E) using an DBS5900 specificati
(Hardware APM5930(DC) using an ons of a
Installatio . For details, APM5930(D DBS5900
n) > see 1.3.4.3.6 C). For using a
Installatio Power details, see TMC11H
n and Requirements 1.3.4.4.6 (Ver.F_B~E
Commissio of a DBS5900 Power ) is the
ning > Using the Distributio same as
Base APM5930(DC n Scheme those of a
Station ). for a DBS5900
Installatio DBS5900 using an
n Guide > Using the APM5930(
Installatio APM5930(D DC). For
n Guide C). details, see
for APM5930
Enhancing Hardware
Existing Descriptio
Cabinets > n.
DBS3900
Installatio
n Guide
for
Enhancing
Existing
Cabinets
(Ver.F
Series).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 681


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabin Applicatio Cabinet Power Power Engineeri


et n Scenario Description Requirement Distributio ng
Nam and n Scheme Specificati
e Cabinet ons
Configurat
ion

IBBS2 See the Restructured - - The input


00D following from the power
(Ver.F path: 3900 IBBS200D specificati
_B~E) & 5900 (Ver.B), ons,
or Series IBBS200T equipment
IBBS2 Base (Ver.B), specificati
00T Station IBBS200D ons, and
(Ver.F Product (Ver.C), environme
_B~E) Document IBBS200T ntal
ation (Ver.C), specificati
(Hardware IBBS200D ons of a
Installatio (Ver.D), DBS5900
n) > IBBS200T using an
Installatio (Ver.D), IBBS200D
n and IBBS200D (Ver.F_B~E
Commissio (Ver.E), or ) or
ning > IBBS200T IBBS200T
Base (Ver.E) (Ver.F_B~E
Station ) are the
Installatio same as
n Guide > those of a
Installatio DBS5900
n Guide using a
for BBC5200D
Enhancing or
Existing BBC5200T.
Cabinets > For details,
DBS3900 see
Installatio BBC5200D
n Guide Hardware
for Descriptio
Enhancing n and
Existing BBC5200T
Cabinets Hardware
(Ver.F Descriptio
Series). n.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 682


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabin Applicatio Cabinet Power Power Engineeri


et n Scenario Description Requirement Distributio ng
Nam and n Scheme Specificati
e Cabinet ons
Configurat
ion

IBBS2 See the Restructured - - The input


00D-L following from the power
(Ver.F path: 3900 IBBS200D specificati
_D~E) & 5900 (Ver.D) or ons,
Series IBBS200D equipment
Base (Ver.E) specificati
Station ons, and
Product environme
Document ntal
ation specificati
(Hardware ons of a
Installatio DBS5900
n) > using an
Installatio IBBS200D-
n and L
Commissio (Ver.F_D~E
ning > ) are the
Base same as
Station those of a
Installatio DBS5900
n Guide > using a
IBBS BBC5200D
Installatio -L. For
n Guide details, see
for BBC5200D
Reconstru -L
cting Hardware
Existing Descriptio
Cabinets n.
to Use
Lithium
Batteries.

APM5950H/APM5900H
The following figure shows the exterior of an APM5950H or an APM5900H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 683


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-342 Exterior of an APM5950H/APM5900H

APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L
The following figure shows the exterior of an APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 684


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-343 Exterior of an APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L

APM5930
The following figure shows the exterior of an APM5930(AC) or an APM5930(DC).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 685


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-344 Exterior of an APM5930

BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V
The following figure shows the exterior of a BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V.

Figure 1-345 Exterior of a BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 686


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V

Figure 1-346 Exterior of a BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V

BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5200D-L
The following figures show the exteriors of a BBC5200D/BBC5200D-L/BBC5200T.

Figure 1-347 Exterior of a BBC5200D/BBC5200D-L

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 687


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-348 Exterior of a BBC5200T

BBC5300D/BBC5300T
The following figures show the exteriors of a BBC5300D and a BBC5300T.

Figure 1-349 Exterior of a BBC5300D

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 688


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-350 Exterior of a BBC5300T

IBC10 (Ver.B)
The following figure shows the exterior of an IBC10 (Ver.B).

Figure 1-351 Exterior of an IBC10 (Ver.B)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 689


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

ILC29 (Ver.E)
The following figure shows the exterior of an ILC29 (Ver.E).

Figure 1-352 Exterior of an ILC29 (Ver.E)

IMB05
The following figure shows the exterior of an IMB05.

Figure 1-353 Exterior of an IMB05

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 690


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

INS05
The following figure shows the exterior of an INS05.

Figure 1-354 Exterior of an INS05

INS12
The following figure shows the exterior of an INS12.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 691


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-355 Exterior of an INS12

APM30H/TMC11H
The following figure shows the exteriors of APM30H and TMC11H series cabinets.

Figure 1-356 Exteriors of APM30Hs and TMC11Hs

IBBS200D/IBBS200T
The following figure shows the exteriors of IBBS200Ds and IBBS200Ts.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 692


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-357 Exteriors of IBBS200Ds and IBBS200Ts

IBBS300D/IBBS300T
The following figure shows the exteriors of an IBBS300D (Ver.A) and an IBBS300T
(Ver.A). IBBS300D (Ver.A) is shortened to IBBS300D and IBBS300T (Ver.A) is
shortened to IBBS300T in this section.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 693


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-358 Exteriors of an IBBS300D and an IBBS300T

1.3.4.2 Application Scenarios of a DBS5900


The DBS5900 base station can be used in following scenarios: outdoor AC
scenarios, outdoor DC scenarios, indoor AC scenarios, and indoor DC scenarios,
differentiating in the application environment (indoor or outdoor) and external
power supply (110 V/220 V AC or -48 V DC). The DBS5900 supports different
cabinets/racks and deployment modes in different application scenarios.

1.3.4.2.1 Outdoor AC Scenarios


When a DBS5900 is deployed outdoors and supplied with AC power, the DBS5900
deployment mode varies depending on the cabinet combinations and BBU
installation scenarios.
The following table describes the BBU installation scenarios, cabinet combination
principles, and deployment modes.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 694


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-306 BBU installation scenarios and cabinet combination principles


BBU Scenario Description Cabinet Base Station
Installation Combination Deployment Mode
Scenario Principle

APM5950H/ BBU 0 is installed in an Combination BBU Installed in an


APM5900H APM5950H, BBU 1 is Principles of APM5950H/
installed in an APM5950H APM5900H
APM5950H or Series
APM5900H, and RRUs Cabinets
are installed remotely.
The APM5950H supplies
power to the BBUs and
RRUs.

APM5950H- BBU 0 is installed in an Combination BBU Installed in an


L/ APM5950H-L, BBU 1 is Principles of APM5950H-L/
APM5900H- installed in an APM5950H-L APM5900H-L
L APM5950H-L or Series
APM5900H-L, and RRUs Cabinets
are installed remotely.
The APM5950H-L
supplies power to the
BBUs and RRUs.

APM5930(A BBU 0 is installed in an Combination BBU Installed in an


C)/ APM5930(AC), BBU 1 is Principles of APM5930(AC)/
APM5930(D installed in an APM5930 APM5930(DC)
C) APM5930(AC) or Series
APM5930(DC), and Cabinets
RRUs are installed
remotely. The
APM5930(AC) supplies
power to the BBUs and
RRUs.

APM30H BBU 0 is installed in an Combination BBU Installed in an


(Ver.E)/ APM30H (Ver.E), BBU 1 Principles of APM30H (Ver.E)/
TMC11H is installed in an APM30H TMC11H (Ver.E)
(Ver.E) APM30H (Ver.E)/ Series
TMC11H (Ver.E), and Cabinets
RRUs are installed
remotely. The APM30H
(Ver.E)/TMC11H (Ver.E)
supplies power to the
BBUs, and the APM30H
(Ver.E) supplies power to
the RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 695


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

For details about BBU installation in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base
station, see Configuration Principles of BBUs in Applicable Cabinets.

Configuration Principles of BBUs in Applicable Cabinets


● The DBS5900 can be a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode base station.
A single- or dual-mode base station can be configured with only one BBU,
and a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with one or two
BBUs.
● When a single- or dual-mode base station is configured with only one BBU,
the BBU is installed in the basic cabinet.
● When a triple- or quadruple-mode base station is configured with one BBU,
the BBU is installed in the basic cabinet.
● When a triple-or quadruple-mode base station is configured with two BBUs,
there are two scenarios: initial deployment and capacity expansion.
– If two BBUs are configured during initial deployment, both the BBUs are
installed in an APM30H/APM5930(AC)/APM5950H/APM5950H-L, and
transmission equipment is installed in a TMC11H/APM5930(DC)/
APM5900H/APM5900H-L.
– If there is space for a second BBU in the APM30H/APM5930(AC)/
APM5950H/APM5950H-L during capacity expansion, the BBU is
preferentially installed in the APM30H/APM5930(AC)/APM5950H/
APM5950H-L. Otherwise, the BBU is installed in a TMC11H/
APM5930(DC)/APM5900H/APM5900H-L.
NOTE

The following figures use a base station configured with two BBUs as an example.

Combination Principles of APM5950H Series Cabinets


The following table lists the combination principles of APM5950H series cabinets.

Table 1-307 Combination principles of APM5950H series cabinets

Category Principle

Supported ● The BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V/


cabinets BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T cabinets can be used
to provide backup power for the APM5950H.
● Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration of 1 BBC5600D/
BBC5600A and 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T or 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V and 1 BBC5200D-L can
be used to provide backup power for the APM5950H.
● When an APM5950H supplies power to an APM5930/APM30H
(Ver.E)/APM30H (Ver.D) battery cabinet, the power distribution
capability of the APM5950H is the same as that of the
APM5930/APM30H (Ver.E)/APM30H (Ver.D) battery cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 696


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Category Principle

Stacked ● An APM5950H can be combined with only one APM5900H.


and ● The power cabinet and battery cabinet can be stacked only on a
combined 1:1 ratio (the power cabinet is stacked above the battery
cabinets cabinet).
● BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V cabinets can be
stacked only with APM5950H/APM5950H-L series cabinets.
● In initial deployment scenarios, the auxiliary cabinet such as the
battery cabinet or transmission cabinet, if required, is positioned
on the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment. In
capacity expansion scenarios, unless otherwise specified, the
original cabinets remain in the original positions and new
cabinets are added to the right side of the original cabinets. In
special scenarios, new cabinets can be added to the left side of
the original cabinets.
● If both a battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are
configured, the battery cabinet is preferentially positioned on
the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment, and the
transmission cabinet is stacked on the battery cabinet or
positioned on the left side of the battery cabinet.
● An APM5950H can only be installed side by side with an
BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T and cannot be stacked.

Combination Principles of APM5950H-L Series Cabinets


The following table lists the combination principles of APM5950H-L series
cabinets.

Table 1-308 Combination principles of APM5950H-L series cabinets


Category Principle

Supported ● The BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V/


cabinets BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T cabinets can be used
to provide backup power for the APM5950H-L.
● Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration of 1 BBC5600D/
BBC5600A and 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T or 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V and 1 BBC5200D-L can
be used to provide backup power for the APM5950H-L.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 697


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Category Principle

Stacked ● One APM5950H-L can be installed side by side with only one
and APM5900H-L. The cabinet can be stacked with a maximum of
combined two BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V cabinets.
cabinets (The power cabinet and battery cabinet are stacked on a 1:1
ratio.)
● The BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V/BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V can be
stacked only with APM5950H/APM5950H-L series cabinets.
● In initial deployment scenarios, the auxiliary cabinet such as the
battery cabinet or transmission cabinet, if required, is positioned
on the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment. In
capacity expansion scenarios, unless otherwise specified, the
original cabinets remain in the original positions and new
cabinets are added to the right side of the original cabinets. In
special scenarios, new cabinets can be added to the left side of
the original cabinets.
● If both a battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are
configured, the battery cabinet is preferentially positioned on
the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment, and the
transmission cabinet is stacked on the battery cabinet or
positioned on the left side of the battery cabinet.
● APM5950H-L series cabinets cannot be installed on the base of
an APM5930/APM30H (Ver.E)/APM30H (Ver.D).

Combination Principles of APM5930 Series Cabinets


The following table lists the combination principles of APM5930 series cabinets.

Table 1-309 Combination principles of APM5930 series cabinets


Configura Configuration Principle
tion Item

Supported ● If an APM5930(AC) supplies power to a Ver.D or Ver.E series


cabinets battery cabinet, the power distribution capability of the
APM5930(AC) is the same as that of an APM30H (Ver.D) or
APM30H (Ver.E).
● If an APM5930 series cabinet is installed on a Ver.D base, the
cabling capability at the bottom of the cabinet is the same as
that of a Ver.D cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 698


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Configura Configuration Principle


tion Item

Stacked ● An APM5930(AC) can be installed side by side with only 1


and APM5930(DC) or stacked on a maximum of 2 BBC5200D/
combined BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L cabinets. (A
cabinets BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L
cabinet can be stacked on another cabinet of the same type.)
● An APM5930(AC) or APM5930(DC) can be installed on the
ground or stacked on a BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/
BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L cabinet.
● In initial deployment scenarios, the auxiliary cabinet such as the
battery cabinet or transmission cabinet, if required, is positioned
on the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment. In
capacity expansion scenarios, unless otherwise specified, the
original cabinets remain in the original positions and new
cabinets are added to the right side of the original cabinets. In
special scenarios, new cabinets can be added to the left side of
the original cabinets.
● If both a battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are
configured, the battery cabinet is preferentially positioned on
the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment, and the
transmission cabinet is stacked on the battery cabinet or
positioned on the left side of the battery cabinet.
● When APM5930(AC)/APM30H (Ver.E)/APM30H (Ver.D) cabinets
are used with BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V
cabinets, the cabinets can only be installed side by side and
cannot be stacked.

Combination Principles of APM30H Series Cabinets


The following table lists the combination principles of APM30H series cabinets.

Table 1-310 Combination principles of APM30H series cabinets


Configura Configuration Principle
tion Item

Supported ● The APM30H (Ver.E) can be used with Ver.D cabinets, to power
cabinets a maximum of 15 RRUs.
● If an APM30H (Ver.E) supplies power to a Ver.D series battery
cabinet, the power distribution capability of the APM30H (Ver.E)
is the same as that of an APM30H (Ver.D).
● If a Ver.E cabinet is installed on a Ver.D base, the cabling
capability at the bottom of the Ver.E cabinet is the same as that
of a Ver.D cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 699


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Configura Configuration Principle


tion Item

Stacked ● In initial deployment scenarios, the auxiliary cabinet such as the


and battery cabinet or transmission cabinet, if required, is positioned
combined on the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment. In
cabinets capacity expansion scenarios, unless otherwise specified, the
original cabinets remain in the original positions and new
cabinets are added to the right side of the original cabinets. In
special scenarios, new cabinets can be added to the left side of
the original cabinets.
● An APM30H can be installed side by side with only 1 TMC11H
or stacked on a maximum of 2 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T/BBC5200D-L cabinets. (An IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T/BBC5200D-L cabinet can be stacked on
another cabinet of the same type.)
● An APM30H/TMC11H can be installed on the ground or stacked
on an IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T/BBC5200D-L
cabinet.
● If both a battery cabinet and a transmission cabinet are
configured, the battery cabinet is preferentially positioned on
the left side of the cabinet housing main equipment, and the
transmission cabinet is stacked on the battery cabinet or
positioned on the left side of the battery cabinet.
● When APM5930(AC)/APM30H (Ver.E)/APM30H (Ver.D) cabinets
are used with BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V cabinets, the cabinets can
only be installed side by side and cannot be stacked.

BBU Installed in an APM5950H/APM5900H


An APM5950H that is installed side by side with or stacked with BBC series
cabinets can supply power to a maximum of 27 RRUs. The following table
describes the mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-311 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs LOAD12 to LOAD17 -


(power consumption per ports on the
RRU ≤ 800 W) EPU07A-01/02

Seventh to twenty- 4 PDU06D-01 modulesa One PDU06D-01 can


seventh RRUs (power supply power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 700


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

Seventh to twenty- ● 2 PDU06D-01 ● One PDU06D-01 can


seventh RRUs modules: 12 RRUs supply power to 6
● 12 RRUs (power (power consumption RRUs.
consumption per RRU per RRU ≤ 800 W) ● One PDU03D-03 can
≤ 800 W) ● 3 PDU03D-03 supply power to 3
● 9 RRUs (800 W < modulesa: 9 RRUs RRUs.
power consumption (800 W < power
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) consumption per RRU
≤ 1400 W)

a: The PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03 is configured in the EPU07A-01/02.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations given different backup power
requirements, requirements on space for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-312 Cabinet configurations

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Combination


Supply p Customer Configurat
Power Equipment ion
Requir
ement

110 V No Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H


AC or backup 7U
220 V power Two BBUs: ≤
AC 4U

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H


21 U
Two BBUs: ≤
18 U

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 BBC5600D/


50Hs 7U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
and Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC 4U BBC5200T/BBC5300D/
series BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/
cabinet IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
s IBBS300D/IBBS300Ta
initially
configu Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H+1
red on 21 U BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
a 1:1 Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V/
ratio 18 U BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
BBC5200D-L/IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 701


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Combination


Supply p Customer Configurat
Power Equipment ion
Requir
ement

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+2 BBC5600Ds/


50Hs 7U BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
and Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/
BBC 4U BBC5200Ts/BBC5300Ds/
series BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/
cabinet IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
s IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
initially
configu Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H+2
red on 21 U BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
a 1:2 Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/
ratio 18 U BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 BBC5600D-V/


7U BBC5600A-V+1 BBC5600Db/
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5600A
4U

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5950H+1 APM5900H+1


21 U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V/
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
18 U BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T+1
BBC5600D/BBC5600A/
BBC5200D-L

a: When the APM5950H series cabinets are used with the BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/IBBS300T, the carrier
configuration capability depends on the circuit breaker capability of the old
battery cabinet. When the APM5950H series cabinets are used with the
BBC5200D-L, the carrier configuration capability depends on the backup power
capability of the old battery cabinet.
b: In lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration scenarios, it is recommended
that the discharge power of the lithium batteries be greater than the total
power of the entire base station. This prevents the lithium battery protection
due to insufficient power supply capacity of lead-acid batteries in the later
period of the discharge which causes the entire base station to be powered off.

When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 702


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-359 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 703


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950Hs and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the BBC5600D as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 704


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-360 Configurations of cabinets when APM5950Hs and BBC/IBBS series


cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 705


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 706


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950Hs and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the single-or dual-mode base
station and BBC5600D as an example.
NOTE

Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration of 1 BBC5600D/BBC5600A and 1 BBC5600D-V/


BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T or 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V and 1 BBC5200D-L can be used to provide backup
power for the APM5950H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 707


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-361 APM5950Hs and BBC/IBBS series cabinets initially configured on a


1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 708


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 709


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM5950H-L/APM5900H-L


An APM5950H-L that is installed side by side with or stacked with BBC series
cabinets can supply power to a maximum of 15 RRUs. The following table
describes the mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-313 RRU power distribution scheme

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs LOAD8 to LOAD13 ports -


(power consumption per on the EPU04A-01/02
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to fifteenth 2 PDU06D-01 modulesa One PDU06D-01 can


RRUs (power supply power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

Seventh to fifteenth 3 PDU03D-03 modulesa One PDU03D-03 can


RRUs (800 W < power supply power to 3 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
1400 W)

a: The PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03 is configured in the EPU04A-01/02.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations given different backup power
requirements, requirements on space for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-314 Cabinet configurations

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

110 V No Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L


AC or backup 7U
220 V power
AC Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1
21 U APM5900H-L

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


50H-Ls 7U BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
and BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V/
BBC BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
series BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
cabinet BBC5200D-L/IBBS200D/
s IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
initially IBBS300T
configu

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 710


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

red on Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


a 1:1 21 U APM5900H-L+1 BBC5600D/
ratio BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC5200T/BBC5300D/
BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/
IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
IBBS300D/IBBS300T

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+2


50H-Ls 7U BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
and BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/
BBC BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
series BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
cabinet BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/
s IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
initially IBBS300Ts
configu
red on Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1
a 1:2 21 U APM5900H-L+2
ratio BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/
BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS300Ts

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


7U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V+1
BBC5600D/BBC5600Aa

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5950H-L+1


21 U APM5900H-L+1 BBC5600D-
V/BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/
BBC5200T/BBC5300D/
BBC5300T/IBBS200D/
IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T+1 BBC5600D/
BBC5600A/BBC5200D-L

a: In lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration scenarios, it is recommended


that the discharge power of the lithium batteries be greater than the total
power of the entire base station. This prevents the lithium battery protection
due to insufficient power supply capacity of lead-acid batteries in the later
period of the discharge which causes the entire base station to be powered off.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 711


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-362 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 712


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-363 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950H-Ls and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the BBC5600A as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 713


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-364 Configurations of cabinets when APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series


cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 714


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-365 Configurations of cabinets when APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series


cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 715


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5950H-Ls and


BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs/BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/BBC5200D-Ls/IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts
are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different
requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are
shown in the following figures. These figures use the single-or dual-mode base
station and BBC5600A as an example.
NOTE

Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration of 1 BBC5600D/BBC5600A and 1 BBC5600D-V/


BBC5600A-V/BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/IBBS200D/IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS300T or 1 BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V and 1 BBC5200D-L can be used to provide backup
power for the APM5950H-L.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 716


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-366 APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series cabinets initially configured on a


1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 717


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-367 APM5950H-Ls and BBC/IBBS series cabinets initially configured on a


1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 718


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM5930(AC)/APM5930(DC)


An APM5930(AC) that is installed side by side with or stacked with BBC series
cabinets can supply power to a maximum of 21 RRUs. The following table
describes the mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-315 RRU power distribution scheme

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs LOAD12 to LOAD17 -


(power consumption per ports on the
RRU ≤ 800 W) EPU05A-11/12

Seventh to twenty-first 3 PDU06D-01 modules One PDU06D-01 can


RRUs (power supply power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

Seventh to twenty-first ● 2 PDU06D-01 ● One PDU06D-01 can


RRUs modules: 9 RRUs supply power to 6
● 9 RRUs (power (power consumption RRUs.
consumption per RRU per RRU ≤ 800 W) ● One EPU02D-02/
≤ 800 W) ● 2 EPU02D-02/ DCDU16D/
● 6 RRUs (800 W < DCDU16D/ PDU03D-03/
power consumption PDU03D-03/ BDU70-03 can supply
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) BDU70-03 modules/3 power to 3 RRUs. One
SDU60-02 modulesa: SDU60-02 can supply
6 RRUs (800 W < power to 2 RRUs. The
power consumption EPU02D-02 is used as
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) an example in figures.

a: The BDU70-03 and SDU60-02 are configured in the EPU05A subrack.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations given different backup power
requirements, requirements on space for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-316 Cabinet configurations

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

110 V No Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)


AC or backup 5U
220 V power Two BBUs: ≤
AC 3U

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 719


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


16 U APM5930(DC)
Two BBUs: ≤
14 U

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


30(AC) 5U BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
cabinet Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
s and 3U BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/
BBC BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
series BBC5600A-V
cabinet
s Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1
initially 16 U APM5930(DC)+1
configu Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
red on 14 U BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
a 1:1 BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/
ratio BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
BBC5600A-V

APM59 Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+2


30(AC) 5U BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
cabinet Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
s and 3U BBC5200D-Ls/BBC5600Ds/
BBC BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
series BBC5600A-Vs
cabinet
s Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1
initially 16 U APM5930(DC)+2
configu Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200Ds/BBC5200Ts/
red on 14 U BBC5300Ds/BBC5300Ts/
a 1:2 BBC5200D-Ls/BBC5600Ds/
ratio BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
BBC5600A-Vs

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


5U BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
3U BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V+1
BBC5200D-L/BBC5600Da/
BBC5600A

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 720


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backu Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply p Customer Configuratio
Power Equipment n
Requir
ement

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(AC)+1


16 U APM5930(DC)+1
Two BBUs: ≤ BBC5200D/BBC5200T/
14 U BBC5300D/BBC5300T/
BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A-V+1
BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/
BBC5600A

a: In lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration scenarios, it is recommended


that the discharge power of the lithium batteries be greater than the total
power of the entire base station. This prevents the lithium battery protection
due to insufficient power supply capacity of lead-acid batteries in the later
period of the discharge which causes the entire base station to be powered off.

When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 721


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-368 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 722


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5930(AC) cabinets and
BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio, the
cabinet configurations given different requirements on space for customer
equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 723


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-369 Configurations of cabinets when APM5930(AC) cabinets and BBC


series cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 724


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When backup power is required in a base station and APM5930(AC) cabinets and
BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/BBC5300T/BBC5200D-L/BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V cabinets are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet
configurations given different requirements on space for customer equipment and

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 725


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

carrier configurations are shown in the following figures. These figures use a
single- or dual-mode base station as an example.
NOTE

● Lead-acid and lithium mixed configuration 1 BBC5200D/BBC5200T/BBC5300D/


BBC5300T and 1 BBC5200D-L is supported to provide backup power for the
APM5930(AC) cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 726


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-370 APM5930(AC) cabinets and BBC series cabinets initially configured
on a 1:2 ratio

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 727


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 728


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an APM30H (Ver.E)/TMC11H (Ver.E)


An APM30H that is installed side by side with or stacked with a Ver.E cabinet can
supply power to a maximum of 21 RRUs. The following table describes the
mapping between the number of RRUs and power equipment.

Table 1-317 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth LOAD9 to LOAD14 ports -


RRUs on the EPU05A-07/09

Seventh to 3 PDU03D-02 modules One PDU03D-02 can supply


fifteenth RRUs power to three RRUs.

Sixteenth to 1 PDU01D-01+1 ODM One PDU01D-01 and one ODM


twenty-first RRUs can be used together to supply
power to six RRUs.

The following table lists the cabinet configurations given different backup power
requirements, requirements on space for customer equipment, and carrier
configurations.

Table 1-318 Cabinet configurations


Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Power Custome Configur
Require r ation
ment Equipme
nt

110 V AC No Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 ODM


or 220 V backup BBU: ≤ 5
AC power U
Two
BBUs: ≤ 3
U

Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 TMC11H+1


BBU: ≤ 6 ODM
U
Two
BBUs: ≤ 4
U

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 729


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Backup Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Power Custome Configur
Require r ation
ment Equipme
nt

APM30Hs Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 IBBS200D/


and BBU: ≤ 5 IBBS200T/IBBS300D/
IBBS200D U IBBS300T/BBC5600D/
s/ Two BBC5600D-V/BBC5600A/
IBBS200T BBUs: ≤ 3 BBC5600A-V+ 1 ODM
s initially U
configure
d on a Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H + 1 TMC11H + 1
1:1 ratio BBU: ≤ 6 IBBS200D/IBBS200T/
U BBC5600D/BBC5600D-V/
Two BBC5600A/BBC5600A-V + 1
BBUs: ≤ 4 ODM
U

APM30Hs Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H+2 IBBS200Ds/


and BBU: ≤ 5 IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/
IBBS200D U IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/
s/ Two BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
IBBS200T BBUs: ≤ 3 BBC5600A-Vs+1 ODM
s/ U
IBBS300D
s/ Single ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM30H+1 TMC11H+2
IBBS300T BBU: ≤ 16 IBBS200Ds/IBBS200Ts/
s initially U IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/
configure Two BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/
d on a BBUs: ≤ BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs+1
1:2 ratio 14 U ODM

When backup power is not required in a base station, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 730


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-371 Cabinet configurations when backup power is not required

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/BBC5600A-Vs are initially
configured on a 1:1 ratio, the cabinet configurations given different requirements
on space for customer equipment and carrier configurations are shown in the
following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 731


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-372 Cabinet configurations when backup power is required and


APM30Hs and IBBS/BBC series cabinets are initially configured on a 1:1 ratio

When backup power is required in a base station and APM30Hs and IBBS200Ds/
IBBS200Ts/IBBS300Ds/IBBS300Ts/BBC5600Ds/BBC5600D-Vs/BBC5600As/
BBC5600A-Vs are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio, the cabinet configurations
given different requirements on space for customer equipment and carrier
configurations are shown in the following figure. This figure uses the single- or
dual-mode base station as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 732


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-373 Cabinet configurations when backup power is required and


APM30Hs and IBBS/BBC series cabinets are initially configured on a 1:2 ratio

1.3.4.2.2 Outdoor DC Scenarios


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS5900 is installed outdoors and
supplied with DC power.
The following table describes the scenarios where BBUs are installed outdoors and
the DBS5900 is supplied with DC power.

Table 1-319 BBU installation scenarios


BBU Scenario Description Remarks
Installation
Position

APM5900H The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an


APM5900H and RRUs are APM5900H
installed remotely. The
APM5900H supplies power to
the BBU and RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 733


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Scenario Description Remarks


Installation
Position

APM5900H-L The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an


APM5900H-L and RRUs are APM5900H-L
installed remotely. The
APM5900H-L supplies power
to the BBU and RRUs.

APM5930(DC The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an


) APM5930(DC) and RRUs are APM5930(DC)
installed remotely. The
APM5930(DC) supplies power
to the BBU and RRUs.

TMC11H The BBU is installed in a BBU Installed in a TMC11H


(Ver.E) TMC11H (Ver.E) and RRUs are (Ver.E)
installed remotely. The
TMC11H (Ver.E) supplies
power to the BBU and RRUs.

Configuration Principles of Cabinets Used by a DBS5900


For details, see:
● Combination Principles of APM5950H Series Cabinets
● Combination Principles of APM5950H-L Series Cabinets
● Combination Principles of APM5930 Series Cabinets
● Combination Principles of APM30H Series Cabinets

Configuration Principles of BBUs in Applicable Cabinets


For details about BBU installation in a single-, dual-, triple-, or quadruple-mode
base station, see Configuration Principles of BBUs in Applicable Cabinets. The
following figures use a base station configured with two BBUs as an example.

BBU Installed in an APM5900H


When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of
27 RRUs. The following table describes the mapping between the number of RRUs
and power equipment.

Table 1-320 RRU power distribution scheme

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs DCDU15D (LOAD0 to -


(power LOAD5 ports)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 734


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

Seventh to twenty- 4 DCDU-12Bs One DCDU-12B can supply power


seventh RRUs to 6 RRUs.
(power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to twenty- ● 2 DCDU-12Bs: 12 ● One DCDU-12B can supply


seventh RRUs RRUs (power power to 6 RRUs.
● 12 RRUs (power consumption per ● One DCDU16D-02 can supply
consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W) power to 3 RRUs.
RRU ≤ 800 W) ● 3 DCDU16D-02s: 9
● 9 RRUs (800 W RRUs (800 W <
< power power
consumption per consumption per
RRU ≤ 1400 W) RRU ≤ 1400 W)

When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of


27 RRUs and the cabinet configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 735


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-374 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 736


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 737


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-321 Cabinet configurations


Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 18 RRUs 1 APM5900H-L (2 DCDU-12Bs


11 U (power +3 DCDU16D-02sa)
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 1 APM5900H-L (4 DCDU-12Bs)


11 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 18 RRUs 2 APM5900H-Ls (1 DCDU-12B


25 U (power +3 DCDU16D-02s)
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 27 RRUs 2 APM5900H-Ls (3 DCDU-12Bs)


25 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

a: The DCDU-12B and DCDU16D-02 to be added for capacity expansion must be


installed in the space for customer equipment.

BBU Installed in an APM5900H-L


When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of
15 RRUs. The following table describes the mapping between the number of RRUs
and power equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 738


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-322 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs DCDU15D (LOAD0 to -


(power LOAD5 ports)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to 2 DCDU-12Bs One DCDU-12B can supply power


fifteenth RRUs to 6 RRUs.
(power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to 3 DCDU16D-02s: 9 One DCDU16D-02 can supply


fifteenth RRUs (800 RRUs (800 W < power to 3 RRUs.
W < power power consumption
consumption per per RRU ≤ 1400 W)
RRU ≤ 1400 W)

When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of


15 RRUs and the cabinet configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 739


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-375 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario (single cabinet)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 740


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-376 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario (two cabinets)

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 741


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-323 Cabinet configurations


Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration
Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 6 RRUs 1 APM5900H-L (3


11 U (power DCDU16D-02sa)
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5900H (2 DCDU-12Bs)


11 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 8 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 6 RRUs 2 APM5900Hs (3


25 U (power DCDU16D-02s)
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+9 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 2 APM5900Hs (1 DCDU-12B)


25 U (power
Two BBUs: ≤ 22 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

a: The DCDU-12B and DCDU16D-02 to be added for capacity expansion must be


installed in the space for customer equipment.

BBU Installed in an APM5930(DC)


When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of
21 RRUs. The following table describes the mapping between the number of RRUs
and power equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 742


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-324 RRU power distribution scheme


Number of RRUs Power Equipment Remarks

First to sixth RRUs DCDU15D (LOAD0 to -


(power LOAD5 ports)
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to twenty- 3 DCDU-12Bs One DCDU-12B can supply power


first RRUs (power to 6 RRUs.
consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)

Seventh to twenty- ● 2 DCDU-12Bs: 9 ● One DCDU-12B can supply


first RRUs RRUs (power power to 6 RRUs.
● 9 RRUs (power consumption per ● One EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/
consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W) DCDU16D-02 can supply
RRU ≤ 800 W) ● 2 EPU02D-02s/ power to 3 RRUs.
● 6 RRUs (800 W DCDU16Ds/
< power DCDU16D-02s: 6
consumption per RRUs (800 W <
RRU ≤ 1100 W) power
consumption per
RRU ≤ 1100 W)

When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of


21 RRUs and the cabinet configurations are shown in the following figures.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 743


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-377 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 744


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Table 1-325 Cabinet configurations

Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

-48 V DC Single BBU: ≤ 5 ≤ 15 RRUs 1 APM5930(DC) cabinet (3


U (power DCDUs+2 EPU02D-02s/
Two BBUs: ≤ 3 consumption DCDU16Ds/DCDU16D-02s)
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+6 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1100
W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 745


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Space for Carrier Cabinet Configuration


Supply Customer Configuration
Equipment

Single BBU: ≤ 6 ≤ 21 RRUs 1 APM5930(DC) cabinet (4


U (power DCDUs)
Two BBUs: ≤ 4 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 15 RRUs 2 APM5930(DC) cabinets (3


16 U (power DCDUs+2 EPU02D-02s/
Two BBUs: ≤ 14 consumption DCDU16Ds/DCDU16D-02s)
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)+6 RRUs
(800 W <
power
consumption
per RRU ≤ 1100
W)

Single BBU: ≤ ≤ 21 RRUs 2 APM5930(DC) cabinets (4


17 U (power DCDUs)
Two BBUs: ≤ 15 consumption
U per RRU ≤ 800
W)

BBU Installed in a TMC11H (Ver.E)


When -48 V DC power is provided, a single site supplies power to a maximum of
21 RRUs and the cabinet configurations are shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 746


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-378 Cabinet configurations in the -48 V DC scenario

The following table lists the cabinet configurations of a base station supplied with
-48 V DC power.

Table 1-326 Cabinet configurations


Power Supply Spac Carri Cabin
e for er et
Custo Confi Confi
mer gurat gurat
Equip ion ion
ment

-48 V DC ≤5U ≤ 21 1
RRUs TMC1
1H
(with
3
DCD
Us)

≤ 16 ≤ 21 2
U RRUs TMC1
1Hs
(with
4
DCD
Us)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 747


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.4.2.3 Indoor AC Scenario


This section describes the scenario where the DBS5900 is installed indoors and
supplied with AC power.
The following table describes the scenario where the BBU is installed indoors and
the DBS5900 is supplied with AC power.

Table 1-327 Installation scenario


BBU Scenario Description Reference
Installation
Position

IMB05 The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an IMB05


IMB05 and the RRUs are
installed remotely. The IMB05
supplies power to the BBU and
RRUs.

BBU Installed in an IMB05


When external 220 V AC power is provided, an ETP48100-B1 can be configured to
supply power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-379 BBU installed in an IMB05

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is
installed in an IMB05 and there is no backup power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 748


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-328 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is installed in an
IMB05

Power Supply Cabinet and Module Configuration

220 V single-phase 1 IMB05+1 BBU+1 ETP48100-B1+2


RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤
800 W)

1 IMB05+1 BBU+1 ETP48100-B1+1


RRU (800 W < power consumption per
RRU ≤ 1100 W)

1.3.4.2.4 Indoor DC Scenarios


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS5900 is installed indoors and
supplied with DC power.

The following table describes the scenarios where the BBUs are installed indoors
and the DBS5900 is supplied with DC power.

Table 1-329 Installation scenarios

BBU Scenario Description Reference


Installation
Position

IBC10 The BBUs are installed in an BBU Installed in an IBC10


(Ver.B) IBC10 (Ver.B). The DCDU (Ver.B)
supplies power to the BBUs.

ILC29 The BBUs are installed in an BBU Installed in an ILC29


(Ver.E) ILC29 (Ver.E) and RRUs are (Ver.E)
installed outdoors. The ILC29
(Ver.E) supplies power to the
BBUs and RRUs.

IMB05 The BBU is installed in an BBU Installed in an IMB05


IMB05 and the RRUs are
installed outdoors. The IMB05
supplies power to the BBUs and
outdoor RRUs.

IMS5906 The BBUs are installed in an BBU Installed in an IMS5906


IMS5906 and RRUs are with the IFS5906 Stacked
centrally installed on an
IFS5906, which is stacked on
the IMS5906. The IMS5906
provides 6 U space for
installing DC power supply
modules to supply power to the
BBUs, RRUs, and fan assembly
in the IFS5906.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 749


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Scenario Description Reference


Installation
Position

19-inch rack The 19-inch rack can be BBU Installed in a 19-Inch


provided by Huawei or the Rack/INS05 Installed in a
customer. The 19-inch rack Non-Huawei 19-Inch Rack/
provided by Huawei is an Cabinet
INS12/INS05. The DCDU-12B/
EPU02D-02 and BBUs are
installed in the 19-inch rack.
The DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02
supplies power to the BBUs and
outdoor RRUs.
When the BBU power
consumption does not exceed
1100 W, the BBUs can be
stacked horizontally. When the
BBU power consumption
exceeds 1100 W, the BBUs must
be installed in an INS05.

Wall The BBU and DCDU-12B are BBU Installed on a Wall


installed on a wall, and RRUs
are installed outdoors. The
DCDU-12B supplies power to
the BBU and outdoor RRUs.

BBU Installed in an IBC10 (Ver.B)


When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBUs can be installed in an IBC10
(Ver.B). The IBC10 (Ver.B) supplies power to the BBUs and universal switching
units (USUs), as shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 750


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-380 BBUs installed in an IBC10 (Ver.B)

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBUs
are installed in an IBC10 (Ver.B).

Table 1-330 Module configurations when the BBUs are installed in an IBC10
(Ver.B)

Power Supply Module Configuration

-48 V DC 10 BBU5900s+ 3 DCDU-12Cs

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 751


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in an ILC29 (Ver.E)


The cabinet configurations of an ILC29 (Ver.E) are described as follows:
● A single cabinet supports a maximum of two BBUs.
● A single cabinet supports a maximum of 36 optical fibers.
When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBU can be installed in an ILC29
(Ver.E), which supplies power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the following
figure.

Figure 1-381 BBU installed in an ILC29 (Ver.E)

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is
installed in an ILC29 (Ver.E).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 752


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-331 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is installed in an
ILC29 (Ver.E)
Power Supply Cabinet and Module Configuration

-48 V DC 1 ILC29 (Ver.E)+2 BBUs+3 EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds/


DCDU16D-02s+5 DCDU-12Bs+9 RRUs (800 W < power
consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)+21 RRUs (power
consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W)

BBU Installed in an IMB05


When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBU can be installed in an IMB05,
which supplies power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the following figure.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 753


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-382 BBU installed in an IMB05

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 754


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is
installed in an IMB05.

Table 1-332 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBU is installed in an
IMB05
Power Cabinet and Module Configuration
Supply

-48 V DC 1 IMB05+1 BBU+2 DCDU-12Bs+12 RRUs (power consumption


per RRU ≤ 800 W)

1 IMB05+1 BBU+2 EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds+6 RRUs (800 W <


power consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

1 IMB05+1 BBU+1 DCDU-12B+1 EPU02D-02/DCDU16D+9 RRUs


(6 RRUs: power consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W; 3 RRUs: 800 W
< power consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

BBU Installed in an IMS5906 with the IFS5906 Stacked


When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBUs can be installed in an
IMS5906 on which the IFS5906 is stacked. The IMS5906 is configured with a
DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 to supply power to the BBUs and
RRUs, as shown in the following figure.
NOTE

The 2 U space in the upper part of the IMS5906 can house the DCDU-12B and the
EPU02D-02. The following figure uses 1 EPU02D-02+1 DCDU-12B as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 755


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-383 BBUs installed in an IMS5906 with the IFS5906 stacked

The following table lists the maximum cabinet and module configurations when
the BBUs are installed in an IMS5906.

Table 1-333 Maximum cabinet and module configurations when the BBUs are
installed in an IMS5906
Power Maximum Cabinet and Module Configuration
Supply

-48 V DC 1 IMS5906+1 IFS5906+2 BBUs+2 DCDU-12Bs+6 RRUs (power


consumption per RRU ≤ 800 W)

1 IMS5906+1 IFS5906+2 BBUs+2 EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds/


DCDU16D-02s+6 RRUs (800 W < power consumption per RRU ≤
1100 W)

1 IFS5906+2 BBUs+1 DCDU-12B+1 EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02+6 RRUs (3 low-power RRUs: power consumption
per RRU ≤ 800 W; 3 high-power RRUs: 800 W < power
consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 756


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installed in a Huawei Cabinet or a Non-Huawei Rack with IFS5906


Installed on the Ground
When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBUs can be installed in a Huawei
cabinet or a non-Huawei rack and the IFS5906 can be installed on the ground. The
Huawei cabinet or non-Huawei rack is configured with a DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 to supply power to the BBUs, FAN 03D, and RRUs, as
shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-384 BBUs installed in a Huawei cabinet or a non-Huawei rack and


IFS5906 installed on the ground

The following table lists the cabinet and module configurations when the BBUs
are installed in a Huawei cabinet or a non-Huawei rack.

Table 1-334 Cabinet and module configurations when the BBUs are installed in a
Huawei cabinet or a non-Huawei rack

Power Cabinet and Module Configuration


Supply

-48 V DC 1 IFS5906+2 BBUs+2 DCDU-12Bs+6 RRUs (power consumption


per RRU ≤ 800 W)

1 IFS5906+2 BBUs+2 EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds/DCDU16D-02s+6


RRUs (800 W < power consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 757


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Cabinet and Module Configuration


Supply

1 IFS5906+2 BBUs+1 DCDU-12B+1 EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02+6 RRUs (3 low-power RRUs: power consumption
per RRU ≤ 800 W; 3 high-power RRUs: 800 W < power
consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

BBU Installed in a 19-Inch Rack


When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBUs and DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 can be installed in a 19-inch rack, and RRUs can be
remotely installed outdoors. In this scenario, the DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 supplies power to the BBUs and RRUs. The following
figure shows the cabinet configurations when the BBUs are installed in a 19-inch
rack.

Figure 1-385 BBUs installed in a 19-inch rack

The number of RRUs supported by the DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02 is different. The following table lists the detailed configurations.

Table 1-335 Module configurations for installing BBUs in a 19-inch rack

Power Supply Module Configuration

-48 V DC 2 BBUs+3 DCDU-12Bs+15 RRUs (power consumption per


RRU ≤ 800 W)

2 BBUs+3 EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds/DCDU16D-02s+9 RRUs


(800 W < power consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 758


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

INS05 Installed in a Non-Huawei 19-Inch Rack/Cabinet


This part describes the scenarios where INS05s are installed in a non-Huawei 19-
inch rack/cabinet.
● For a 2.0 m non-Huawei 19-inch rack/cabinet, it is recommended that 3 U
space be reserved on the top of the INS05. For a 2.2 m non-Huawei 19-inch
rack/cabinet, it is recommended that 5 U space be reserved on the top of the
INS05.
● If two INS05s are used, it is recommended that 2 U space be reserved
between INS05s in a 2.0 m non-Huawei 19-inch rack/cabinet and 4 U space
be reserved between INS05s in a 2.2 m non-Huawei 19-inch rack/cabinet.
The following figures show the recommended positions for installing INS05
subracks in non-Huawei 19-inch racks/cabinets.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 759


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-386 One INS05 installed in a non-Huawei 19-inch rack

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 760


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-387 Two INS05s installed in a non-Huawei 19-inch rack

BBU Installed on a Wall


When the external input power is -48 V DC, the BBU and DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 can be installed indoors on a wall, and RRUs can be
remotely installed outdoors. In this scenario, the DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 supplies power to the BBU and RRUs, as shown in the
following figure. The installation positions of the DCDU-12B and EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 on a wall are similar. The following figure uses the
DCDU-12B as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 761


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-388 BBU installed on a wall

The following table lists the module configurations when the BBU is installed on a
wall.

Table 1-336 Module configurations for installing a BBU on a wall


Power Supply Module Configuration

-48 V DC 1 BBU+1 DCDU-12B+6 RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤


800 W)

1 BBU+1 EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02+3 RRUs (800


W < power consumption per RRU ≤ 1100 W)

1.3.4.3 Power Requirements of a DBS5900


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and power cables in a DBS5900 given different cabinets, external
power supply, and product configurations.
The following table describes the power requirements when customer equipment
is used to supply power to the BBU5900 through dual power supplies.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 762


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-337 Power requirements


Power Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Suppl Configuration Requirement Area of the Requirement
y for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

-48 V BBU (one 2x25 A/1 P 2x4 mm2 ≤ 15 m (49.21


UPEUe board) (0.0062 in.2), ft)
one group

BBU (two 4x25 A/1 P 2x4 mm2


UPEUe boards) (0.0062 in.2),
two groups

For details about the power requirements of an RRU/AAU, see "RRU Power Cable"
or "AAU Power Cable" in the corresponding RRU/AAU hardware description. For
example, for the RRU5909s, see "RRU Power Cable" in RRU5909s Hardware
Description.

NOTE

● Two circuit breakers are required for each BBU power board (UPEUe). 30 A is
recommended for a single circuit breaker, and the minimum specification is 25 A. If two
BBU power boards (UPEUe) are configured, four circuit breakers are required.
● If the minimum requirement for circuit breakers on customer equipment provided by the
customer does not meet the requirements listed in the preceding table, contact local
Huawei engineers for technical support.

1.3.4.3.1 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using the APM5950H and having the peak power.

AC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS5900


supplied with AC power and using an APM5950H.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 763


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-338 Power requirements

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 6 or 7 PSUs 1x80 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (default) a black ft)
jacket and
4 or 5 PSUs 1x50 A/3 P four core
2 or 3 PSUs 1x32 A/3 P wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)

220 V AC 5 to 7 PSUs 1x125 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (by default) (L and N),
each with
4 PSUs 1x100 A/1 P a single
3 PSUs 1x80 A/1 P core wire,
two
2 PSUs 1x50 A/1 P insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 PSUs 1x125 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC (by default) wires (L1,
dual-live-wire

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 764


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

4 PSUs 1x100 A/2 P L2, and N),


each with
3 PSUs 1x80 A/2 P a single
2 PSUs 1x50 A/2 P core wire,
two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)

1.3.4.3.2 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using the APM5900H and having the peak power.

DC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

An APM5900H is configured with one DCDU15D by default in outdoor DC


scenarios. In capacity expansion scenarios, additional DCDU-12B/DCDU16D-02 can
be configured. Table 1-339, Table 1-340 and Table 1-341 describe the power
requirements of a DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 765


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-339 Power requirements of a DCDU15D


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m


consumption per 2),two groups of (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)
● 1 FAN02I

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W) DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 766


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),one group of DC
RRU ≤ 800 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 560 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 400 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 767


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-340 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) ≤ 10 m


consumption per (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 2 BBUs
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 2 BBUs
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W) 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 2 BBUs
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 2 BBUs

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 768


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-341 Power requirements of a DCDU16D-02 (2x100 A/1 P circuit breakers


are recommended)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


(power 2),one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 769


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 770


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 771


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.4.3.3 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H-L


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using the APM5950H-L and having the peak power.

AC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of a DBS5900 using an


APM5950H-L.

Table 1-342 Power requirements


Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length
Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 PSUs 1x50 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase a black ft)
2 or 3 PSUs 1x32 A/3 P jacket and
four core
wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 16
mm2
(0.025 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 772


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 PSUs 1x100 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (L and N),
3 PSUs 1x80 A/1 P each with
2 PSUs 1x50 A/1 P a single
core wire,
two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)

110 V AC or 4 PSUs 1x100 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC wires (L1,
dual-live-wire 3 PSUs 1x80 A/2 P L2, and N),
2 PSUs 1x50 A/2 P each with
a single
core wire,
two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 773


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.4.3.4 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H-L


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using the APM5900H-L and having the peak power.

DC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

An APM5900H-L is configured with one DCDU15D by default in outdoor DC


scenarios. In capacity expansion scenarios, additional DCDU-12B/DCDU16D-02 can
be configured. Table 1-343, Table 1-344 and Table 1-345 describe the power
requirements of a DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Table 1-343 Power requirements of a DCDU15D

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m


consumption per 2),two groups of (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W) DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 774


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),one group of DC
RRU ≤ 400 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1200 W)

Table 1-344 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) ≤ 10 m


consumption per (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 1 BBU
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W) 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
2), two groups of
● 1 BBU
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 775


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requiremen
on Customer t
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables

● 6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 560 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 400 W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption per
RRU ≤ 300 W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 776


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-345 Power requirements of a DCDU16D-02 (2x100 A/1 P circuit breakers


are recommended)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


(power 2),one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1200 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1200 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 777


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 778


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 779


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.4.3.5 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(AC)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using an APM5930(AC) and having the peak power.

AC Input Scenario
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor DBS5900


supplied with AC power and using an APM5930(AC).

Table 1-346 Power requirements


Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length
Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x50 A/3 P ● Cable with ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) a black ft)
jacket and
2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P four core
(by default) wires, two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 10
mm2
(0.016 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 780


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Requirement s for the Requirement
for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 5 1x125 A/1 P ● Two wires


single-phase (by default) (L and N),
each with
4 1x100 A/1 P a single
3 1x80 A/1 P core wire,
two
2 1x50 A/1 P insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x125 A/2 P ● Three


120 V AC (by default) wires (L1,
dual-live-wire L2, and N),
4 1x100 A/2 P each with
3 1x80 A/2 P a single
core wire,
2 1x50 A/2 P two
insulation
layers, and
a cross-
sectional
area of 35
mm2
(0.054 in.2)
● PE cable
with a
cross-
sectional
area of 25
mm2
(0.039 in.2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 781


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.4.3.6 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using the APM5930(DC) and having the peak power.

DC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

An APM5930(DC) is configured with a DCDU15D by default in outdoor DC power


scenarios. In capacity expansion scenarios, additional DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/
EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S modules can be configured. Table 1-347, Table
1-349, and Table 1-348 describe the power requirements of a DCDU15D,
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, and EPU02D-02/EPU02B, respectively. Table 1-350 lists
the power requirements of an EPU02S. Table 1-351 lists the power requirements
of an EPU02S-02.

Table 1-347 Power requirements of a DCDU15D


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m


consumption per 2),two groups of (32.81 ft)
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)
● 1 FAN02G

● 6 RRUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 782


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),two groups of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total cables
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1800 W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 800 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
power
2), two groups of
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W) DC input power
cables

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 560 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 783


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2),one group of DC
RRU ≤ 400 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


consumption per 2), one group of DC
RRU ≤ 300 W) input power cables
● 1 or 2 BBUs (total
power
consumption of
BBUs ≤ 1420 W)

Table 1-348 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (800 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


power 2),one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption per 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

3 RRUs (800 W < 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of DC
power consumption
per RRU ≤ 1100 W) input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 784


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2),two groups of
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Table 1-349 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


(power 2), one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 785


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2),one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption per
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1100 W) (low smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Table 1-350 Power requirements of an EPU02S

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


power 2), one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W) (low smoke zero
halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption per 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
BBU ≤ 1420 W) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 786


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power default) 2), two groups of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low smoke
● 1 BBU (power zero halogen)
consumption per
BBU ≤ 1420 W)

3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of DC
power consumption
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 W 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


< power consumption 2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 1600 W) DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Table 1-351 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable
Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m


power 2), one group of DC (32.81 ft)
consumption per input power cables
RRU ≤ 1400 W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption per
BBU ≤ 1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 787


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable


Configuration(1)(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Length
Circuit Breakers Power Cable Requirement
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power default) 2), two groups of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low smoke
● 1 BBU (power zero halogen)
consumption per
BBU ≤ 1420 W)

3 RRUs (1100 W < 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


power consumption 2), one group of DC
per RRU ≤ 1400 W) input power cables

2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 W 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


< power consumption 2), two groups of
per RRU ≤ 1600 W) DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 788


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 789


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.0093 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.0062 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.4.3.7 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
distributed base station using the APM30H (Ver.E) and having the peak power.

AC Input
NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of an outdoor distributed


base station supplied with AC power and using the APM30H (Ver.E).

Table 1-352 Power requirements of a distributed base station using the APM30H
(Ver.E)

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 4 or 5 1x40 A/3 P Cable with a ≤ 15 m (49.21


three-phase (by default) black jacket ft)
and four core
2 or 3 1x32 A/3 P wires, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 6 mm2
(0.0093 in.2)

220 V AC 5 1x100 A/1 P Two wires (L


single-phase and N), each
4 1x80 A/1 P with a single
core wire, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 790


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Number of Minimum Requirement Cable Length


Supply PSUs Circuit s for the Requirement
Breaker Input Power
Requirement Cable
on Customer
Equipment

3 1x63 A/1 P sectional area


of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

110 V AC or 5 1x100 A/2 P Three wires


120 V AC (L1, L2, and
dual-live-wire 4 1x80 A/2 P N), each with
3 1x63 A/2 P a single core
wire, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-
sectional area
of 25 mm2
(0.039 in.2)

1.3.4.3.8 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the TMC11H (Ver.E)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using a TMC11H (Ver.E) and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

When an outdoor DBS5900 is supplied with DC power and uses the TMC11H
(Ver.E), a DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S can be
configured in the TMC11H (Ver.E). Power requirements of a DCDU-12B lists the
power requirements of a DCDU-12B. Table 1-354 lists the power requirements of
a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Table 1-355 lists the power requirements of an
EPU02D-02/EPU02B. Table 1-356 lists the power requirements of an EPU02S.
Table 1-357 lists the power requirements of an EPU02S-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 791


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-353 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2) ≤ 10 m (32.81


consumption ft)
per RRU ≤ 800 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
W) two groups of DC
input power cables
● 2 BBUs

● 6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2)


consumption
per RRU ≤ 560 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
W) two groups of DC
input power cables
● 2 BBUs

● 6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption
per RRU ≤ 400 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2),
W) two groups of DC
input power cables
● 2 BBUs

● 6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 2 BBUs

● 3 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2)


consumption
per RRU ≤ 800
W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption
per RRU ≤ 560
W)
● 1 BBU

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption
per RRU ≤ 400
W)
● 1 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 792


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.2)


consumption
per RRU ≤ 300
W)
● 1 BBU

Table 1-354 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2), ≤ 10 m (32.81


(power one group of DC ft)
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 793


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment(2)(3)
(4)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
consumption ≤
two groups of DC
1200 W)
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.2),


(power one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2),
two groups of DC
input power cables
(low smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-355 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 794


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1100 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-356 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 795


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 796


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-357 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 797


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 798


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.4.3.9 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the IBC10 (Ver.B)


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 using an IBC10 (Ver.B) and having the peak power.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

DC Input Scenario
The following table describes the power requirements of an indoor DBS5900
supplied with DC power and using an IBC10 (Ver.B).

Table 1-358 Power requirements in DC scenarios


Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable Length
Equipmen Configuration Requirement Sectional Area Requirement
t for Circuit of the Input
Breakers on Power
Customer Cable(2)
Equipment(1)

0#DCDU- ● 2 first-level 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 ≤ 10 m (32.81


12C USUs in.2), one ft)
(power group of DC
consumptio input power
n per USU ≤ cables
850 W)
2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039
● 1 second-
level USU in.2), two
(power groups of DC
consumptio input power
n per USU ≤ cables
505 W)
● 2 fan
assemblies
(power
consumptio
n per fan
assembly ≤
1050 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 799


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Product Minimum Cross- Cable Length


Equipmen Configuration Requirement Sectional Area Requirement
t for Circuit of the Input
Breakers on Power
Customer Cable(2)
Equipment(1)

1#DCDU- 5 BBUs (power 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039


12C to consumption in.2), two
4#DCDU- per BBU ≤ groups of DC
12C 2100 W) input power
cables

NOTE

(1) Remarks about minimum requirements for circuit breakers on the customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 2x100 A, 160
A, and 2x80 A.
(2) When two power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from the same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specifications and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.

1.3.4.3.10 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)


NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

The following table describes the power requirements of the DCDU-12B in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the DCDU-12B provides power only for the BBUs and fan
assembly.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 800


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-359 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(5) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

● 1 or 2 BBUs 2x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(total power 2), two groups of
consumption ≤ DC input power
1800 W) cables
● 1 FAN (power
consumption ≤
730 W)

The following table describes the power requirements of the DCDU-12B in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the DCDU-12B provides power only for the RRUs.

Table 1-360 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

3 RRUs (power 2x63 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)
consumption per default) 2), two groups of
RRU ≤ 1200 W) DC input power
cables

1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of

DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 800 W) DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 801


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

6 RRUs (power 1x100 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 560 W) DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 400 W) DC input power
cables

6 RRUs (power 1x63 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 300 W) DC input power
cables

3 RRUs (power 1x32 A/1 P 4 mm2 (0.006 in.


consumption per 2), one group of
RRU ≤ 300 W) DC input power
cables

The following table describes the power requirements of the DCDU16D in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the DCDU provides power only for the RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 802


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-361 Power requirements of a DCDU16D (recommended circuit breaker


specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1100 W ≤ 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements of the EPU02D-02/EPU02B


in an ILC29 (Ver.E) when the EPU is powered by external equipment.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 803


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-362 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


2), one group of
(power
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1200 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements of the EPU02S in an ILC29
(Ver.E) when the EPU02S is powered by external equipment.

Table 1-363 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


2), one group of
W < power
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 804


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of
W < power
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements of the EPU02S-02 in an


ILC29 (Ver.E) when the EPU02S-02 is powered by external equipment.

Table 1-364 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1100 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1400 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 805


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

1 to 3 RRUs (1400 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


W < power 2), one group of
consumption per DC input power
RRU ≤ 1600 W) cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 806


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 807


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● If more than six RRUs are configured, a maximum of six 6 mm2 (0.009 in.2) power
cables can be configured for RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 560 W) and a
maximum of three 4 mm2 (0.006 in.2) power cables can be configured for RRUs
(power consumption per RRU ≤ 400 W).
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.4.3.11 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the IMB05/IFS5906+IMS5906


This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 (with the peak power) using the IMB05/IFS5906+IMS5906.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

AC Input Scenario
The following table describes the power requirements of a DBS5900 supplied with
AC power and using the IMB05.

Table 1-365 Power requirements when the IMB05 and ETP48100-B1 are used
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(5) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
Circuit Breakers Power Cable
on Customer
Equipment

● 1 to 2 RRUs 1x32 A/1 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 ≤ 40 m (131.23


(power in.2) ft)
consumption
per RRU ≤ 800
W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

● 1 RRU (power
consumption ≤
1100 W)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 808


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input Scenario
When a DBS5900 uses an IMB05/IMS5906+IFS5906 and is provided with DC power
supply by an EPU02D-02/EPU02B, the power requirements are listed in the
following table.

Table 1-366 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


2), one group of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

When a DBS5900 uses an IMB05 and is provided with DC power supply by an


EPU02S, the power requirements are listed in the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 809


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-367 Power requirements of an EPU02S


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1400 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 810


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

When a DBS5900 uses an IMB05 and is provided with DC power supply by an


EPU02S-02, the power requirements are listed in the following table.

Table 1-368 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 811


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x63 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1400 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements when a base station is
powered by a DCDU-12B.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 812


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-369 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 1 BBUa (power
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption ≤ 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables

a: When the power consumption per BBU does not exceed 1420 W, one power
board is configured in the BBU and needs to be powered by the DCDU-12B.
When the power consumption per BBU is greater than 1420 W and less than or
equal to 1800 W, two power boards are configured in the BBU and one of the
two power boards needs to be powered by other equipment.

The following table describes the power requirements when a base station is
powered by a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02.

Table 1-370 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 813


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 814


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 815


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● When more than six RRUs are configured, another DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B is required.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.4.3.12 Power Requirements of a DBS5900 Using the 19-Inch Rack or Wall for
Installation
This section describes the requirements for circuit breakers on customer
equipment and cross-sectional areas of power cables in a fully configured
DBS5900 (with the peak power) using the 19-inch rack or wall for installation.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following table, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

DC Input Scenario
When the BBU of a DBS5900 is installed in a 19-inch rack or on a wall and the
DBS5900 is supplied with DC power by an EPU02D-02/EPU02B, the power
requirements are listed in Table 1-371. Table 1-372 lists the power requirements
when a base station is powered by an EPU02S. Table 1-373 lists the power
requirements when a base station is powered by an EPU02S-02. Table 1-374 lists
the power requirements when a base station is powered by a DCDU-12B. Table
1-375 lists the power requirements when a base station is powered by a
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02.

Table 1-371 Power requirements of an EPU02D-02/EPU02B

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
1420 W)
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 816


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 0 BBU halogen)

1x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), one group of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power default) 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1100 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.
2100 W)
2), one group of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-372 Power requirements of an EPU02S

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 817


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power default) 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2100 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1400 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 818


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)
● 0 BBU 2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Table 1-373 Power requirements of an EPU02S-02


Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
default) 2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1100 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 819


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Maximum Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)(4)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(power default) 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low
1400 W) smoke zero
● 1 BBU (power halogen)
consumption ≤
2100 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.


(1400 W < default) 2), two groups of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
1420 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(1400 W < 2), one group of
power DC input power
consumption cables (low
per RRU ≤ smoke zero
1600 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x80 A/1 P (by 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
default) 2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

The following table describes the power requirements when a base station is
powered by a DCDU-12B.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 820


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-374 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 4 to 6 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), one group of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 800 cables (low smoke
W) zero halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.
consumption ≤
2),two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables

● 4 to 6 RRUs 2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025 in.


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ 560 cables
W)
● 1 BBUa (power
consumption ≤
2100 W)

a: When the power consumption per BBU does not exceed 1420 W, one power
board is configured in the BBU and needs to be powered by the DCDU-12B.
When the power consumption per BBU is greater than 1420 W and less than or
equal to 2100 W, two power boards are configured in the BBU and one of the
two power boards needs to be powered by other equipment.

The following table describes the power requirements when a base station is
powered by a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 821


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-375 Power requirements of a DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 (recommended


circuit breaker specification: 2x100 A/1 P)
Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 2x100 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in. ≤ 10 m (32.81 ft)


(power 2), two groups of
consumption DC input power
per RRU ≤ cables (low smoke
1400 W) zero halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
consumption ≤
2100 W)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x125 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1400 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
2), two groups of
2100 W)
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 822


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length


Configuration(1) Requirement for Area of the Input Requirement
(4)(5) Circuit Breakers Power Cable(3)
on Customer
Equipment(2)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 1 BBU (power
2x80 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
consumption ≤
2), two groups of
1420 W)
DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

● 1 to 3 RRUs 1x100 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 in.


(power 2), one group of DC
consumption input power cables
per RRU ≤ (low smoke zero
1100 W) halogen)
● 0 BBU
2x63 A/1 P 25 mm2 (0.039 in.
2), two groups of

DC input power
cables (low smoke
zero halogen)

When the INS05 is used, a DCDU-12B can provide a maximum of eight DC


outputs for the BBU5900 or BBU3910. The following table describes the power
requirements.
NOTE

If the specifications of circuit breakers on customer equipment are 2x100 A (not


recommended by default), the cross-sectional area of the input power cable for the
DCDU-12B is 25 mm2 (0.039 in.2).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 823


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-376 Power requirements of a DCDU-12B


Power Product Minimum Cross-Sectional Cable Length
Equipme Configuration( Requirement Area of the Requirement
nt 1)(4)(5) for Circuit Input Power
Breakers on Cable(3)
Customer
Equipment(2)

0#DCDU- 10 BBUs 1x160 A/1 P 35 mm2 (0.054 ≤ 10 m (32.81


12B to in.2), one group ft)
4#DCDU- of DC input
12B power cables
(low smoke
zero halogen)

2x80 A/1 P 16 mm2 (0.025


in.2), two
groups of DC
input power
cables (low
smoke zero
halogen)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 824


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

NOTE

(1) RRU maximum power consumption:


● 5000 series
● 0–400 W: RRU5336E, RRU5836E
● 400–560 W: RRU5309, RRU5309w, RRU5909, RRU5909c, RRU5909N, RRU5909s
● 560–650 W: RRU5301, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5901, RRU5901N, RRU5901w,
RRU5903, RRU5903w, RRU5905, RRU5905w
● 650–800 W: RRU5304, RRU5304w, RRU5507, RRU5904, RRU5904w, RRU5904N,
RRU5910
● 800–1100 W: RRU5254, RRU5258, RRU5501, RRU5505, RRU5505N, RRU5508,
RRU5509t, RRU5512, RRU5512t, RRU5515t, RRU5519et
● 1100–1400 W: RRU5502, RRU5502w, RRU5502N, RRU5513, RRU5513w,
RRU5513t, RRU5810, RRU5818, RRU5862, RRU5865
● 3000 series
● 0–300 W: RRU3821E, RRU3824, RRU3826, RRU3838
● 300–400 W: RRU3203, RRU3220, RRU3232, RRU3260, RRU3268,
● 400–560 W: RRU3229, RRU3232, RRU3251, RRU3252, RRU3253, RRU3256,
RRU3259, RRU3262, RRU3841, RRU3942, RRU3929, RRU3952, RRU3952m,
RRU3959, RRU3959a, RRU3959w, RRU3961
● 560–650 W: RRU3249, RRU3262 (850M), RRU3269, RRU3939, RRU3953,
RRU3953w, RRU3971, RRU3971a, RRU5305 (1.4G), RRU5301
● 650–800 W: RRU3276, RRU3278, RRU3278u, RRU3279, RRU3281, RRU3962,
RRU3965
AAU maximum power consumption:
● 0–800 W: AAU3910, AAU3911, AAU3920, AAU3940, AAU3961, HAAU5213, HAAU5222,
HAAU5323, AAU5243, AAU5940, AAU5942
● 800–1100 W: AAU5271, AAU5281, AAU5339w, AAU5711, AAU5711a, AAU5972,
AAU5313
● 1100–1400 W: AAU5613, AAU5614, AAU5636, AAU5636w, AAU5639, AAU5639w,
AAU5649, AAU5733, AAU5825a, AAU5831, AAU5833f, AAU5835f
● 1400–1600 W: AAU5636m, AAU5726, AAU5825g, AAU5835h
● 1600–1800 W: AAU5726e
(2) Remarks about the minimum requirements for circuit breakers on customer equipment:
● The requirements for the circuit breakers used in a large configuration scenario are
also applicable to a small configuration scenario.
● The circuit breakers with high-load capabilities can be used in a scenario where the
circuit breakers with low-load capabilities are required. The circuit breakers are
arranged based on their load capabilities in descending order as follows: 160 A, 2x80
A, 2x63 A, 100 A, 80 A, and 63 A.
(3) When two groups of power inputs are used, the following requirements must be met:
● Both power inputs are from a same power cabinet.
● Both power inputs use circuit breakers of the same specification and model.
● Both power inputs use power cables of the same cross-sectional area and length.
(4) Remarks about the product configuration are as follows:
● When a base station uses both high-power RRUs and low-power RRUs, the
specifications of circuit breakers are determined by the high-power RRUs.
● If the customer power supply is sufficient, configure the circuit breakers based on the
full configuration of high-power RRUs. If the originally configured circuit breakers do
not meet the requirements for the full configuration of high-power RRUs, replace the
circuit breakers during base station capacity expansion.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 825


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● When the power consumption of the transmission equipment exceeds 350 W, the
circuit breakers corresponding to the exceeding part of the actual power consumption
need to be added to the circuit breakers that support 350 W.
● When more than six RRUs are configured, another DCDU-11B/DCDU-12B is required.
(5) For details about the power consumption of BBUs, contact local Huawei engineers.

1.3.4.4 Power Distribution Schemes for a DBS5900


This section describes the power distribution schemes for a DBS5900 given power
input of 110 V AC, 220 V AC, and -48 V DC power.

1.3.4.4.1 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using an
APM5950H in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU (EPU07A-01 or EPU07A-02)
in the cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to
other components.
The EPU distributes two AC power outputs to the junction box on the left side of
the cabinet. The junction box then distributes four AC power outputs to the service
outlet unit (SOU) and heater.
The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
Figure 1-389 and Figure 1-390 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-377 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses in a base station.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-389 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H in a 220 V AC single-


phase or three-phase scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/
PDU01D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 826


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-390 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H in a 110 V AC dual-


live-wire scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/PDU01D-02)

Table 1-377 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in an APM5950H in AC


scenarios

Power Specificatio Specifications Specifications of the Circuit


Supply ns of the of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Upper-Level Breaker for
Circuit the AC
Breaker for Output
the PSU

220 V AC ● 220 V AC Heater and ● RRU (LOAD12 to LOAD17,


single- three- SOU: 1x16 A power consumption per RRU ≤
phase/ phase: (MCB) 800 W): 6x30 A (FUSEa)
three- 1x80 A/3 ● RRU (2 PDU06D-01s, power
phase P consumption per RRU ≤ 800
● 220 V AC W): 12x30 A (FUSE)
single- ● RRU (3 PDU03D-03s, power
phase: consumption per RRU ≤ 1400
1x125 A/1 W): 9x50 A (MCB)
P
● BBU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
110 V AC 1x125 A/2 P Heater and ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
dual-live- SOU: 1x16 A
wire (MCB) ● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/EMUB: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/TMC: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● BBC: 1x30 A (FUSE)

a: MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b: FUSE: fuse

When the AC input is used for an APM5950H, the PDU01D-02 provides two DC
outputs for the transmission cabinet APM5900H. The transmission cabinet
provides power for the transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 827


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

components through the DC power distribution box. The following figure shows
the power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-391 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-378 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios

Cabinet Type Power Equipment Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

APM5900H DCDU15D ● TM: 10x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to


serving as a LOAD9)a
transmission ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)
cabinet

NOTE

When a second BBU is installed in the transmission cabinet, the second BBU obtains power
from the APM5950H.

1.3.4.4.2 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using an
APM5900H that serves as the power cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 828


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


An APM5900H can be configured when a DBS5900 base station is supplied with
-48 V DC power. The DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, or DCDU16D-02 provides DC power
to the BBUs, RRUs, fan assembly, and other components. Figure 1-392, Figure
1-393, and Figure 1-394 show the power distribution schemes of a DCDU15D,
DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Figure 1-392 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H (configured with a


DCDU15D)

Figure 1-393 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H (configured with a


DCDU-12B)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 829


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-394 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H (configured with a


DCDU16D-02)

Table 1-379 Fuse specifications of the APM5900H in -48 V DC scenarios


Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Equipment the DC Output

APM5900H DCDU16D-0 ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB) (LOAD0 to LOAD2)


serving as a 2 ● BBU/TM/FAN: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD3 to
power LOAD6) a
cabinet

APM5900H DCDU15D ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to LOAD5)


serving as a ● BBU/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD6 to LOAD9)
power
cabinet ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)

APM5900H DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


serving as a ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet ● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

a: MCB:
miniature
circuit
breaker
b: FUSE: fuse

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from "LOAD6", "LOAD7", "LOAD8", and "LOAD9"
ports on a DCDU15D. When a second BBU is configured, the second BBU obtains power
from another DCDU.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 830


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.4.4.3 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5950H-L


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using an
APM5950H-L in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU (EPU04A-01 or EPU04A-02)
in the cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to
other components.
The EPU distributes two AC power outputs to the junction box on the left side of
the cabinet. The junction box then distributes four AC power outputs to the service
outlet unit (SOU) and heater.
The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
Figure 1-395 and Figure 1-396 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-380 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses in a base station.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-395 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H-L in a 220 V AC single-


phase or three-phase scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/
PDU01D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 831


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-396 Power distribution scheme for an APM5950H-L in a 110 V AC dual-


live-wire scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01/PDU03D-03/PDU01D-02)

Table 1-380 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in an APM5950H-L in


AC scenarios

Power Specificatio Specifications Specifications of the Circuit


Supply ns of the of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Upper-Level Breaker for
Circuit the AC
Breaker for Output
the PSU

220 V AC 4x32 A Heater and ● RRU (LOAD8 to LOAD13,


single- SOU: 1x16 A power consumption per RRU ≤
phase/ (MCBa) 800 W): 6x30 A (FUSEb)
three- ● RRU (2 PDU06D-01s, power
phase consumption per RRU ≤ 800
110 V AC 4x32 A Heater and W): 12x30 A (FUSE)
dual-live- SOU: 1x16 A ● RRU (3 PDU03D-03s, power
wire (MCB) consumption per RRU ≤ 1400
W): 9x50 A (MCB)
● BBU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/EMUB: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/TMC: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● BBC: 1x30 A (FUSE)

a: MCB: miniature circuit breaker


b: FUSE: fuse

When the AC input is used for an APM5950H-L, the PDU01D-02 provides two DC
outputs for the transmission cabinet APM5900H-L. The transmission cabinet
provides power for the transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 832


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

components through the DC power distribution box. The following figure shows
the power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-397 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-381 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios

Cabinet Type Power Equipment Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

APM5900H-L DCDU15D ● TM: 10x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to


serving as a LOAD9)a
transmission ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)
cabinet

NOTE

When a second BBU is installed in the transmission cabinet, the second BBU obtains power
from the APM5950H-L.

1.3.4.4.4 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5900H-L


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using an
APM5900H-L that serves as the power cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 833


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


An APM5900H-L can be configured when a DBS5900 base station is supplied with
-48 V DC power. The DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, or DCDU16D-02 provides DC power
to the BBUs, RRUs, fan assembly, and other components. Figure 1-398, Figure
1-399, and Figure 1-400 show the power distribution schemes of a DCDU15D,
DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D-02, respectively.

Figure 1-398 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H-L (configured with a


DCDU15D)

Figure 1-399 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H-L (configured with a


DCDU-12B)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 834


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-400 Power distribution scheme for an APM5900H-L (configured with a


DCDU16D-02)

Table 1-382 Specifications of the circuit breakers or fuses in the APM5900H-L in


-48 V DC scenarios
Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Equipment the DC Output

APM5900H-L DCDU16D-0 ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB) (LOAD0 to LOAD2)


serving as a 2 ● BBU/TM/FAN: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD3 to
power LOAD6) a
cabinet

APM5900H-L DCDU15D ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to LOAD5)


serving as a ● BBU/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD6 to LOAD9)
power
cabinet ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)

APM5900H-L DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


serving as a ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet ● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

a: MCB:
miniature
circuit
breaker
b: FUSE: fuse

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from "LOAD6", "LOAD7", "LOAD8", and "LOAD9"
ports on a DCDU15D. When a second BBU is configured, the second BBU obtains power
from another DCDU.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 835


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.4.4.5 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(AC)


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using an
APM5930(AC) in 110 V AC or 220 V AC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC input power is provided, the EPU (EPU05A-11 or
EPU05A-12) in a cabinet distributes AC power and DC power to other
components.
The EPU divides the AC input into two AC outputs.
● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).
● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.
The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-401, Figure 1-403, Figure 1-404, and Figure 1-402 show the power
distribution schemes in 220 V AC and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table
1-383 lists the specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a base station.

Figure 1-401 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(AC) in a 220 V AC single/three-phase


scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 836


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-402 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(AC) in a 110 V AC dual-


live-wire scenario (configured with the PDU06D-01)

Figure 1-403 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(AC) in a 220 V AC single/three-phase


scenario (configured with the PDU03D-03)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 837


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-404 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(AC) in a 110 V AC dual-live-wire scenario
(configured with the PDU03D-03)

Table 1-383 Specifications of circuit breakers and fuses in an APM5930(AC) in AC


scenarios
Power Specificatio Specifications Specifications of the Circuit
Supply ns of the of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Upper-Level Breaker for
Circuit the AC
Breaker for Output
the PSU

220 V AC 3x50 A Heater and ● RRU (power consumption per


single- SOU: 1x16 A RRU ≤ 800 W): 6x30 A (FUSE)
phase/ (MCB) (LOAD12 to LOAD14)
three- ● BBU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
phase
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
110 V AC 1x125 A Heater and ● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
dual-live- SOU: 1x25 A
● TM/EMUB: 1x30 A (FUSE)
wire (MCB)
● TM/TMC: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● BBC: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● RRU (power consumption per
RRU ≤ 800 W): 15x30 A (FUSE)
(3 PDU06D-01s)

When a cabinet requires EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds, the EPU05A must be configured


with the PDU01D-02s that obtain power from the EPU05A (converting AC input
power into DC power) and distribute the power to the EPU02D-02s/DCDU16Ds.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 838


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The power distribution schemes are shown in Figure 1-405 and Figure 1-406. The
specifications of circuit breakers and fuses in a base station are listed in Table
1-384.
NOTE

The scheme for the DCDU16D to obtain power from the PDU01D-02 is similar to that for
the EPU02D-02. The following figure uses the EPU02D-02 as an example.

Figure 1-405 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(AC) in a 220 V AC


single/three-phase scenario (configured with the EPU02D-02)

Figure 1-406 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(AC) in a 110 V AC dual-


live-wire scenario (configured with the EPU02D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 839


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-384 Specifications of circuit breakers and fuses in an APM5930(AC) in AC


scenarios
Power Specificatio Specifications Specifications of the Circuit
Supply ns of the of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for the DC Output
Upper-Level Breaker for
Circuit the AC
Breaker for Output
the PSU

220 V AC 3x50 A Heater and ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD12


single- SOU: 1x16 A to LOAD14)
phase/ (MCB) ● RRU (power consumption per
three- RRU ≤ 800 W): 9x30 A (FUSE)
phase (2 PDU06D-01s)
110 V AC 1x125 A Heater and ● RRU (800 W < power
dual-live- SOU: 1x25 A consumption per RRU ≤ 1100
wire (MCB) W): 6x30 A (FUSE) (2
EPU02D-02s)
● BBU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/EMUB: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● TM/TMC: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● BBC: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● EPU02D-02/DCDU16D: 1x125
A (MCB) (PDU01D-02)

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from "LOAD0", "LOAD3", "LOAD1", and "LOAD4"
ports on an EPU. If there is a standby power board or a second BBU, the standby power
board or second BBU obtains power from "LOAD2" and "LOAD5" ports.

An EPU02D-02 supplies power to RRUs (800 W < power consumption per RRU ≤
1100 W). The following figure shows the power distribution scheme for an
EPU02D-02.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 840


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-407 Power distribution scheme for an EPU02D-02

The following table lists the fuse specifications of an EPU02D-02 providing


boosted-voltage and DC power outputs.

Table 1-385 Fuse specifications of an EPU02D-02


Power Fuse Terminal Specifications
Equipment

EPU02D-02 Slot 1 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) -57 V boosted-voltage power


Slot 2 (LOAD0 or LOAD1) output: 3x30 A (RRU)

LOAD0 to LOAD3 -48 V DC power output: 4x30


A (SPARE)

A DCDU16D supplies power to RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 1400 W). The
following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 841


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-408 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D

The following table lists the circuit breaker or fuse specifications of a DCDU16D
providing DC power outputs.

Table 1-386 Specifications of circuit breakers or fuses for a DCDU16D


Power Circuit Breaker/Fuse Specifications
Equipment Terminal

DCDU16D LOAD0 to LOAD2 -48 V DC power output: 3x50


A (RRU)

LOAD3 to LOAD6 -48 V DC power output: 4x30


A (BBU)

When an APM5930(AC) uses AC power supply, the AC power is converted into two
DC outputs for the transmission cabinet APM5930(DC). The transmission cabinet
provides power supply for the transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other
components through the DC power distribution box. The following figure shows
the power distribution scheme.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 842


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-409 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-387 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios


Cabinet Type Power Equipment Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

APM5930(DC) DCDU15D ● TM: 10x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to


serving as a LOAD9)
transmission ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)
cabinet
DCDU16D TM/FAN: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD3 to
LOAD6)

NOTE

When a second BBU is installed in a transmission cabinet, the second BBU obtains power
from the APM5930(AC).

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 843


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.4.4.6 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM5930(DC)


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using the
APM5930(DC) that serves as a power cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


An APM5930(DC) can be configured when a DBS5900 base station is supplied
with -48 V DC power. The power distribution box DCDU15D, DCDU-12B,
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, or EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S in the APM5930(DC) is
used to supply power to the BBUs, RRUs, fan assembly, and other components.
Figure 1-410, Figure 1-411, and Figure 1-412 show the power distribution
schemes for a DCDU15D, DCDU-12B, and DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02, respectively.
Figure 1-413 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02D-02. Figure
1-414 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02B. Figure 1-415 shows
the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S. Figure 1-416 shows the power
distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Figure 1-410 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the DCDU15D)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 844


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-411 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the DCDU-12B)

Figure 1-412 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 845


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-413 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02D-02)

Figure 1-414 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02B)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 846


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-415 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02S)

Figure 1-416 Power distribution scheme for an APM5930(DC) (configured with


the EPU02S-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 847


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-388 Fuse specifications of an APM5930(DC) in -48 V DC scenarios


Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Equipment the DC Output

APM5930(DC DCDU16D/ ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB) (LOAD0 to LOAD2)


) serving as a DCDU16D-0 ● BBU/TM/FAN: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD3 to
power 2 LOAD6)
cabinet

APM5930(DC DCDU15D ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD0 to LOAD5)


) serving as a ● BBU/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD6 to LOAD9)
power
cabinet ● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE) (LOAD10)

APM5930(DC DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet ● SPARE: 2x30 A (FUSE)

APM5930(DC EPU02D-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x30 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

APM5930(DC EPU02B ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

APM5930(DC EPU02S ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

APM5930(DC EPU02S-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A (FUSE)


) serving as a ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
power
cabinet

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from "LOAD6", "LOAD7", "LOAD8", and "LOAD9"
ports on a DCDU15D. When a second BBU is configured, the second BBU obtains power
from another DCDU or EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02.

1.3.4.4.7 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the APM30H (Ver.E)

Power Distribution Scheme in 110 V AC or 220 V AC Scenarios


When 110 V AC or 220 V AC power is used, the EPU (EPU05A-07 or EPU05A-09)
in the cabinet converts the AC power into DC power and distributes power to
other components.
The EPU divides the AC input into two AC outputs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 848


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

● One output is provided for the service outlet unit (SOU).


● One output is connected to the junction box on the left side of the cabinet,
and divided into four AC power outputs, which are then provided for the
heater or heating film.
The PSUs convert AC power into DC power, which is supplied to the battery
cabinet, transmission cabinet, BBUs, RRUs, and other equipment.
NOTE

The power distribution scheme in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario is the same as that in a
220 V AC single-phase scenario, except that the three power inputs do not need to be
connected by short-circuiting bars in a 220 V AC three-phase scenario.

Figure 1-417 and Figure 1-418 show the power distribution schemes in 220 V AC
and 110 V AC scenarios, respectively. Table 1-389 lists the specifications of the
circuit breakers and fuses in a base station.

Figure 1-417 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 220 V AC
single-phase scenario (configured with the PDU03D-02)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 849


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-418 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 110 V AC
dual-live-wire scenario (configured with the PDU03D-02)

Table 1-389 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.E)
in AC scenarios

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 2x40 A+1x25 A Heater and SOU: ● LOAD9 to


phase/three- 1x16 A (MCB) LOAD14: 6x30
phase A (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A
(FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● TM: 4x30 A
(FUSE)
● TMC: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBS: 1x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 850


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 1x100 A ● Heater: 1x16 A ● RRU (slot 7):


live-wire (MCB) 3x30 A (FUSE)
● SOU: 1x16 A ● RRU (slot 8):
(MCB) 3x30 A (FUSE)
● RRU (slot 9):
3x30 A (FUSE)

NOTE

The BBU is preferentially powered by the "LOAD0" and "LOAD1" ports on an EPU. If there is
a standby power board or a second BBU, the standby power board or second BBU obtains
power from "LOAD5" and "LOAD6" ports.

When the cabinet requires a DCDU16D/EPU02D/EPU02D-02, the EPU05A must be


configured with two PDU01D-01 modules that obtain power from the EPU05A
(converting AC input power into DC power) and distribute it to the DCDU16D/
EPU02D/EPU02D-02. The power distribution schemes are shown in Figure 1-419
and Figure 1-420. The specifications of circuit breakers and fuses are listed in the
following table.
NOTE

The scheme for the DCDU16D/EPU02D-02 to obtain power from the PDU01D-01 is similar
to that for the EPU02D. The following figure uses the EPU02D as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 851


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-419 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 220 V AC
single-phase scenario (configured with the EPU02D)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 852


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-420 Power distribution scheme for the APM30H (Ver.E) in a 110 V AC
dual-live-wire scenario (configured with the EPU02D)

Table 1-390 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in the APM30H (Ver.E)
in AC scenarios
Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of
the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

220 V AC single- 2x40 A+1x25 A Heater and SOU: ● LOAD9 to


phase/three- 1x16 A (MCB) LOAD14: 6x30
phase A (FUSE)
● BBU: 2x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 853


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Supply Specifications of Specifications of Specifications of


the Upper-Level the Circuit the Circuit
Circuit Breaker Breaker for the Breaker/Fuse for
for the PSU AC Output the DC Output

110 V AC dual- 1x100 A ● Heater: 1x16 A ● FAN: 1x30 A


live-wire (MCB) (FUSE)
● SOU: 1x16 A ● TM: 4x30 A
(MCB) (FUSE)
● TMC: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● IBBS: 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● RRU (slot 7):
3x30 A (FUSE)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
8): 1x100 A
(MCB)
● EPU02D/
EPU02D-02/
DCDU16D (slot
9): 1x100 A
(MCB)

NOTE

The BBU is preferentially powered by the "LOAD0" and "LOAD1" ports on an EPU. If there is
a standby power board or a second BBU, the standby power board or second BBU obtains
power from "LOAD5" and "LOAD6" ports.

The following figure shows the EPU02D or EPU02D-02 power distribution scheme.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 854


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-421 EPU02D or EPU02D-02 power distribution scheme

A DCDU16D supplies power to RRUs (power consumption per RRU ≤ 1400 W). The
following figure shows the power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D.

Figure 1-422 Power distribution scheme for a DCDU16D

The following table lists the circuit breaker or fuse specifications of a DCDU16D
providing DC power outputs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 855


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-391 Specifications of circuit breakers or fuses for a DCDU16D

Power Circuit Breaker/Fuse Specifications


Equipment Terminal

DCDU16D LOAD0 to LOAD2 -48 V DC power output: 3x50


A (RRU)

LOAD3 to LOAD6 -48 V DC power output: 4x30


A (BBU)

When the APM30H (Ver.E) uses the AC power supply, one DC output is supplied to
the transmission cabinet. The transmission cabinet provides power supply for the
transmission equipment, fan assembly, and other components in the cabinet
through the DC power distribution box, as shown in the following figure.

Figure 1-423 Power distribution scheme for the transmission cabinet in AC


scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet
in AC scenarios.

Table 1-392 Specifications of the fuses in the transmission cabinet in AC scenarios

Cabinet Type Specifications of the DC Output Fuse

TMC11H (Ver.E) serving as a ● TM: 7x30 A (FUSE)


transmission cabinet ● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 856


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

1.3.4.4.8 When the BBU Is Installed in the TMC11H (Ver.E)


This section describes the power distribution scheme for a distributed base station
using a TMC11H (Ver.E) in -48 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


When a distributed base station uses -48 V DC power, a TMC11H can be
configured and the DCDU-12B/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02/EPU02D/EPU02D-02/
EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 in the TMC11H distributes the power to BBUs, RRUs,
fan assembly, and other components. Figure 1-424 shows the power distribution
scheme for a DCDU-12B. Figure 1-425 shows the power distribution scheme for a
DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02. Figure 1-426 shows the power distribution scheme for
an EPU02D/EPU02D-02. Figure 1-427 shows the power distribution scheme for an
EPU02B. Figure 1-428 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S.
Figure 1-429 shows the power distribution scheme for an EPU02S-02.

Figure 1-424 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when a DCDU-12B


is configured in the TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 857


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-425 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when a DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02 is configured in the TMC11H

Figure 1-426 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02D


or EPU02D-02 is configured in the TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 858


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-427 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02B is


configured in the TMC11H

Figure 1-428 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02S is


configured in the TMC11H

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 859


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-429 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an


EPU02S-02 is configured in the TMC11H

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the TMC11H in -48 V DC
scenarios.

Table 1-393 Specifications of the fuses in the TMC11H in -48 V DC scenarios


Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse
Equipment for the DC Output

When the DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● TM/BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet ● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN: 1x30 A (FUSE)

When the DCDU16D/ ● RRU: 3x50 A (MCB)


TMC11H is DCDU16D-02 ● BBU/FAN/TM: 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

When the EPU02D ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 2x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet ● FAN: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)

When the EPU02D-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 2x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet ● FAN: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: -48 V 1x30 A (FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 860


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Type Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse


Equipment for the DC Output

When the EPU02B ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A (FUSE)


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

When the EPU02S ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

When the EPU02S-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


TMC11H is ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A (FUSE)
used as a
power cabinet

NOTE

The BBU preferentially obtains power from the "LOAD6" and "LOAD7" ports on the
DCDU-12B. If there is a standby power board or a second BBU, a second DCDU-12B must
be configured so that the standby power board or second BBU can obtain power from the
"LOAD6" and "LOAD7" ports on the second DCDU-12B.

1.3.4.4.9 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the IBC10 (Ver.B)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using an
IBC10 (Ver.B) in -48 V DC scenarios.

Power Distribution Scheme for an IBC10 (Ver.B) DC Cabinet


When -48 V DC input power is provided for an IBC10 (Ver.B) DC cabinet, the
power distribution boxes DCDU-12Cs in the cabinet supply power to the BBUs,
USUs, fan assemblies, and other components. The following figure shows the
positions of five DCDU-12Cs in the cabinet.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 861


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-430 Positions of the modules in the cabinet

The following table describes the power distribution schemes of the five
DCDU-12Cs in an IBC10 (Ver.B) DC cabinet.

Table 1-394 Power distribution schemes


Port LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9

0#D USU USU FAN FAN USU USU SPAR SPAR SPAR SPAR
CDU 0 1 0 1 0 1 E E E E
-12C (left (left (righ (righ
a UPIU UPIU t t
) ) UPIU UPIU
) )

1#D BBU5 (UPEU BBU6 (UPEU BBU7 (UPEU BBU8 (UPEU BBU9 (UPEU
CDU in the upper in the upper in the upper in the upper in the upper
-12C slot) slot) slot) slot) slot)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 862


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Port LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9

2#D BBU5 (UPEU BBU6 (UPEU BBU7 (UPEU BBU8 (UPEU BBU9 (UPEU
CDU in the lower in the lower in the lower in the lower in the lower
-12C slot) slot) slot) slot) slot)

3#D BBU0 (UPEU BBU1 (UPEU BBU2 (UPEU BBU3 (UPEU BBU4 (UPEU
CDU in the upper in the upper in the upper in the upper in the upper
-12C slot) slot) slot) slot) slot)

4#D BBU0 (UPEU BBU1 (UPEU BBU2 (UPEU BBU3 (UPEU BBU4 (UPEU
CDU in the lower in the lower in the lower in the lower in the lower
-12C slot) slot) slot) slot) slot)

a. 0#DCDU-12C is installed at the rear of the cabinet.

1.3.4.4.10 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the ILC29 (Ver.E)
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a distributed base station
using the ILC29 (Ver.E) cabinet in -48 V DC scenarios.

The following figure shows the components in an ILC29 (Ver.E).


NOTE

The DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 and EPU02D-02 installation positions are the same. The figure
uses the EPU02D-02 as an example.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 863


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-431 Components in an ILC29 cabinet

The power distribution schemes for the five DCDU-12B modules in the cabinet are
different from each other, as described in Table 1-395. Table 1-396 lists the
specifications of DC output fuses in these modules.

Table 1-395 Power distribution schemes for DCDU-12B modules


Pow LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA
er D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9
Distr
ibuti
on
Mod
ule

DCD RRU RRU RRU - - - - - - -


U-12 18 19 20
B (4)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 864


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Pow LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA LOA
er D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9
Distr
ibuti
on
Mod
ule

DCD - BBU BBU BBU BBU FAN BBU BBU BBU BBU
U-12 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
B (0) (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE (UPE
U0) U0) U1) U1) U0) U0) U1) U1)

DCD RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU - - - -


U-12 12 13 14 15 16 17
B (3)

DCD RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU - - - -


U-12 6 7 8 9 10 11
B (2)

DCD RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU RRU - - - -


U-12 0 1 2 3 4 5
B (1)

Table 1-396 Specifications of the DC output fuses in DCDU-12B modules


Application Power Supply Specifications of the DC Output Fuse
Scenario

DCDU-12B -48 V DC RRU: 3x30 A (FUSE)


(4)

DCDU-12B -48 V DC ● BBU 0: 4x30 A (FUSE)


(0) ● BBU 1: 4x30 A (FUSE)
● SPARE: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● FAN 0: 1x30 A (FUSE)

DCDU-12B -48 V DC RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)


(3)/
DCDU-12B
(2)/
DCDU-12B
(1)

Table 1-397 describes the power distribution schemes for the three EPU02D-02/
EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02 modules in the cabinet. Table 1-398 lists the
specifications of DC output fuses in these modules.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 865


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-397 Power distribution scheme for EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/


EPU02S-02 modules
Pow BDU 0 BDU 1
er
Distr LOA LOA N/A LOA LOA N/A
D0 D1 D0 D1 LOA LOA LOA LOA
ibuti
D0 D1 D2 D3
on
Mod
ule

EPU0 RRU/ RRU/ - RRU/ - - - - - -


2D-0 AAU AAU AAU
2/ (6) (7) (8)
EPU0
2B/
EPU0
2S/
EPU0
2S-0
2 (2)

EPU0 RRU/ RRU/ - RRU/ - - - - - -


2D-0 AAU AAU AAU
2/ (3) (4) (5)
EPU0
2B/
EPU0
2S/
EPU0
2S-0
2 (1)

EPU0 RRU/ RRU/ - RRU/ - - - - - -


2D-0 AAU AAU AAU
2/ (0) (1) (2)
EPU0
2B/
EPU0
2S/
EPU0
2S-0
2 (0)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 866


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-398 Specifications of the DC output fuses in EPU02D-02/EPU02B/EPU02S/


EPU02S-02 modules
Power Power Supply Specifications of the DC Output Fuse
Distribution
Module

EPU02D-02/ -48 V DC RRU: -57 V 3x30 A (FUSE)


EPU02B

EPU02S -48 V DC RRU: -57 V 3x28 A (FUSE)

EPU02S-02 -48 V DC RRU: -57 V 3x28 A (FUSE)

Table 1-399 describes the power distribution scheme for the three DCDU16D/
DCDU16D-02 modules in the cabinet. Table 1-400 lists the specifications of DC
output circuit breakers in these modules.

Table 1-399 Power distribution scheme for DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 modules


Power LOAD0 LOAD1 LOAD2 LOAD3 LOAD4 LOAD5 LOAD6
Distrib
ution
Module

DCDU1 RRU/AA RRU/AA RRU/AA - - - -


6D (2) U (6) U (7) U (8)

DCDU1 RRU/AA RRU/AA RRU/AA - - - -


6D (1) U (3) U (4) U (5)

DCDU1 RRU/AA RRU/AA RRU/AA - - - -


6D (0) U (0) U (1) U (2)

Table 1-400 Specifications of the DC output circuit breakers in DCDU16D/


DCDU16D-02 modules
Power Distribution Power Supply Specifications of the
Module Circuit Breaker for the
DC Output

DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 -48 V DC RRU/AAU: -48 V 3x50A


(MCB)

1.3.4.4.11 Power Distribution Scheme for a DBS5900 Using the IMB05,


IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-Inch Rack, or Wall for Installation
This section describes the power distribution scheme for a DBS5900 using the
IMB05, IMS5906+IFS5906, 19-inch rack, or wall for installation in 220 V AC and
-48 V DC input scenarios.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 867


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Distribution Scheme in 220 V AC Scenarios


When 220 V AC power is supplied, the ETP48100-B1 in the IMB05 cabinet converts
the AC power into DC power and distributes the DC power to other components.
The following figure shows the power distribution scheme.

Figure 1-432 Power distribution scheme for the IMB05 configured with an
ETP48100-B1 in 220 V AC or 110 V AC scenarios

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a
base station.

Table 1-401 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a base station
Application Power Specifications of the Circuit Breaker/Fuse for
Scenario Supply the DC Output

IMB05 220 V AC ● RRU: 2x30 A (FUSE)


single-phase ● BBU: 2x30 A (FUSE)

Power Distribution Scheme in -48 V DC Scenarios


When -48 V DC power supply is used, an EPU02B/EPU02S/EPU02S-02/DCDU-12B/
EPU02D-02/DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 distributes the power to BBUs, RRUs, and
other components, as shown in Figure 1-433, Figure 1-434, Figure 1-435, Figure
1-436, Figure 1-437, and Figure 1-438.
When -48 V DC power supply is used, the IFS5906 is stacked on the IMS5906 and
a DCDU-12B/EPU02D-02 distributes power to BBUs, RRUs, and other components,
as shown in Figure 1-439 and Figure 1-440.
When -48 V DC power supply is used, the INS05 is installed in a non-Huawei
cabinet and a DCDU-12B distributes power to BBUs, as shown in Figure 1-441.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 868


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-433 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02B is


configured

Figure 1-434 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02S is


configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 869


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-435 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC input scenarios when an


EPU02S-02 is configured

Figure 1-436 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when a DCDU-12B


is configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 870


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-437 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC scenarios when an EPU02D


or EPU02D-02 is configured

Figure 1-438 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC input scenarios when a


DCDU16D/DCDU16D-02 is configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 871


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-439 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC input scenarios when the
IFS5906 is stacked on the IMS5906 and a DCDU-12B is configured

Figure 1-440 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC input scenarios when the
IFS5906 is stacked on the IMS5906 and an EPU02D-02 is configured

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 872


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-441 Power distribution scheme in -48 V DC input scenarios when BBUs
are installed in an INS05 in a non-Huawei cabinet and a DCDU-12B is configured

The following table lists the specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a
base station.

Table 1-402 Specifications of the circuit breakers and fuses in a base station

Application Power Supply Power Equipment Specifications of the


Scenario Circuit Breaker/Fuse
for the DC Output

IMB05, -48 V DC EPU02D-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x30 A


IMS5906+IFS (FUSE)
5906, wall, or ● BBU: -48 V 2x30 A
19-inch rack (FUSE)
● FAN: -48 V 1x30 A
(FUSE)
● SPARE: -48 V 1x30
A (FUSE)

IMB05, -48 V DC DCDU-12B ● RRU: 6x30 A


IMS5906+IFS (FUSE)
5906, wall, or ● BBUa: 2x30 A
19-inch rack (FUSE)
● SPARE: 2x30 A
(FUSE)

INS05 -48 V DC DCDU-12B ● BBU: 8x30 A


(FUSE)
● SPARE: 2x30 A
(FUSE)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 873


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Application Power Supply Power Equipment Specifications of the


Scenario Circuit Breaker/Fuse
for the DC Output

IMB05, wall, -48 V DC DCDU16D/ ● RRU: 3x50 A


or 19-inch DCDU16D-02 (MCB)
rack ● BBU/FAN/TM:
4x30 A (FUSE)

IMB05, wall, -48 V DC EPU02B ● RRU: -57 V 6x30 A


or 19-inch (FUSE)
rack ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A
(FUSE)

IMB05, wall, -48 V DC EPU02S ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


or 19-inch (FUSE)
rack ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A
(FUSE)

IMB05, wall, -48 V DC EPU02S-02 ● RRU: -57 V 3x28 A


or 19-inch (FUSE)
rack ● BBU: -48 V 4x30 A
(FUSE)

a: One DCDU-12B cannot supply power to two power boards in a BBU5900. One
of the two power boards needs to be powered by other module.

1.3.4.5 Cable Connections in a DBS5900


For cable connections for a DBS5900, see section "Cable Connections" in 3900 &
5900 Series Base Station Cables. The following table lists the links for reference.

Table 1-403 Cable connections


Cabinet Power Monitorin Transmiss BBU CPRI Cable
Used by Cable g Signal ion Cable Interconne Connection
a Connections Cable Connecti ction s
DBS5900 Connectio ons Signal
ns Cable
Connection
s

APM5950 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


H Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
APM5950H DBS5900 Series s
Using the Base
APM5950H Stations

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 874


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Power Monitorin Transmiss BBU CPRI Cable


Used by Cable g Signal ion Cable Interconne Connection
a Connections Cable Connecti ction s
DBS5900 Connectio ons Signal
ns Cable
Connection
s

APM5900 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


H Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
APM5900H DBS5900 Series s
Using the Base
APM5900H Stations

APM5950 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


H-L Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
APM5950H- DBS5900 Series s
L Using the Base
APM5950H Stations
-L

APM5900 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


H-L Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
APM5900H- DBS5900 Series s
L Using the Base
APM5900H Stations
-L

APM593 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


0(AC) Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
APM5930(A DBS5900 Series s
C) Using the Base
APM5930( Stations
AC)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 875


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Power Monitorin Transmiss BBU CPRI Cable


Used by Cable g Signal ion Cable Interconne Connection
a Connections Cable Connecti ction s
DBS5900 Connectio ons Signal
ns Cable
Connection
s

APM593 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


0(DC) Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
APM5930(D DBS5900 Series s
C) Using the Base
APM5930( Stations
DC)

ILC29 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


(Ver.E) Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
ILC29 (Ver.E) DBS5900 Series s
Using the Base
ILC29 Stations
(Ver.E)

IMB05 Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
IMB05 DBS5900 Series s
Using the Base
IMB05 Stations

APM30H Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


(Ver.E) Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
APM30H DBS5900 Series s
(Ver.E) Using the Base
APM30H Stations
(Ver.E)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 876


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Cabinet Power Monitorin Transmiss BBU CPRI Cable


Used by Cable g Signal ion Cable Interconne Connection
a Connections Cable Connecti ction s
DBS5900 Connectio ons Signal
ns Cable
Connection
s

TMC11H Power Cable Monitoring Transmissi BBU CPRI Cable


(Ver.E) Connections Signal on Cable Interconnec Connection
in a Cable Connectio tion Signal s for 5900
DBS5900 Connection ns for Cable Series Base
Using the s in a 5900 Connection Stations
TMC11H DBS5900 Series s
(Ver.E) Using the Base
TMC11H Stations
(Ver.E)

1.3.5 DBS5900A
This section describes the application scenarios, power requirements, power
distribution schemes, and cable connections of a DBS5900A.

1.3.5.1 Application Scenarios of a DBS5900A


This section describes outdoor AC and DC scenarios of a DBS5900A configured
with a BBU5900A.

1.3.5.1.1 Outdoor AC Scenario


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS5900A is installed outdoors and
supplied with AC power.
The following table describes the outdoor AC installation scenario of a DBS5900A
configured with a BBU5900A.

Table 1-404 BBU5900A installation scenarios


BBU Installation Scenario Scenario Description

Pole- or wall-mounted The BBU5900A (DC) and OPM200 are


installed on a pole or wall, RRUs are
remotely installed, and the OPM200
supplies power to the BBU5900A (DC)
and RRUs.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 877


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

BBU Installation Scenario Scenario Description

Pole- or wall-mounted The BBU5900A (AC) is installed on a


pole, RRUs are remotely installed, and
the external AC power distribution
equipment supplies power to the
BBU5900A (AC).

The following table describes the typical configurations of a base station with
different requirements for backup power capacities and carrier configurations.

Table 1-405 DBS5900A typical configurations


Power Bac Carrier Typical Configuration Illustration
Supply kup Configu
Pow ration
er
Req
uire
men
t

110 V N/A 6 RRUs 1 BBU5900A (DC)+1 See Figure 1-442.


AC or OPM200+6 RRUs
220 V
AC N/A 3 Easy 1 BBU5900A (AC)+3 See Figure 1-443.
Macro Easy Macro modules/
modules Book RRUs
/Book
RRUs

6 Easy 1 BBU5900A (AC)+6


Macro Easy Macro modules/
modules Book RRUs
/Book
RRUs

110 V OP 6 RRUs 1 BBU5900A (DC)+1 See Figure 1-444.


AC or M20 OPM200+2 IBBS50Ls+6
220 V 0:IB RRUs
AC BS5
0L =
1:2

110 V OP 9 RRUs 1 BBU5900A (DC)+1


AC or M20 OPM200+4 IBBS50Ls+9
220 V 0:IB RRUs
AC BS5
0L =
1:4

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 878


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Power Bac Carrier Typical Configuration Illustration


Supply kup Configu
Pow ration
er
Req
uire
men
t

110 V OP 18 RRUs 1 BBU5900A (DC)+2


AC or M20 OPM200s+8 IBBS50Ls
220 V 0:IB +18 RRUs
AC BS5
0L =
1:4

Figure 1-442 and Figure 1-443 show the application scenarios of a DBS5900A
when no backup power is required.

Figure 1-442 DBS5900A application scenario without backup power for the
BBU5900A (DC)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 879


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-443 DBS5900A application scenario without backup power for the
BBU5900A (AC)

The following figure shows the application scenario of a DBS5900A when backup
power is required.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 880


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-444 DBS5900A application scenario with backup power for the
BBU5900A (DC)

1.3.5.1.2 Outdoor DC Scenario


This section describes the scenarios where the DBS5900A is installed outdoors and
supplied with DC power.
The following table describes the outdoor DC installation scenario of a DBS5900A
configured with a BBU5900A (DC).

Table 1-406 BBU5900A installation scenarios


BBU Installation Position Scenario Description

Pole- or wall-mounted The BBU and RRUs are separately


installed on poles or walls. The
external DC power distribution
equipment provides DC power for the
BBU and RRUs.

When supplied with -48 V DC power, the DBS5900A can use the typical
configurations described in the following table.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 881


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Table 1-407 DBS5900A typical configurations

Power Supply Base Station Illustration


Configuration

-48 V DC 1 BBU5900A (DC)+6 RRUs See Figure 1-445.

The following figure shows the application scenario of a DBS5900A when external
DC power is supplied.

Figure 1-445 DBS5900A application scenario

1.3.5.2 Power Requirements of a DBS5900A


This section describes the power requirements of a DBS5900A configured with a
BBU5900A.

AC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when the BBU5900A (AC) is
powered by external AC equipment.

Table 1-408 Power requirements in AC scenarios

Power Supply Minimum Requirements for the Cable Length


Requirement for Input Power Cable Requirement
Circuit Breakers
on Customer
Equipment

220 V AC single- 1x16 A/1 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 in.2), ≤ 100 m


phase one group (328.08 ft)

110 V AC single- 1x16 A/1 P 2.5 mm2 (0.0039 in.2), ≤ 20 m (65.62


phase one group ft)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 882


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

When an outdoor DBS5900A is supplied with AC power in the pole- or wall-


mounted scenario, an OPM200 can be configured to provide power for the
BBU5900A (DC) and RRUs. The following table lists the power requirements.

NOTE

● Power cables purchased locally must comply with local regulations.


● In the following tables, P is short for Pole, indicating the number of switches
simultaneously controlled by a pole.

Table 1-409 Power requirements in AC scenarios


Power Number of Minimum Requirements for Cable
Supply PSUs Requirement the Input Power Length
for Circuit Cable Requireme
Breakers on nt
Customer
Equipment

220 V AC 2 1x32 A/3 P ● Black cable ≤ 100 m


three-phase with four core (328.08 ft)
3 wires (L1, L2,
L3, and N),
dual insulation
layers, and a
cross-sectional
area of 6 mm2
(0.0093 in.2)

220 V AC 2 1x50 A/1 P ● Black cable


single-phase with three core
3 1x80 A/1 P wires (L, N, and
PE), dual
insulation
layers, and a
cross-sectional
area of 16
mm2 (0.025 in.
2)

110 V AC or 2 1x50 A/2 P ● Three wires


120 V AC (L1, L2, and
dual-live-wire 3 1x80 A/2 P PE), each with
a single core
wire, two
insulation
layers, and a
cross-sectional
area of 16
mm2 (0.025 in.
2)

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 883


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

DC Input Scenario
The following table lists the power requirements when the BBU5900A (DC) is
powered by external DC equipment.

Table 1-410 Power requirements in DC scenarios


Power Supply Minimum Requirements for the Cable Length
Requirement for Input Power Cable Requirement
Circuit Breakers
on Customer
Equipment

-48 V DC 40 A/1 P 5.3 mm2 (0.0082 in.2) ≤ 20 m (65.62


or 6 mm2 (0.0093 in. ft)
30 A/1 P 2), one group

1.3.5.3 Power Distribution Schemes for a DBS5900A


This section describes the power distribution schemes for a DBS5900A configured
with a BBU5900A.

AC Input Scenario
When AC power is supplied, the OPM200 converts AC power into DC power and
then supplies it to the BBU, RRUs, and other components.
The following figures show the power distribution schemes for a DBS5900A
supplied with AC power.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 884


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

Figure 1-446 Power distribution scheme for a DBS5900A supplied with 110 V AC
power

Figure 1-447 Power distribution scheme for a DBS5900A supplied with 220 V AC
power

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 885


3900 & 5900 Series Base Station 1 3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Model
Model Description Description

The following table lists the specifications of the fuses in the OPM200 in AC
scenarios.

Table 1-411 Specifications of the fuses in the OPM200 in AC scenarios


Power Supply Fuse Specifications

220 V AC single-phase or 110 V AC ● BBU5900A: 1x30 A (FUSE)


dual-live-wire ● TM: 1x30 A (FUSE)
● RRU: 6x30 A (FUSE)
● Power distribution slots: 2
(1) When the PDU06D-01 is
configured: 6x30 A (FUSE)
(2) When the SDU60-02 is
configured: 2x30 A (FUSE)

1.3.5.4 Cable Connections in a DBS5900A


For cable connections in a DBS5900A, see topics related to Cable Connections in
3900 & 5900 Series Base Station Cables.

Issue 15 (2022-06-27) Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 886

You might also like